String expansions: support sha3 under OpenSSL (1.1.1+)
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.90"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2017
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 .endtable
441
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
449 .cindex "web site"
450 .cindex "FTP site"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
452 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
453 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
454 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
455 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
456 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
457
458 .cindex "wiki"
459 .cindex "FAQ"
460 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
461 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
462 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
463 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
464 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
465
466 .cindex Bugzilla
467 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
468 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
469 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
470
471
472
473 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
474 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
475 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
476
477 .table2 140pt
478 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
479 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
480 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
481 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
482 .endtable
483
484 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
485 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
486 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
487 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
488 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
489 via this web page:
490 .display
491 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 .endd
493 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
494 lists.
495
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503
504
505
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507 .cindex "FTP site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
510 .display
511 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
512 .endd
513 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
514 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
515 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
516
517 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
518 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
519 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
520 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
521 .display
522 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
523 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
524 .endd
525 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
526 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
527 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
528
529 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
530 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
531 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
532 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
533 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
534 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
535 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
536 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
537 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
538 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
539 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
540
541 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
542 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
543 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
544 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
545
546 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
547 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
548 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
549
550 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
551 .display
552 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
554 .endd
555 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
556 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
557 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
558
559 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
560 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
561 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
562 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
563 .display
564 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
565 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
566 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568 .endd
569 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
570 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
571
572
573 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
574 .ilist
575 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
576 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
577 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
578 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
579 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
580 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
581 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
582 .next
583 .cindex "domainless addresses"
584 .cindex "address" "without domain"
585 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
586 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
587 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
588 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
589 arrival.
590 .next
591 .cindex "transport" "external"
592 .cindex "external transports"
593 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
594 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
595 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
596 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
597 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
598 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
599 .next
600 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
601 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
602 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
603 other means.
604 .next
605 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
606 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
607 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
608 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
609 a number of common scanners are provided.
610 .endlist
611
612
613 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
614 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
615 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
616 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
617 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
618 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
619
620
621 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
622 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
623 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
624 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
625 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
626 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
627 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
628 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
629 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
630 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
631 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
632 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
633
634 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
635 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
636 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
637 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
638
639
640
641 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
642 .cindex "terminology definitions"
643 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
644 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
645 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
646 below) by a blank line.
647
648 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
649 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
650 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
651 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
652 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
653 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
654 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
655 rise to further bounce messages.
656
657 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
658 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
659 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
660 otherwise.
661
662 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
663 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
664 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
665 until a later time.
666
667 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
668 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
669 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
670
671 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
672 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
673 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
674 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
675 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
676 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
677 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
678 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
679
680 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
681 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
682 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
683 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
684 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
685 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
686 line.
687
688 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
689 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
690 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
691 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
692 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
693
694 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
695 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
696 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
697 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
698 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
699 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
700
701 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
702 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
703 message's envelope.
704
705 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
706 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
707 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
708 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
709 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
710
711 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
712 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
713 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
714 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
715 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
716
717 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
718 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
719 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
720 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
721 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
722 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
723
724
725
726
727
728
729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
731
732 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
733 .cindex "incorporated code"
734 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
735 .cindex "PCRE"
736 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
737 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
738
739 .ilist
740 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
741 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
742 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
743 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
744 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
745 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
746 .next
747 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
748 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
749 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
750 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
751 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
752 following statements:
753
754 .blockquote
755 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
756
757 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
758 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
759 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
760 version.
761 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
762 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
763 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
764 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
765 restrictions applied to it).
766 .endblockquote
767 .next
768 .cindex "SPA authentication"
769 .cindex "Samba project"
770 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
771 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
772 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
773 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
774 under the Gnu GPL.
775 .next
776 .cindex "Cyrus"
777 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
778 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
779 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
780 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
781 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
782 conditions expressed therein.
783
784 .blockquote
785 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
786
787 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
788 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
789 are met:
790
791 .olist
792 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
793 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
794 .next
795 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
796 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
797 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
798 distribution.
799 .next
800 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
801 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
802 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
803 details, please contact
804 .display
805 Office of Technology Transfer
806 Carnegie Mellon University
807 5000 Forbes Avenue
808 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
809 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
810 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
811 .endd
812 .next
813 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
814 acknowledgment:
815
816 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
817 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
818
819 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
820 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
821 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
822 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
823 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
824 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
825 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
826 .endlist
827 .endblockquote
828
829 .next
830 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
831 .cindex "X-windows"
832 .cindex "Athena"
833 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
834 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
835 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
836 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
837
838 .blockquote
839 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
840 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
841
842 All Rights Reserved
843
844 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
845 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
846 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
847 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
848 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
849 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
850 software without specific, written prior permission.
851
852 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
853 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
854 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
855 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
856 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
857 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
858 SOFTWARE.
859 .endblockquote
860
861 .next
862 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
863 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
864 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
865 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
866 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
867 source code.
868
869 .next
870 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
871 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
872 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
873 .endlist
874
875
876
877
878
879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
881
882 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
883 "Receiving and delivering mail"
884
885
886 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
887 .cindex "design philosophy"
888 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
889 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
890 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
891 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
892 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
893 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
894
895
896 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
897 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
898 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
899 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
900 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
901 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
902 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
903
904 .ilist
905 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
906 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
907 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
908 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
909 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
910 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
911 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
912 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
913 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
914 error code.
915 .next
916 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
917 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
918 .next
919 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
920 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
921 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
922 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
923 .next
924 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
925 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
926 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
927 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
928 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
929 .next
930 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
931 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
932 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
933 .next
934 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
935 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
936 runs at the start of every delivery process.
937 .endlist
938
939
940
941 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
942 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
943 .cindex "Sieve filter"
944 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
945 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
946 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
947 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
948 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
949 of filtering are available:
950
951 .ilist
952 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
953 by RFC 3028.
954 .next
955 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
956 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
957 .endlist
958
959 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
960
961
962
963 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
964 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
965 .cindex "format" "of message id"
966 .cindex "id of message"
967 .cindex "base62"
968 .cindex "base36"
969 .cindex "Darwin"
970 .cindex "Cygwin"
971 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
972 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
973 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
974 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
975 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
976 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
977 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
978 not always case-sensitive.
979
980 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
981 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
982 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
983 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
984 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
985 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
986 somewhat eccentric:
987
988 .ilist
989 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
990 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
991 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
992 way of representing the date and time of day).
993 .next
994 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
995 received the message.
996 .next
997 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
998 .olist
999 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1000 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1001 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1002 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1003 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1004 .next
1005 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1006 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1007 (1/100) of a second.
1008 .endlist
1009 .endlist
1010
1011 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1012 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1013 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1014 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1015 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1016
1017
1018 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1019 .cindex "receiving mail"
1020 .cindex "message" "reception"
1021 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1022 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1023 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1024 there are several possibilities:
1025
1026 .ilist
1027 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1028 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1029 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1030 .next
1031 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1032 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1033 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1034 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1035 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1036 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1037 .next
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1039 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1040 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1041 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1042 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1043 .next
1044 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1045 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1046 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1047 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1048 .endlist
1049
1050
1051 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1052 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1053 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1054 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1055 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1056 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1057 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1058 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1059 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1060 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1061 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1062 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1063 users to change sender addresses.
1064
1065 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1066 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1067 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1068 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1069 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1070 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1071 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1072
1073 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1074 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1075 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1076 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1077 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1078 message is received.
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1085 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1086 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1087 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1088 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1089 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1090 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1091 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1092
1093 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1094 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1095 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1096 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1097 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1098 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1099 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1100 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1101 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1102 affect file system performance.
1103
1104 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1105 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1106 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1107 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1108 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1109
1110 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1111 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1112 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1113 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1114 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1115 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1116 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1117 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1118 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1119 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1120 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1121 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1122
1123
1124
1125 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1126 .cindex "message" "life of"
1127 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1128 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1129 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1130 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1131 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1132 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1133 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1134
1135 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1136 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1137 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1138 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1139 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1140 to be sent.
1141
1142 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1143 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1144 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1145 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1146 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1147
1148 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1149 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1150 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1151 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1152 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1153 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1154 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1155 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1156 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1157 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1158 systems.
1159
1160 .cindex "journal file"
1161 .cindex "file" "journal"
1162 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1163 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1164 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1165 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1166 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1167 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1168 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1169 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1170
1171 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1172 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1173 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1174 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1175 deliveries caused by crashes.
1176
1177
1178
1179 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1180 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1181 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1182 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1183 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1184 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1185 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1186 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1187 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1188
1189 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1190 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1191 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1192 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1193 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1194 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1195 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1196 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1197 the driver's features in general.
1198
1199 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1200 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1201 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1202 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1203 to be bounced.
1204
1205 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1206 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1207 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1208 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1209 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1210 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1211
1212 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1213 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1214 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1215 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1216 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1217 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1218
1219 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1220 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1221 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1222 configuration.
1223
1224 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1225 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1226 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1227 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1228 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1229 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1230 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1231 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1232 configured to fail the address.
1233
1234 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1235 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1236 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1237 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1238 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1239 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1240
1241 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1242 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1243 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1244 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1245 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1246 the address is bounced.
1247
1248
1249
1250 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1251 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1252 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1253 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1254 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1255 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1256 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1257 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1258
1259 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1260 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1261 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1262 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1263 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1264 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1265 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1266 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1267
1268
1269
1270
1271 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1272 .cindex "router" "running details"
1273 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1274 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1275 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1276 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1277 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1278 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1279 the following:
1280
1281 .ilist
1282 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1283 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1284 original address ceases,
1285 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1286 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1287 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1288 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1289 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1290 end of routing.
1291
1292 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1293 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1294 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1295 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1296 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1297 .next
1298 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1299 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1300 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1301 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1302 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1303 .next
1304 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1305 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1306 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1307 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1308 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1309 .next
1310 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1311 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1312 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1313 .next
1314 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1315 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1316 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1317 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1318 .next
1319 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1320 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1321 .endlist
1322
1323 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1324 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1325 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1326 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1327 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1328
1329 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1330 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1331 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1332 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1333 facility for this purpose.
1334
1335
1336 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1337 .cindex "case of local parts"
1338 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1339 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1340 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1341 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1342 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1343 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1344 routed addresses are shown.
1345
1346
1347
1348 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1349 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1350 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1351 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1352 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1353 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1354
1355 .ilist
1356 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1357 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1358 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1359 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1360 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1361 of any other conditions.
1362 .next
1363 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1364 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1365 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1366 address.
1367 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1368 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1369 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1370 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1371 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1372 .next
1373 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1374 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1375 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1376 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1377 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1378 .next
1379 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1380 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1381 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1382 .next
1383 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1384 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1385 .next
1386 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1387 of domains that it defines.
1388 .next
1389 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1390 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1391 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1392 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1393 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1394 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1395 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1396 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1397 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1398 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1399 .next
1400 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1402 .vindex "&$home$&"
1403 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1404 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1405 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1406 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1407 remaining preconditions.
1408 .next
1409 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1410 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1411 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1412 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1413 could lead to confusion.
1414 .next
1415 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1416 set of addresses that it defines.
1417 .next
1418 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1419 specified files is tested.
1420 .next
1421 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1422 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1423 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1424 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1425 .endlist
1426
1427
1428 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1429 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1430 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1431 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1432 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1433 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1434 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1435
1436
1437
1438 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1439 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1440 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1441
1442 .ilist
1443 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1444 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1445 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1446 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1447 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1448 filtering'&.
1449 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1450 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1451
1452 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1453 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1454 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1455 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1456 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1457 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1458 filter.
1459 .next
1460 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1461 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1462 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1463 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1464 processed entirely independently of each other.
1465 .next
1466 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1467 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1468 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1469 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1470 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1471 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1472 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1473 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1474 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1475 .next
1476 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1477 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1478 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1479 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1480 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1481 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1482 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1483 addresses to the same domain.
1484 .next
1485 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1486 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1487 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1488 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1489 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1490 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1491 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1492 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1493 .next
1494 .cindex "queue runner"
1495 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1496 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1497 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1498 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1499 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1500 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1501 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1502 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1503 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1504 .next
1505 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1506 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1507 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1508 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1509 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1510 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1511 .next
1512 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1513 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1514 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1515 messages to other addresses.
1516 .next
1517 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1518 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1519 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1520 &'deferred'&.
1521 .next
1522 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1523 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1524 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1525 .endlist
1526
1527
1528
1529
1530 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1531 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1532 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1533 .cindex "queue runner"
1534 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1535 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1536 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1537 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1538 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1539 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1540 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1541 passed its retry time.
1542 You can run several queue runners at once.
1543
1544 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1545 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1546 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1547 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1548 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1549 as permanent.
1550
1551
1552
1553 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1554 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1555 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1556 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1557 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1558 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1559 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1560 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1561 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1562 also apply.
1563
1564 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1565 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1566 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1567 deferred,
1568 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1569 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1570 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1571 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1572 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1573 one connection.
1574
1575
1576
1577 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1578 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1579 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1580 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1581 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1582 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1583 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1584 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1585 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1586 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1587 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1588
1589 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1590 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1591 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1592 automatically.
1593
1594 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1595 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1596 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1597 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1598 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1599 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1600 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1601 of the list.
1602
1603
1604
1605 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1606 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1607 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1608 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1609 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1610 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1611 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1612 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1613
1614
1615
1616
1617
1618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1620
1621 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1622 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1623
1624 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1625 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1626 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1627 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1628
1629 .table2 140pt
1630 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1631 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1632 documented"
1633 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1634 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1635 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1636 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1637 instructions"
1638 .endtable
1639
1640 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1641 following subdirectories are created:
1642
1643 .table2 140pt
1644 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1645 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1646 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1647 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1648 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1649 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1650 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1651 .endtable
1652
1653 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1654 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1655 that may be useful to some sites.
1656
1657
1658 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1659 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1660 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1661 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1662 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1663 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1664 system.
1665 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1666 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1667 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1668 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1669 overridden if necessary.
1670 .cindex compiler requirements
1671 .cindex compiler version
1672 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1673
1674
1675 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1676 .cindex "PCRE library"
1677 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1678 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1679 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1680 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1681 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1682 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1683 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1684 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1685 If your operating system has no
1686 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1687 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1688 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1689
1690 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1691 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1692 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1693 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1694 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1695 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1696 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1697
1698 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1699 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1700 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1701 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1702 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1703 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1704 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1705 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1706
1707 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1708 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1709 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1710 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1711 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1712 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1713 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1714 Berkeley DB library.
1715
1716 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1717 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1718 possibilities:
1719
1720 .olist
1721 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1722 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1723 .next
1724 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1725 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1726 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1727 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1728 file name is used unmodified.
1729 .next
1730 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1731 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1732 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1733 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1734 .next
1735 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1736 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1737 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1738 .next
1739 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1740 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1741 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1742 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1743 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1744 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1745 .next
1746 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1747 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1748 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1749 operates on a single file.
1750 .endlist
1751
1752 .cindex "USE_DB"
1753 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1754 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1755 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1756 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1757 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1758 .code
1759 USE_DB=yes
1760 .endd
1761 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1762 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1763
1764 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1765 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1766 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1767 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1768 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1769 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1770
1771 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1772 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1773 in one of these lines:
1774 .code
1775 DBMLIB = -ldb
1776 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1777 .endd
1778 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1779 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1780 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1781 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1782 this example:
1783 .code
1784 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1785 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1786 .endd
1787 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1788 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1789
1790
1791
1792 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1793 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1794 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1795 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1796 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1797 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1798 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1799 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1800 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1801 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1802 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1803 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1804
1805 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1806 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1807 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1808 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1809 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1810 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1811
1812 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1813 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1814 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1815 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1816 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1817 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1818 be logged.
1819
1820 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1821 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1822 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1823 facilities, you need to set
1824 .code
1825 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1826 .endd
1827 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1828 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1829
1830
1831 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1832 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1833 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1834 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1835 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1836 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1837 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1838
1839 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1840 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1841 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1842 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1843 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1844 do this.
1845
1846
1847
1848 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1849 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1850 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1851 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1852 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1853 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1854 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1855 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1856 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1857 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1858
1859 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1860 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1861 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1862 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1863 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1864 .code
1865 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1866 .endd
1867 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1868
1869
1870
1871 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1872 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1873 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1874 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1875 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1876 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1877 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1878 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1879 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1880 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1881 line option).
1882
1883 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1884 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1885 implementing SSL.
1886
1887 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1888 .code
1889 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1890 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1891 .endd
1892 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1893 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1894 .code
1895 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1896 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1897 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1898 .endd
1899 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1900 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1904 .endd
1905 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1906 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1907 .code
1908 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1909 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1910 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1911 .endd
1912 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1913 library and include files. For example:
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1919 .endd
1920 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1921 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1922 .code
1923 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1924 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1925 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1926 .endd
1927
1928 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1929 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1930 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1931
1932
1933
1934
1935 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1936
1937 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1938 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1939 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1940 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1941 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1942 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1943 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1944 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1945 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1946 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1947 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1948 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1949 you might have
1950 .code
1951 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1952 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1953 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1954 .endd
1955 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1956 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1957 .code
1958 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1959 .endd
1960 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1961 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1962 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1963 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1964 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1965 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1966 further details.
1967
1968
1969 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1970 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1971 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1972 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1973 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1974 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1975 library files.
1976
1977 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1978 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1979 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1980 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1981 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1982 Exim used to
1983 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1984 withdrawn.
1985
1986
1987
1988 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1989 .cindex "lookup modules"
1990 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1991 .cindex ".so building"
1992 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1993 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1994 on demand.
1995 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1996 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1997 dependencies.
1998 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1999
2000 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2001 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2002 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2003 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2004 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2005 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2006
2007 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2008 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2009 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2010 on demand:
2011 .code
2012 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2013 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2014 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2015 .endd
2016
2017
2018 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2019 .cindex "build directory"
2020 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2021 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2022 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2023 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2024 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2025 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2026 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2027
2028 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2029 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2030 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2031 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2032 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2033 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2034 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2035 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2036
2037 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2038 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2039 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2040
2041
2042
2043 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2044 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2045 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2046 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2047 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2048 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2049 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2050 .code
2051 FULLECHO='' make -e
2052 .endd
2053 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2054 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2055 given in addition to the short output.
2056
2057
2058
2059 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2060 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2061 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2062 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2063 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2064 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2065 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2066 order:
2067 .display
2068 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2069 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2070 &_Local/Makefile_&
2071 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2072 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2073 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2074 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2075 .endd
2076 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2077 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2078 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2079 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2080 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2081 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2082 and are often not needed.
2083
2084 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2085 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2086 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2087 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2088 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2089 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2090 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2091 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2092 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2093
2094
2095 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2096 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2097 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2098 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2099 default values are.
2100
2101
2102 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2103 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2104 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2105 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2106 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2107 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2108 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2109 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2110 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2111 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2112 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2113 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2114 containing the lines
2115 .code
2116 CC=cc
2117 CFLAGS=-std1
2118 .endd
2119 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2120 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2121
2122 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2123 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2124 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2125
2126
2127 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2128 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2129 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2130 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2131 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2132 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2133 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2134 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2135 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2136 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2137 .code
2138 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2139 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2140 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2141 .endd
2142 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2143 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2144 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2145 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2146 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2147 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2148 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2149 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2150 errors.
2151
2152 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2153 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2154 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2155 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2156 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2157 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2158 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2159 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2160 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2161 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2162 syntax. For instance:
2163 .code
2164 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2165 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2166 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2167 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2168 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2169 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2170 .endd
2171
2172 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2173 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2174 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2175 .code
2176 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2177 .endd
2178 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2179 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2180
2181 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2182 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2183 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2184 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2185 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2186 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2187 .code
2188 X11=/usr/X11R6
2189 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2190 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2191 .endd
2192 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2193 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2194 .code
2195 X11=/usr/openwin
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2198 .endd
2199 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2200 definition of all three of these variables into your
2201 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2202
2203 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2204 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2205 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2206 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2207 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2208
2209 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2210 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2211 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2212 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2213 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2214 libraries.
2215
2216 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2217 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2218 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2219 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2220 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2221
2222
2223 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2224 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2225 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2226 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2227 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2228 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2229 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2230 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2231
2232
2233
2234 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2235 .cindex "building Eximon"
2236 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2237 where the files that are involved are
2238 .display
2239 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2240 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2241 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2242 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2243 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2244 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2245 .endd
2246 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2247 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2248 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2249 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2250 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2251 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2252 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2253 .ecindex IIDbuex
2254
2255
2256 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2257 .cindex "installing Exim"
2258 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2259 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2260 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2261 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2262 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2263 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2264 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2265 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2266 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2267 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2268 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2269 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2270
2271 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2272 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2273 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2274 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2275 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2276 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2277 alternative files, no default is installed.
2278
2279 .cindex "system aliases file"
2280 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2281 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2282 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2283 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2284 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2285 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2286 and outputs a comment to the user.
2287
2288 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2289 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2290 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2291 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2292 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2293
2294 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2295 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2296 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2297 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2298 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2299 over SMTP.
2300
2301 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2302 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2303 command such as
2304 .code
2305 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2306 .endd
2307 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2308 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2309 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2310 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2311 but this usage is deprecated.
2312
2313 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2314 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2315 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2316 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2317 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2318 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2319
2320 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2321 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2322 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2323 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2324 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2325 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2326 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2327
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2329 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2330 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2331 command:
2332 .code
2333 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2334 .endd
2335 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2336 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2337 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2338 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2339 command:
2340 .code
2341 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2342 .endd
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2344 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2345
2346 .ilist
2347 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2348 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2349 .next
2350 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2351 installed binary.
2352 .endlist
2353
2354 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2355 .code
2356 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2357 .endd
2358 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2359 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2360 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2361 .code
2362 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2363 .endd
2364
2365
2366
2367 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2368 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2369 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2370 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2371 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2372 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2373
2374 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2375 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2376 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2377
2378
2379
2380 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2381 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2382 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2383 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2384 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2385 necessary.
2386
2387
2388
2389
2390 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2391 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2392 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2393 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2394 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2395 .code
2396 exim -bV
2397 .endd
2398 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2399 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2400 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2401 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2402 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2403 example,
2404 .display
2405 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2406 .endd
2407 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2408 .display
2409 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2410 .endd
2411 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2412 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2413 user agent. For example:
2414 .code
2415 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2416 From: user@your.domain.example
2417 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2418 Subject: Testing Exim
2419
2420 This is a test message.
2421 ^D
2422 .endd
2423 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2424 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2425 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2426
2427 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2428 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2429 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2430 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2431 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2432 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2433 .display
2434 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2435 .endd
2436 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2437 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2438 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2439 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2440 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2441
2442 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2443 .cindex "lock files"
2444 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2445 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2446 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2447 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2448 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2449 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2450 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2451 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2452 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2453 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2454 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2455 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2456
2457 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2458 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2459 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2460 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2461 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2462 incoming SMTP mail.
2463
2464 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2465 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2466 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2467 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2468 production version.
2469
2470
2471 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2472 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2473 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2474 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2475 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2476 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2477 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2478 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2479 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2480 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2481 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2482 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2483 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2484
2485 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2486 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2487 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2488 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2489 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2490 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2491 as follows:
2492 .code
2493 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2494 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2495 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2496 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2497 .endd
2498 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2499 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2500 favourite user agent.
2501
2502 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2503 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2504 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2505 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2506 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2507 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2508
2509
2510
2511 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2512 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2513 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2514 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2515 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2516 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2517 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2518 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2519 configuration file.
2520
2521
2522
2523
2524 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2525 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2526 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2527 .code
2528 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2529 .endd
2530 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2531 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2532 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2533 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2534 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2535 .code
2536 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2537 .endd
2538 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2539
2540 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2541 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2542 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2543
2544
2545
2546
2547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2549
2550 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2551 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2552 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2553 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2554 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2555 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2556 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2557 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2558 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2559
2560
2561 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2562 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2563 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2564 were present before any other options.
2565 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2566 standard output.
2567 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2568 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2569 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2570
2571 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2572 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2573 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2574 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2575 format.
2576
2577 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2578 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2579 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2580 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2581
2582 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2583 .cindex "queue runner"
2584 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2585 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2586 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2587
2588 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2589 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2590 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2592 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2593 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2594 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2595 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2596
2597
2598 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2599 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2600 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2601 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2602 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2603 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2604
2605 .ilist
2606 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2607 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2608 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2609 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2610 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2611 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2612
2613 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2614 .cindex "envelope sender"
2615 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2616 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2617 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2618 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2619 users to set envelope senders.
2620
2621 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2622 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2623 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2624 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2625 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2626 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2627 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2628
2629 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2630 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2631 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2632 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2633 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2634 that are available to trusted users.
2635 .next
2636 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2637 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2638 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2639 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2640 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2641
2642 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2643 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2644 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2645 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2646
2647 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2648 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2649 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2650 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2651
2652 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2653 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2654 false.
2655 .endlist
2656
2657
2658 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2659 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2660 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2661 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2662
2663
2664
2665
2666 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2667 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2668 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2669 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2670 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2671 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2672 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2673 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2674
2675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2676 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2677 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2678 . creates a man page for the options.
2679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2680
2681 .literal xml
2682 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2683 .literal off
2684
2685
2686 .vlist
2687 .vitem &%--%&
2688 .oindex "--"
2689 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2690 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2691 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2692 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2693
2694 .vitem &%--help%&
2695 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2696 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2697 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2698 no arguments.
2699
2700 .vitem &%--version%&
2701 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2702 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2703 displayed.
2704
2705 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2706 &%-Am%&
2707 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2708 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2709 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2710 ignored by Exim.
2711
2712 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2713 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2714 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2715 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2716 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2717 clean; it ignores this option.
2718
2719 .vitem &%-bd%&
2720 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2721 .cindex "daemon"
2722 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2723 .cindex "queue runner"
2724 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2725 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2726 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2727
2728 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2729 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2730 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2731 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2732
2733 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2734 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2735 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2736 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2737
2738 When a listening daemon
2739 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2740 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2741 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2742 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2743 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2744 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2745 running as root.
2746
2747 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2748 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2749 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2750
2751 The SIGHUP signal
2752 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2753 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2754 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2755 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2756 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2757 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2758 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2759 because these are reread each time they are used.
2760
2761 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2762 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2763 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2764 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2765
2766 .vitem &%-be%&
2767 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2768 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2769 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2770 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2771 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2772 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2773 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2774
2775 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2776 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2777 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2778 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2779 test data. A line history is supported.
2780
2781 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2782 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2783 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2784 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2785 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2786 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2787 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2788
2789 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2790 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2791 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2792 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2793
2794 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2795 defined and macros will be expanded.
2796 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2797 available to admin users.
2798
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2805 .code
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807 .endd
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815 &%-be%&).
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2824
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835 supplied.
2836
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840 .code
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842 .endd
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847 .code
2848 # Exim filter
2849 # Sieve filter
2850 .endd
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854 redirection lists.
2855
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869 options).
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876 &$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890 prefix.
2891
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 suffix.
2897
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2909 .code
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912 .endd
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924 &*Warning 1*&:
2925 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929 connection.
2930
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2941
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957 .vitem &%-bi%&
2958 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966 recognized.
2967
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002 .vitem &%-bm%&
3003 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024 The format
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032 .code
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035 .endd
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3053 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3054 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3055 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3056 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3057 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3058 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3059
3060 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3061 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3062 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3063 This option requires admin privileges.
3064
3065 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3066 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3067 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3068
3069 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3070 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3071 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3072 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3073 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3074 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3075 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3076 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3077 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3078
3079 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3080 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3081 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3082 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3083 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3084
3085 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3086 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3087 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3088 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3089
3090
3091 .vitem &%-bP%&
3092 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3093 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3094 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3095 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3096 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3097 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3098 arguments, for example:
3099 .code
3100 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3101 .endd
3102 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3103 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3104 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3105 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3106 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3107 users, the output is as in this example:
3108 .code
3109 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3110 .endd
3111 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3112 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3113
3114 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3115 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3116 backward compatibility.)
3117 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3118 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3119
3120 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3121 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3122 name will not be output.
3123
3124 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3125 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3126 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3127 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3128 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3129 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3130 written directly into the spool directory.
3131
3132 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3133 .code
3134 exim -bP +local_domains
3135 .endd
3136 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3137 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3138
3139 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3141 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3142 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3143 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3144 that driver are output. For example:
3145 .code
3146 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3147 .endd
3148 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3149 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3150 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3151 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3152 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3153 &%authenticators%&.
3154
3155 .cindex "environment"
3156 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3157 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3158 variables.
3159
3160 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3161 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3162 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3163 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3164 The output format is one item per line.
3165
3166 .vitem &%-bp%&
3167 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3168 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3169 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3170 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3171 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3172 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3173 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3174 to allow any user to see the queue.
3175
3176 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3177 .code
3178 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3179 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3180 <other addresses>
3181 .endd
3182 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3183 .cindex "size" "of message"
3184 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3185 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3186 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3187 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3188 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3189 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3190 before the sender address.
3191
3192 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3193 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3194 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3195
3196 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3197 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3198 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3199 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3200 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3201 complete.
3202
3203
3204 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3205 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3206 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3207 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3208 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3209 of just &"D"&.
3210
3211
3212 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3213 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3214 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3215 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3216 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3217 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3218
3219
3220 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3221 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3222 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3223 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3224 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3225 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3226
3227 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3228 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3229 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3230
3231 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3232 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3233 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3234
3235
3236 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3237 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3238 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3239 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3240 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3241 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3242
3243
3244 .vitem &%-brt%&
3245 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3246 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3247 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3248 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3249 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3250 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3251 .code
3252 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3253 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3254 .endd
3255 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3256 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3257 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3258 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3259 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3260 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3261 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3262 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3263 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3264 .code
3265 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3266 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3267 .endd
3268
3269 .vitem &%-brw%&
3270 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3271 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3272 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3273 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3274 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3275 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3276 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3277 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3278
3279 .vitem &%-bS%&
3280 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3281 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3282 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3283 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3284 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3285 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3286 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3287 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3288 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3289 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3290
3291 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3292 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3293 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3294
3295 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3296 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3297 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3298 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3299
3300 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3301 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3302 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3303
3304 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3305 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3306 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3307 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3308 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3309
3310 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3311 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3312
3313 .vitem &%-bs%&
3314 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3315 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3316 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3317 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3318 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3319 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3320 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3321 messages to the MTA.
3322
3323 In
3324 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3325 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3326 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3327 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3328 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3329 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3330 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3331
3332 .cindex "inetd"
3333 The
3334 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3335 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3336 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3337 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3338 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3339 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3340 the listening daemon.
3341
3342 .vitem &%-bt%&
3343 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3344 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3345 .cindex "address" "testing"
3346 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3347 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3348 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3349 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3350 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3351
3352 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3353 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3354
3355 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3356 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3357 security issues.
3358
3359 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3360 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3361 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3362 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3363 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3364 program.
3365
3366 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3367 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3368 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3369 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3370
3371 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3372 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3373 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3374 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3375 always shown.
3376
3377 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3378 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3379 message,
3380 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3381 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3382 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3383 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3384 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3385 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3386 doing such tests.
3387
3388 .vitem &%-bV%&
3389 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3390 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3391 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3392 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3393 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3394 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3395 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3396
3397 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3398 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3399 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3400 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3401 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3402 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3403 dynamic testing facilities.
3404
3405 .vitem &%-bv%&
3406 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3407 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3408 .cindex "address" "verification"
3409 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3410 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3411 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3412 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3413 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3414 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3415
3416 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3417 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3418 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3419
3420 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3421 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3422
3423 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3424 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3425 security issues.
3426
3427 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3428 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3429 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3430 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3431 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3432
3433 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3434 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3435 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3436 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3437 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3438 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3439 to succeed.
3440
3441 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3442 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3443 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3444
3445 The
3446 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3447 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3448 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3449 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3450
3451 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3452 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3453 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3454 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3455
3456 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3457 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3458 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3459 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3460 might happen.
3461
3462 .vitem &%-bw%&
3463 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3464 .cindex "daemon"
3465 .cindex "inetd"
3466 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3467 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3468 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3469 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3470
3471 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3472 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3473 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3474 each port only when the first connection is received.
3475
3476 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3477 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3478
3479 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3480 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3481 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3482 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3483 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3484 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3485 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3486 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3487 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3488 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3489 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3490
3491 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3492 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3493 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3494 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3495 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3496 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3497 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3498 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3499 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3500
3501 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3502 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3503 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3504 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3505 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3506 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3507 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3508
3509 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3510 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3511 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3512 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3513 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3514 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3515 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3516
3517 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3518 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3519 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3520 configuration file.
3521
3522 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3523 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3524 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3525 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3526 specified by this option.
3527
3528
3529 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3530 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3531 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3532 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3533 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3534 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3535 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3536 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3537
3538 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3539 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3540 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3541 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3542 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3543 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3544 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3545
3546 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3547 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3548 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3549 synonymous:
3550 .code
3551 exim -DABC ...
3552 exim -DABC= ...
3553 .endd
3554 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3555 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3556 example:
3557 .code
3558 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3559 .endd
3560 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3561 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3562
3563
3564 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3565 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3566 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3567 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3568 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3569 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3570 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3571 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3572 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3573 return code.
3574
3575 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3576 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3577 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3578 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3579 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3580 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3581 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3582 are:
3583 .display
3584 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3585 &`auth `& authenticators
3586 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3587 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3588 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3589 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3590 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3591 &`filter `& filter handling
3592 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3593 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3594 &`ident `& ident lookup
3595 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3596 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3597 &`load `& system load checks
3598 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3599 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3600 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3601 &`memory `& memory handling
3602 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3603 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3604 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3605 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3606 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3607 &`retry `& retry handling
3608 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3609 &`route `& address routing
3610 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3611 &`tls `& TLS logic
3612 &`transport `& transports
3613 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3614 &`verify `& address verification logic
3615 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3616 .endd
3617 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3618 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3619 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3620 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3621 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3622 turn everything off.
3623
3624 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3625 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3626 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3627 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3628 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3629 rather than stderr.
3630
3631 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3632 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3633 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3634 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3635 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3636 run in parallel.
3637
3638 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3639 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3640 in processing.
3641
3642 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3643 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3644
3645 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3646 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3647 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3648 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3649 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3650 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3651
3652 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3653 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3654 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3655 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3656 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3657
3658 .vitem &%-E%&
3659 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3660 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3661 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3662 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3663 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3664 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3665 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3666 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3667 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3668
3669 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3670 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3671 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3672 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3673 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3674 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3675
3676 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3677 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3678 .cindex "sender" "name"
3679 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3680 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3681 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3682 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3683 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3684 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3685
3686 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3687 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3688 .cindex "sender" "address"
3689 .cindex "address" "sender"
3690 .cindex "trusted users"
3691 .cindex "envelope sender"
3692 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3693 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3694 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3695 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3696 users to use it.
3697
3698 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3699 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3700 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3701 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3702 domain.
3703
3704 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3705 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3706 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3707 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3708 examples of shell commands:
3709 .code
3710 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3711 exim -f "" user@domain
3712 .endd
3713 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3714 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3715 &%-bv%& options.
3716
3717 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3718 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3719 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3720 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3721
3722 White
3723 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3724 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3725 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3726 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3727 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3728 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3729
3730 .vitem &%-G%&
3731 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3732 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3733 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3734 .code
3735 control = suppress_local_fixups
3736 .endd
3737 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3738 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3739 in future.
3740
3741 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3742 this option.
3743
3744 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3745 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3746 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3747 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3748 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3749 headers.)
3750
3751 .vitem &%-i%&
3752 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3753 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3754 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3755 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3756 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3757 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3758 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3759
3760 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3761 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3762 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3763 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3764 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3765 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3766 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3767 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3768
3769 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3770
3771 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3772 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3773 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3774 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3775 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3776 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3777 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3778 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3779 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3780
3781 Retry
3782 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3783 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3784 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3785 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3786 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3787 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3788
3789 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3790 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3791 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3792 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3793
3794 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3795 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3796 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3797 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3798 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3799 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3800 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3801 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3802 can be used only by an admin user.
3803
3804 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3805 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3806 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3807 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3808 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3809 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3810 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3811 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3812 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3813 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3814 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3815
3816 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3817 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3818 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3819 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3820 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3821
3822 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3823 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3824 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3825 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3826 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3827
3828 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3829 .oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3830 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3831 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3832 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3833
3834 .vitem &%-MCK%&
3835 .oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3836 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3837 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3838 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3839
3840 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3841 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3842 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3843 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3844 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3845
3846 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3847 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3848 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3849 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3850 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3851 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3852 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3853 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3854
3855 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3856 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3857 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3858 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3859 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3860 connection.
3861
3862 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3863 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3864 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3865 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3866 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3867
3868 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3869 .oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3870 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3871 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3872 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3873 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3874
3875 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3876 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3877 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3878 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3879 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3880 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3881 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3882 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3883 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3884 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3885 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3886 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3887 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3888 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3889 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3890
3891 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3892 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3893 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3894 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3895 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3896 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3897 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3898 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3899 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3900 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3901
3902 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3903 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3904 .cindex "freezing messages"
3905 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3906 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3907 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3908 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3909 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3910 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3911 user.
3912
3913 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3914 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3915 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3916 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3917 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3918 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3919 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3920 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3921 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3922 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3923 user.
3924
3925 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3926 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3927 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3928 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3929 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3930 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3931 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3932
3933 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3934 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3935 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3936 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3937 .cindex "removing recipients"
3938 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3939 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3940 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3941 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3942 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3943 can be used only by an admin user.
3944
3945 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3946 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3947 .cindex "removing messages"
3948 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3949 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3950 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3951 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3952 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3953 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3954 placed on the queue.
3955
3956 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3957 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3958 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3959 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3960 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3961 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3962 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3963 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3964 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3965 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3966 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3967
3968 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3969 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3970 .cindex "thawing messages"
3971 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3972 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3973 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3974 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3975 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3976 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3977 by an admin user.
3978
3979 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3980 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3981 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3982 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3983 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3984 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985
3986 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3987 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3988 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3989 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3990 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3991 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3992 only by an admin user.
3993
3994 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3995 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3996 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3997 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3998 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3999 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4000 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4001
4002 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4003 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4004 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4005 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4006 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4007 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4008
4009 .vitem &%-m%&
4010 .oindex "&%-m%&"
4011 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4012 treats it that way too.
4013
4014 .vitem &%-N%&
4015 .oindex "&%-N%&"
4016 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4017 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4018 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4019 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4020 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4021 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4022 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4023 than &"=>"&.
4024
4025 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4026 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4027 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4028 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4029 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4030 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4031 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4032 for that message.
4033
4034 .vitem &%-n%&
4035 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4036 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4037 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4038 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4039 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4040
4041 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4042 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4043 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4044 Exim.
4045
4046 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4047 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4048 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4049 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4050 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4051 description above.
4052
4053 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4054 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4055 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4056 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4057 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4058 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4059 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4060 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4061
4062 .vitem &%-odb%&
4063 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4064 .cindex "background delivery"
4065 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4066 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4067 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4068 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4069 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4070 processes to finish.
4071
4072 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4073 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4074 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4075 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4076
4077 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4078 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4079 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4080 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4081
4082 .vitem &%-odf%&
4083 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4084 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4085 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4086 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4087 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4088 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4089 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4090
4091 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4092 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4093 during deliveries.
4094
4095 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4096 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4097
4098 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4099 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4100 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4101 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4102
4103
4104 .vitem &%-odi%&
4105 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4106 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4107 Sendmail.
4108
4109 .vitem &%-odq%&
4110 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4111 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4112 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4113 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4114 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4115 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4116 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4117 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4118 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4119 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4120 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4121 forces queueing.
4122
4123 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4124 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4125 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4126 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4127 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4128 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4129 configuration file is in effect.
4130
4131 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4132 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4133 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4134 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4135 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4136 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4137 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4138 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4139 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4140 &%-qq%& option.
4141
4142 .vitem &%-oee%&
4143 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4144 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4145 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4146 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4147 message.
4148
4149 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4150 Provided
4151 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4152 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4153 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4154 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4155
4156 .vitem &%-oem%&
4157 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4158 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4159 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4160 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4161 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4162 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4163
4164 .vitem &%-oep%&
4165 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4166 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4167 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4168 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4169 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4170 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4171
4172 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4173 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4174 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4175 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4176 effect as &%-oep%&.
4177
4178 .vitem &%-oew%&
4179 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4180 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4181 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4182 effect as &%-oem%&.
4183
4184 .vitem &%-oi%&
4185 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4186 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4187 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4188 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4189 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4190 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4191 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4192
4193 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4194 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4195 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4196
4197 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4198 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4199 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4200 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4201 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4202 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4203 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4204 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4205
4206 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4207 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4208 .code
4209 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4210 .endd
4211 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4212 followed by a colon and the port number:
4213 .code
4214 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4215 .endd
4216 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4217 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4218 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4219 whichever one is last.
4220
4221 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4222 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4223 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4224 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4225 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4226 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4227 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4228 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4229
4230 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4231 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4232 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4233 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4234 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4235 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4236 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4237 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4238
4239 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4240 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4241 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4242 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4243 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4244 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4245 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4246 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4247 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4248 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4249
4250 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4251 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4252 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4253 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4254 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4255 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4256 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4257
4258 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4259 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4260 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4261 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4262 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4263 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4264 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4265 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4266 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4267
4268 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4269 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4270 is sending the bounce.
4271
4272 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4273 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4274 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4275 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4276 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4277 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4278 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4279 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4280 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4281 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4282 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4283 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4284
4285 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4286 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4287 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4288 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4289 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4290 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4291 uses the name it is given.
4292
4293 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4294 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4295 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4296 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4297 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4298 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4299 used, when there is no default.
4300
4301 .vitem &%-om%&
4302 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4303 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4304 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4305 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4306 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4307
4308 .vitem &%-oo%&
4309 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4310 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4311 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4312 whatever that means.
4313
4314 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4315 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4316 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4317 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4318 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4319 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4320 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4321 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4322 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4323
4324 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4325 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4326 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4327 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4328 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4329 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4330 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4331
4332 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4333 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4334 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4335 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4336 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4337 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4338 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4339 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4340
4341 .vitem &%-ov%&
4342 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4343 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4344
4345 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4346 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4347 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4348 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4349 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4350 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4351 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4352 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4353 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4354 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4355
4356 .vitem &%-pd%&
4357 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4358 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4359 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4360 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4361 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4362 needed.
4363
4364 .vitem &%-ps%&
4365 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4366 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4367 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4368 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4369 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4370 started.
4371
4372 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4373 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4374 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4375 .display
4376 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4377 .endd
4378 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4379 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4380 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4381 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4382 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4383 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4384
4385 .vitem &%-q%&
4386 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4387 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4388 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4389 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4390 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4391 and &%-S%& options).
4392
4393 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4394 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4395 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4396 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4397 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4398 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4399 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4400
4401 If
4402 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4403 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4404 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4405 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4406 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4407 proceeding.
4408
4409 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4410 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4411 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4412 this to be repeated periodically.
4413
4414 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4415 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4416 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4417 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4418
4419 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4420 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4421 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4422
4423 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4424 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4425 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4426 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4427
4428 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4429 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4430 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4431 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4432 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4433 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4434 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4435 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4436 transports are run.
4437
4438 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4439 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4440 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4441 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4442 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4443 delivered down a single SMTP
4444 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4445 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4446 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4447 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4448 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4449 intermittently.
4450
4451 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4452 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4453 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4454 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4455 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4456 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4457 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4458
4459 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4460 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4461 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4462 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4463 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4464 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4465 their retry times are tried.
4466
4467 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4468 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4469 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4470 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4471 frozen or not.
4472
4473 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4474 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4475 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4476 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4477 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4478 for later delivery.
4479
4480 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4481 .oindex "&%-qG%&"
4482 .cindex queue named
4483 .cindex "named queues"
4484 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4485 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4486 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4487 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4488 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4489 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4490
4491 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4492 will specify a queue to operate on.
4493 For example:
4494 .code
4495 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4496 mailq -qGquarantine
4497 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4498 .endd
4499
4500 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4501 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4502 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4503 starting message id. For example:
4504 .code
4505 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4506 .endd
4507 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4508 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4509 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4510 .code
4511 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4512 .endd
4513 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4514 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4515 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4516 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4517 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4518 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4519
4520 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4521 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4522 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4523 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4524 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4525 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4526 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4527 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4528 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4529 .code
4530 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4531 .endd
4532 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4533 process every 30 minutes.
4534
4535 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4536 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4537
4538 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4539 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4540 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4541 compatibility.
4542
4543 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4544 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4545 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4546
4547 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4548 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4549 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4550 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4551 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4552 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4553 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4554 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4555 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4556
4557 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4558 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4559 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4560 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4561 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4562 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4563
4564 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4565 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4566 .code
4567 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4568 .endd
4569 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4570 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4571 applied to each queue run.
4572
4573 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4574 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4575 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4576 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4577 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4578 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4579 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4580 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4581 address will be skipped.
4582
4583 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4584 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4585 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4586 &'ff'& is present.
4587
4588 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4589 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4590 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4591 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4592 an arbitrary command instead.
4593
4594 .vitem &%-r%&
4595 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4596 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4597
4598 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4599 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4600 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4601 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4602 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4603 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4604 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4605 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4606
4607 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4608 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4609 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4610 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4611 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4612
4613 .vitem &%-t%&
4614 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4615 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4616 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4617 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4618 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4619 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4620 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4621 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4622 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4623 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4624
4625 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4626 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4627 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4628 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4629 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4630 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4631 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4632 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4633 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4634 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4635 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4636
4637 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4638 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4639 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4640 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4641 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4642 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4643
4644 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4645 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4646 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4647 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4648 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4649 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4650 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4651 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4652 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4653
4654 .vitem &%-ti%&
4655 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4656 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4657 compatibility with Sendmail.
4658
4659 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4660 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4661 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4662 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4663 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4664 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4665 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4666 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4667
4668
4669 .vitem &%-U%&
4670 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4671 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4672 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4673 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4674 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4675 set. Exim ignores this option.
4676
4677 .vitem &%-v%&
4678 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4679 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4680 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4681 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4682 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4683 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4684 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4685 unconditional.
4686
4687 .vitem &%-x%&
4688 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4689 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4690 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4691 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4692 this option.
4693
4694 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4695 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4696 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4697 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4698
4699 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4700 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4701 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4702 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4703 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4704 under most shells.
4705 .endlist
4706
4707 .ecindex IIDclo1
4708 .ecindex IIDclo2
4709
4710
4711 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4712 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4713 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4714 . creates a man page for the options.
4715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4716
4717 .literal xml
4718 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4719 .literal off
4720
4721
4722
4723
4724
4725 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4726 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4727
4728
4729 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4730 "The runtime configuration file"
4731
4732 .cindex "run time configuration"
4733 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4734 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4735 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4736 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4737 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4738 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4739 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4740 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4741 control.
4742
4743 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4744 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4745 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4746 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4747 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4748 actually alter the string.
4749
4750 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4751 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4752 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4753 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4754 existing file in the list.
4755
4756 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4757 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4758 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4759 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4760 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4761 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4762 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4763 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4764 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4765 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4766 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4767
4768 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4769 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4770 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4771 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4772 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4773
4774 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4775 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4776 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4777 compromise the Exim user account.
4778
4779 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4780 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4781 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4782 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4783 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4784 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4785 configuration.
4786
4787
4788
4789 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4790 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4791 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4792 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4793 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4794 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4795 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4796 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4797 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4798 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4799 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4800
4801 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4802 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4803 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4804 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4805 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4806 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4807 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4808 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4809 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4810 &%-M%&).
4811
4812 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4813 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4814 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4815 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4816 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4817
4818 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4819 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4820 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4821 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4822 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4823 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4824
4825 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4826 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4827 necessarily be discarded.
4828 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4829 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4830 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4831 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4832 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4833 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4834
4835 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4836 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4837 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4838 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4839 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4840 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4841 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4842
4843 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4844 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4845 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4846
4847
4848
4849 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4850 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4851 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4852 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4853 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4854 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4855 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4856 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4857
4858 .ilist
4859 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4860 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4861 .next
4862 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4863 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4864 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4865 .next
4866 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4867 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4868 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4869 .next
4870 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4871 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4872 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4873 .next
4874 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4875 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4876 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4877 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4878 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4879 .next
4880 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4881 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4882 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4883 .next
4884 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4885 want to use this feature, you must set
4886 .code
4887 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4888 .endd
4889 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4890 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4891 .endlist
4892
4893 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4894 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4895 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4896 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4897
4898 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4899 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4900 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4901 and does not introduce a comment.
4902
4903 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4904 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4905 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4906 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4907 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4908
4909 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4910 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4911 change settings as required.
4912
4913 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4914 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4915 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4916 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4917 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4918 described.
4919
4920
4921
4922 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4923 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4924 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4925 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4926 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4927 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4928 using this syntax:
4929 .display
4930 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4931 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4932 .endd
4933 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4934 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4935 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4936 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4937 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4938 name is required.
4939
4940 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4941 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4942 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4943 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4944
4945 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4946 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4947 for example:
4948 .code
4949 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4950 .include /some/file
4951 .endd
4952 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4953 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4954 inclusion appears.
4955
4956
4957
4958 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4959 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4960 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4961 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4962 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4963 definition, and must be of the form
4964 .display
4965 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4966 .endd
4967 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4968 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4969 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4970 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4971 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4972
4973 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4974 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4975 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4976
4977 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4978 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4979 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4980 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4981 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4982 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4983 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4984 define
4985 .display
4986 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4987 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4988 .endd
4989 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4990 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4991 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4992 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4993 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4994 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4995
4996
4997 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4998 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4999 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5000 &'='&. For example:
5001 .code
5002 MAC = initial value
5003 ...
5004 MAC == updated value
5005 .endd
5006 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5007 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5008 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5009 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5010 .code
5011 MAC = initial value
5012 ...
5013 MAC == MAC and something added
5014 .endd
5015 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5016 from a number of other files.
5017
5018 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5019 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5020 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5021 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5022 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5023 file to be ignored.
5024
5025
5026
5027 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5028 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5029 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5030 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5031 .code
5032 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5033 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5034 .endd
5035 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5036 .code
5037 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5038 .endd
5039 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5040 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5041 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5042
5043
5044 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5045 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5046 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5047 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5048 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5049 (see below).
5050
5051 The following classes of macros are defined:
5052 .display
5053 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5054 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5055 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5056 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5057 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5058 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5059 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5060 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5061 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5062 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5063 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5064 .endd
5065
5066 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5067
5068
5069 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5070 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5071 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5072 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5073 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5074 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5075 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5076
5077 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5078 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5079 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5080 line. Thus:
5081 .code
5082 .ifdef AAA
5083 message_size_limit = 50M
5084 .else
5085 message_size_limit = 100M
5086 .endif
5087 .endd
5088 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5089 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5090 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5091 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5092 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5093
5094 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5095 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5096 in this line"& will always be true.
5097
5098 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5099 to clarify complicated nestings.
5100
5101
5102
5103 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5104 .cindex "common option syntax"
5105 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5106 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5107 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5108 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5109 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5110 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5111 space) and then the value. For example:
5112 .code
5113 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5114 .endd
5115 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5116 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5117 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5118 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5119 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5120 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5121 word &"hide"&. For example:
5122 .code
5123 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5124 .endd
5125 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5126 .code
5127 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5128 .endd
5129 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5130 all instances of the same driver.
5131
5132 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5133 that are found in option settings.
5134
5135
5136 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5137 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5138 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5139 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5140 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5141 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5142 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5143 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5144 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5145 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5146 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5147 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5148 .code
5149 queue_only
5150 queue_only = true
5151 .endd
5152 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5153 .code
5154 no_queue_only
5155 queue_only = false
5156 .endd
5157 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5158
5159
5160
5161
5162 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5163 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5164 .cindex "format" "integer"
5165 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5166 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5167 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5168 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5169 hexadecimal number.
5170
5171 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5172 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5173 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5174 When the values
5175 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5176 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5177 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5178 used.
5179
5180
5181 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5182 .cindex "integer format"
5183 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5184 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5185 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5186 Such options are always output in octal.
5187
5188
5189 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5190 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5191 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5192 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5193 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5194
5195
5196
5197 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5198 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5199 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5200 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5201 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5202
5203 .table2 30pt
5204 .irow &%s%& seconds
5205 .irow &%m%& minutes
5206 .irow &%h%& hours
5207 .irow &%d%& days
5208 .irow &%w%& weeks
5209 .endtable
5210
5211 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5212 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5213 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5214
5215
5216
5217 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5218 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5219 .cindex "format" "string"
5220 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5221 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5222 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5223 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5224 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5225 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5226 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5227 therefore equivalent:
5228 .code
5229 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5230 trusted_users = uucp:\
5231 # This comment line is ignored
5232 mail
5233 .endd
5234 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5235 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5236 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5237 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5238 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5239
5240 .table2 100pt
5241 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5242 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5243 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5244 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5245 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5246 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5247 character"
5248 .endtable
5249
5250 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5251 character, that character replaces the pair.
5252
5253 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5254 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5255 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5256 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5257 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5258 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5259
5260
5261 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5262 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5263 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5264 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5265 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5266 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5267 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5268 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5269 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5270 within a quoted configuration string.
5271
5272
5273 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5274 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5275 .cindex "format" "user name"
5276 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5277 .cindex "format" "group name"
5278 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5279 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5280 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5281 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5282
5283
5284 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5285 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5286 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5287 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5288 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5289 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5290 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5291 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5292 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5293 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5294 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5295
5296 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5297 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5298 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5299 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5300 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5301 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5302 example, the list
5303 .code
5304 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5305 .endd
5306 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5307
5308 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5309 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5310 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5311 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5312
5313 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5314 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5315 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5316 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5317 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5318 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5319 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5320 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5321 .code
5322 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5323 .endd
5324 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5325 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5326 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5327
5328 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5329 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5330 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5331 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5332 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5333 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5334 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5335 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5336 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5337 .code
5338 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5339 .endd
5340 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5341 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5342 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5343 the value in quotes. For example:
5344 .code
5345 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5346 .endd
5347 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5348 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5349 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5350 enclosing an empty list item.
5351
5352
5353
5354 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5355 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5356 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5357 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5358 .code
5359 senders = user@domain :
5360 .endd
5361 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5362 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5363 items, the second of which is empty:
5364 .code
5365 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5366 .endd
5367 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5368 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5369 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5370 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5371 .code
5372 senders = :
5373 .endd
5374 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5375 is at the end of the list.
5376
5377
5378
5379
5380 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5381 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5382 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5383 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5384 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5385 a sequence of lines like this:
5386 .display
5387 <&'instance name'&>:
5388 <&'option'&>
5389 ...
5390 <&'option'&>
5391 .endd
5392 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5393 followed by three options settings:
5394 .code
5395 localuser:
5396 driver = accept
5397 check_local_user
5398 transport = local_delivery
5399 .endd
5400 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5401 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5402 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5403 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5404 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5405 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5406
5407 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5408 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5409
5410 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5411 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5412 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5413 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5414 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5415 server.
5416
5417 .cindex "generic options"
5418 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5419 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5420 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5421 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5422 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5423 .cindex "private options"
5424 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5425 they all have default values.
5426
5427 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5428 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5429 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5430
5431 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5432 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5433 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5434 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5435 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5436 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5437 configuration lines:
5438 .code
5439 remote_smtp:
5440 driver = smtp
5441 .endd
5442 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5443 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5444 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5445 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5446 thus:
5447 .code
5448 special_smtp:
5449 driver = smtp
5450 port = 1234
5451 command_timeout = 10s
5452 .endd
5453 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5454 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5455 lines.
5456
5457 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5458 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5459 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5460 option.
5461
5462
5463
5464
5465
5466
5467 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5468 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5469
5470 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5471 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5472 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5473 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5474 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5475 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5476 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5477 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5478 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5479 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5480 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5481
5482
5483
5484 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5485 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5486 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5487 the line
5488 .code
5489 # primary_hostname =
5490 .endd
5491 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5492 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5493 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5494 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5495
5496 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5497 .code
5498 domainlist local_domains = @
5499 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5500 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5501 .endd
5502 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5503 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5504 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5505 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5506
5507 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5508 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5509 on the local host.
5510
5511 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5512 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5513 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5514 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5515 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5516 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5517
5518 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5519 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5520 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5521 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5522 domain is permitted.
5523
5524 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5525 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5526 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5527 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5528 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5529 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5530
5531 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5532 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5533 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5534
5535 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5536 .code
5537 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5538 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5539 .endd
5540 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5541 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5542 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5543 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5544 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5545 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5546 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5547 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5548 contents of a message to be checked.
5549
5550 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5551 .code
5552 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5553 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5554 .endd
5555 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5556 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5557 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5558 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5559
5560 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5561 .code
5562 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5563 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5564 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5565 .endd
5566 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5567 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5568 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5569 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5570 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5571 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5572 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5573
5574 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5575 .code
5576 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5577 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5578 .endd
5579 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5580 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5581 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5582 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5583 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5584 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5585 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5586 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5587 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5588 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5589 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5590 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5591 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5592 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5593 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5594 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5595 consequences).
5596 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5597 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5598 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5599 which should be used in preference to 587.
5600 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5601 these ports.
5602 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5603
5604 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5605 .code
5606 # qualify_domain =
5607 # qualify_recipient =
5608 .endd
5609 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5610 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5611 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5612 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5613 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5614 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5615
5616 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5617 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5618 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5619 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5620 .code
5621 # allow_domain_literals
5622 .endd
5623 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5624 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5625 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5626 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5627 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5628 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5629
5630 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5631 .code
5632 never_users = root
5633 .endd
5634 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5635 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5636 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5637 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5638 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5639 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5640 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5641 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5642
5643 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5644 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5645 line,
5646 .code
5647 host_lookup = *
5648 .endd
5649 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5650 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5651 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5652 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5653 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5654 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5655 unreachable.
5656
5657 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5658 1413 (hence their names):
5659 .code
5660 rfc1413_hosts = *
5661 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5662 .endd
5663 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5664 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5665 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5666 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5667 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5668 information, you can change this.
5669
5670 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5671 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5672 .code
5673 prdr_enable = true
5674 .endd
5675
5676 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5677 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5678 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5679 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5680 .code
5681 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5682 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5683 .endd
5684 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5685 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5686
5687 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5688 over the default:
5689 .code
5690 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5691 +tls_certificate_verified
5692 .endd
5693
5694 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5695 .code
5696 # percent_hack_domains =
5697 .endd
5698 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5699 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5700 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5701
5702 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5703 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5704 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5705 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5706 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5707 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5708 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5709 always bounce messages.
5710 .code
5711 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5712 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5713 .endd
5714 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5715 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5716 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5717 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5718 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5719
5720 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5721 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5722 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5723 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5724 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5725 not often needed).
5726 .code
5727 # split_spool_directory = true
5728 .endd
5729
5730 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5731 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5732 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5733 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5734 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5735 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5736 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5737 .code
5738 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5739 .endd
5740
5741 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5742 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5743 that are not 8-bit clean.
5744 .code
5745 # accept_8bitmime = false
5746 .endd
5747
5748 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5749 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5750 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5751 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5752 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5753 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5754 .code
5755 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5756 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5757 .endd
5758
5759
5760 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5761 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5762 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5763 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5764 It starts with the line
5765 .code
5766 begin acl
5767 .endd
5768 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5769 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5770 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5771
5772 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5773 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5774 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5775 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5776 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5777 result of the ACL processing.
5778 .code
5779 acl_check_rcpt:
5780 .endd
5781 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5782 ACL, and names it.
5783 .code
5784 accept hosts = :
5785 .endd
5786 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5787 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5788 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5789 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5790 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5791 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5792
5793 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5794 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5795 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5796 manner.
5797 .code
5798 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5799 domains = +local_domains
5800 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5801
5802 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5803 domains = !+local_domains
5804 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5805 .endd
5806 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5807 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5808 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5809 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5810 in Internet mail addresses.
5811
5812 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5813 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5814 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5815 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5816 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5817 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5818 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5819 policy of being as safe as possible.
5820
5821 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5822 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5823 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5824 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5825 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5826 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5827
5828 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5829 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5830 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5831 have to modify this rule.
5832
5833 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5834 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5835 common convention of local parts constructed as
5836 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5837 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5838 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5839 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5840 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5841 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5842
5843 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5844 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5845 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5846 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5847 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5848 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5849 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5850 .code
5851 accept local_parts = postmaster
5852 domains = +local_domains
5853 .endd
5854 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5855 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5856 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5857 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5858 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5859
5860 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5861 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5862 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5863 .code
5864 require verify = sender
5865 .endd
5866 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5867 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5868 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5869 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5870 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5871 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5872 discusses the details of address verification.
5873 .code
5874 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5875 control = submission
5876 .endd
5877 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5878 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5879 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5880 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5881 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5882 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5883 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5884 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5885 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5886 .code
5887 accept authenticated = *
5888 control = submission
5889 .endd
5890 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5891 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5892 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5893 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5894 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5895 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5896 .code
5897 require message = relay not permitted
5898 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5899 .endd
5900 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5901 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5902 .code
5903 require verify = recipient
5904 .endd
5905 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5906 fails, the address is rejected.
5907 .code
5908 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5909 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5910 # $dnslist_text
5911 # dnslists = black.list.example
5912 #
5913 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5914 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5915 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5916 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5917 .endd
5918 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5919 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5920 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5921 line.
5922 .code
5923 # require verify = csa
5924 .endd
5925 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5926 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5927 records.
5928 .code
5929 accept
5930 .endd
5931 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5932 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5933 .code
5934 acl_check_data:
5935 .endd
5936 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5937 of this ACL are commented out:
5938 .code
5939 # deny malware = *
5940 # message = This message contains a virus \
5941 # ($malware_name).
5942 .endd
5943 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5944 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5945 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5946 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5947 .code
5948 # warn spam = nobody
5949 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5950 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5951 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5952 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5953 .endd
5954 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5955 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5956 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5957 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5958 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5959 whatever the spam score.
5960 .code
5961 accept
5962 .endd
5963 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5964
5965
5966 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5967 .cindex "default" "routers"
5968 .cindex "routers" "default"
5969 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5970 by the line
5971 .code
5972 begin routers
5973 .endd
5974 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5975 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5976 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5977 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5978 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5979 .code
5980 # domain_literal:
5981 # driver = ipliteral
5982 # domains = !+local_domains
5983 # transport = remote_smtp
5984 .endd
5985 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5986 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5987 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5988 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5989 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5990 .code
5991 dnslookup:
5992 driver = dnslookup
5993 domains = ! +local_domains
5994 transport = remote_smtp
5995 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5996 no_more
5997 .endd
5998 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5999 domains. This is specified by the line
6000 .code
6001 domains = ! +local_domains
6002 .endd
6003 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6004 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6005 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6006 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6007 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6008 passed on to the following routers.
6009
6010 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6011 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6012 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6013 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6014 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6015
6016 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6017 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6018 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6019 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6020 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6021 the address fails and is bounced.
6022
6023 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6024 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6025 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6026 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6027 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6028 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6029 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6030 out.
6031 .code
6032 system_aliases:
6033 driver = redirect
6034 allow_fail
6035 allow_defer
6036 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6037 # user = exim
6038 file_transport = address_file
6039 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6040 .endd
6041 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6042 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6043 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6044 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6045 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6046 the next router.
6047
6048 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6049 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6050 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6051 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6052 .code
6053 userforward:
6054 driver = redirect
6055 check_local_user
6056 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6057 # local_part_suffix_optional
6058 file = $home/.forward
6059 # allow_filter
6060 no_verify
6061 no_expn
6062 check_ancestor
6063 file_transport = address_file
6064 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6065 reply_transport = address_reply
6066 .endd
6067 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6068 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6069 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6070 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6071 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6072 namely:
6073 .code
6074 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6075 # local_part_suffix_optional
6076 .endd
6077 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6078 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6079 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6080 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6081 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6082 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6083 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6084
6085 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6086 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6087 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6088 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6089
6090 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6091 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6092 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6093 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6094 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6095 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6096 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6097
6098 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6099 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6100 There are two reasons for doing this:
6101
6102 .olist
6103 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6104 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6105 unnecessary work.
6106 .next
6107 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6108 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6109 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6110 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6111 this time.
6112 .endlist
6113
6114 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6115 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6116 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6117 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6118
6119 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6120 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6121 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6122 .code
6123 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6124 .endd
6125 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6126 transport.
6127 .code
6128 localuser:
6129 driver = accept
6130 check_local_user
6131 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6132 # local_part_suffix_optional
6133 transport = local_delivery
6134 .endd
6135 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6136 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6137 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6138 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6139 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6140
6141
6142 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6143 .cindex "default" "transports"
6144 .cindex "transports" "default"
6145 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6146 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6147 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6148 .code
6149 begin transports
6150 .endd
6151 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6152 .code
6153 remote_smtp:
6154 driver = smtp
6155 hosts_try_prdr = *
6156 .endd
6157 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6158 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6159 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6160 It is negotiated between client and server
6161 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6162 All other options are defaulted.
6163 .code
6164 local_delivery:
6165 driver = appendfile
6166 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6167 delivery_date_add
6168 envelope_to_add
6169 return_path_add
6170 # group = mail
6171 # mode = 0660
6172 .endd
6173 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6174 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6175 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6176 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6177 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6178 show how this can be done.
6179
6180 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6181 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6182 similarly-named options above.
6183 .code
6184 address_pipe:
6185 driver = pipe
6186 return_output
6187 .endd
6188 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6189 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6190 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6191 be returned to the sender.
6192 .code
6193 address_file:
6194 driver = appendfile
6195 delivery_date_add
6196 envelope_to_add
6197 return_path_add
6198 .endd
6199 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6200 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6201 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6202 .code
6203 address_reply:
6204 driver = autoreply
6205 .endd
6206 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6207 filter files.
6208
6209
6210
6211 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6212 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6213 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6214 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6215 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6216 introduced by the line
6217 .code
6218 begin retry
6219 .endd
6220 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6221 errors:
6222 .code
6223 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6224 .endd
6225 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6226 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6227 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6228 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6229 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6230
6231 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6232 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6233 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6234
6235
6236 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6237 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6238 .code
6239 begin rewrite
6240 .endd
6241 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6242 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6243
6244
6245
6246 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6247 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6248 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6249 .code
6250 begin authenticators
6251 .endd
6252 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6253 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6254 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6255 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6256 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6257 to support most MUA software.
6258
6259 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6260 .code
6261 #PLAIN:
6262 # driver = plaintext
6263 # server_set_id = $auth2
6264 # server_prompts = :
6265 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6266 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6267 .endd
6268 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6269 .code
6270 #LOGIN:
6271 # driver = plaintext
6272 # server_set_id = $auth1
6273 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6274 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6275 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6276 .endd
6277
6278 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6279 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6280 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6281 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6282 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6283 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6284 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6285 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6286
6287 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6288 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6289 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6290 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6291
6292 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6293 usercode and password are in different positions.
6294 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6295
6296 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6297
6298
6299
6300 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6301 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6302
6303 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6304
6305 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6306 .cindex "PCRE"
6307 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6308 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6309 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6310 regular expressions is discussed in
6311 online Perl manpages, in
6312 many Perl reference books, and also in
6313 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6314 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6315
6316 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6317 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6318 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6319 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6320 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6321 case-insensitive.
6322
6323 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6324 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6325 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6326 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6327 .code
6328 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6329 .endd
6330 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6331 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6332 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6333 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6334 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6335 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6336 matched.
6337
6338 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6339 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6340 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6341 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6342 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6343 match anywhere in the subject string.
6344
6345 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6346 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6347 .code
6348 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6349 .endd
6350 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6351 You need to use:
6352 .code
6353 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6354 .endd
6355 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6356 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6357
6358
6359
6360 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6361 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6362
6363 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6364 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6365 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6366 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6367 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6368 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6369
6370 .olist
6371 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6372 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6373 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6374 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6375 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6376 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6377 .next
6378 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6379 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6380 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6381 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6382 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6383 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6384 .endlist
6385
6386 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6387 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6388 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6389 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6390 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6391 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6392
6393 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6394 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6395 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6396 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6397 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6398 .code
6399 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6400 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6401 .endd
6402 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6403 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6404 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6405 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6406 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6407 .code
6408 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6409 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6410 .endd
6411 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6412 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6413
6414 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6415 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6416 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6417 .code
6418 domain1:
6419 domain2:
6420 .endd
6421 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6422 matches the list item.
6423
6424 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6425 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6426 .code
6427 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6428 .endd
6429 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6430 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6431 causes a second lookup to occur.
6432
6433 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6434 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6435 lookup is permitted.
6436
6437
6438 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6439 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6440 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6441 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6442
6443 .ilist
6444 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6445 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6446 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6447 .next
6448 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6449 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6450 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6451 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6452 .endlist
6453
6454 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6455 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6456 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6457 .code
6458 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6459 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6460 .endd
6461 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6462 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6463 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6464
6465
6466
6467
6468 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6469 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6470 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6471 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6472
6473 .ilist
6474 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6475 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6476 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6477 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6478 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6479 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6480 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6481 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6482 be found in several places:
6483 .display
6484 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6485 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6486 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6487 .endd
6488 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6489 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6490 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6491 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6492 .next
6493 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6494 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6495 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6496 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6497 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6498 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6499 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6500
6501 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6502 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6503 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6504 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6505 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6506 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6507 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6508 .next
6509 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6510 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6511 .cindex "sasldb2"
6512 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6513 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6514 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6515 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6516 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6517 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6518 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6519 .next
6520 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6521 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6522 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6523 .cindex "Courier"
6524 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6525 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6526 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6527 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6528 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6529 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6530 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6531 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6532 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6533 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6534 .next
6535 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6536 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6537 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6538 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6539 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6540 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6541 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6542 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6543 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6544 .next
6545 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6546 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6547 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6548 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6549 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6550 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6551 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6552 .code
6553 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6554 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6555 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6556 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6557 .endd
6558 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6559 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6560 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6561 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6562 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6563
6564 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6565 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6566 lookup types support only literal keys.
6567
6568 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6569 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6570 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6571 .next
6572 .cindex "linear search"
6573 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6574 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6575 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6576 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6577 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6578 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6579 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6580 in the file is used.
6581
6582 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6583 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6584 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6585 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6586 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6587 colon, for example:
6588 .code
6589 baduser: :fail:
6590 .endd
6591 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6592 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6593 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6594 wildcarding of any kind.
6595
6596 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6597 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6598 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6599 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6600 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6601 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6602 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6603 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6604 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6605
6606 .next
6607 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6608 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6609 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6610 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6611 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6612 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6613 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6614 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6615
6616 .next
6617 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6618 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6619 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6620 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6621 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6622 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6623 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6624 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6625 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6626
6627 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6628 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6629 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6630 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6631
6632 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6633 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6634
6635 .olist
6636 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6637 .code
6638 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6639 *fish data for anythingfish
6640 .endd
6641 .next
6642 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6643 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6644 .code
6645 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6646 .endd
6647 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6648 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6649 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6650 .code
6651 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6652 .endd
6653 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6654 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6655 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6656 .code
6657 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6658 .endd
6659
6660 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6661 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6662 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6663 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6664 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6665
6666 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6667 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6668 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6669 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6670 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6671
6672 .next
6673 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6674 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6675 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6676 example:
6677 .code
6678 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6679 .endd
6680 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6681 .endlist olist
6682
6683 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6684 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6685 be followed by optional colons.
6686
6687 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6688 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6689 lookup types support only literal keys.
6690 .endlist ilist
6691
6692
6693 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6694 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6695 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6696 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6697 many of them are given in later sections.
6698
6699 .ilist
6700 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6701 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6702 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6703 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6704 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6705 .next
6706 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6707 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6708 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6709 .next
6710 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6711 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6712 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6713 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6714 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6715 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6716 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6717 .next
6718 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6719 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6720 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6721 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6722 .next
6723 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6724 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6725 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6726 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6727 .next
6728 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6729 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6730 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6731 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6732 .next
6733 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6734 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6735 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6736 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6737 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6738 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6739 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6740 password value. For example:
6741 .code
6742 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6743 .endd
6744 .next
6745 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6746 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6747 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6748 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6749
6750 .next
6751 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6752 .cindex lookup Redis
6753 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6754 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6755
6756 .next
6757 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6758 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6759 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6760 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6761
6762 .next
6763 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6764 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6765 .next
6766 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6767 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6768 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6769 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6770 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6771 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6772 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6773 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6774 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6775 .code
6776 require condition = \
6777 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6778 .endd
6779 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6780 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6781 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6782 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6783 .endlist
6784
6785
6786
6787 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6788 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6789 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6790 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6791 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6792 options such as a list of local domains.
6793
6794 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6795 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6796 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6797 or may give up altogether.
6798
6799
6800
6801 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6802 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6803 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6804 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6805 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6806 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6807 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6808 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6809
6810 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6811 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6812 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6813
6814 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6815 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6816 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6817
6818 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6819 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6820 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6821 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6822 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6823 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6824 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6825 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6826 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6827 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6828 .code
6829 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6830 .endd
6831 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6832 looks up these keys, in this order:
6833 .code
6834 jane@eyre.example
6835 *@eyre.example
6836 *
6837 .endd
6838 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6839 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6840 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6841 Exim move on to try the next key.
6842
6843
6844
6845 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6846 .cindex "partial matching"
6847 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6848 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6849 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6850 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6851 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6852 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6853 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6854 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6855 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6856 a key in a DBM file is
6857 .code
6858 *.dates.fict.example
6859 .endd
6860 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6861 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6862 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6863 file.
6864
6865 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6866 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6867 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6868
6869 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6870 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6871 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6872 partial matching keys
6873 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6874 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6875 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6876
6877 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6878 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6879 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6880 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6881 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6882 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6883 remains.
6884
6885 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6886 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6887 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6888 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6889 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6890 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6891 .code
6892 2250.dates.fict.example
6893 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6894 *.dates.fict.example
6895 *.fict.example
6896 .endd
6897 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6898 finishes.
6899
6900 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6901 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6902 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6903 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6904 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6905 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6906 .code
6907 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6908 .endd
6909 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6910 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6911 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6912 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6913 .code
6914 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6915 .endd
6916 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6917 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6918
6919 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6920 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6921 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6922
6923 .ilist
6924 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6925 .next
6926 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6927 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6928 .next
6929 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6930 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6931 for &"*"& on its own.
6932 .next
6933 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6934 .endlist
6935
6936
6937 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6938 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6939 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6940 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6941 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6942 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6943 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6944
6945 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6946 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6947 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6948 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6949 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6950
6951
6952
6953
6954 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6955 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6956 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6957 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6958 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6959 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6960 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6961
6962 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6963 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6964 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6965 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6966 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6967 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6968
6969 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6970 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6971 complete.
6972
6973
6974
6975
6976 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6977 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6978 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6979 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6980 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6981 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6982 .code
6983 [name=$local_part]
6984 .endd
6985 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6986 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6987 .code
6988 [name="$local_part"]
6989 .endd
6990 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6991 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6992 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6993 of the following form is provided:
6994 .code
6995 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6996 .endd
6997 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6998 .code
6999 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7000 .endd
7001 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7002 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7003 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7004
7005
7006
7007
7008 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7009 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7010 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7011 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7012 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7013 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7014 an expansion string could contain:
7015 .code
7016 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7017 .endd
7018 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7019 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7020 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7021 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7022
7023 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7024 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7025 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7026
7027 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7028 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7029 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7030 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7031 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7032 .code
7033 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7034 .endd
7035 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7036 white space is ignored.
7037 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7038 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7039 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7040
7041 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7042 When the type is PTR,
7043 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7044 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7045 .code
7046 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7047 .endd
7048 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7049 altered and nothing is added.
7050
7051 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7052 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7053 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7054 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7055 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7056 The field separator can be modified as above.
7057
7058 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7059 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7060 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7061 unless a field separator is specified.
7062 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7063 For SPF records the
7064 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7065 .code
7066 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7067 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7068 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7069 .endd
7070 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7071 white space is ignored.
7072
7073 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7074 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7075 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7076 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7077 specified.
7078 .code
7079 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7080 .endd
7081
7082 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7083 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7084 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7085 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7086 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7087 each followed by a comma,
7088 that may appear before the record type.
7089
7090 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7091 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7092 a defer-option modifier.
7093 The possible keywords are
7094 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7095 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7096 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7097 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7098 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7099 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7100 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7101 .code
7102 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7103 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7104 .endd
7105 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7106 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7107
7108 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7109 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7110 The possible keywords are
7111 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7112 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7113 with the lookup.
7114 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7115 is not labelled as authenticated data
7116 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7117 The default is &"never"&.
7118
7119 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7120
7121 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7122 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7123 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7124 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7125 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7126 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7127
7128 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7129 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7130 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7131
7132 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7133 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7134 .cindex DNS TTL
7135 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7136 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7137 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7138
7139
7140 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7141 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7142 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7143 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7144 the pseudo-type MXH:
7145 .code
7146 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7147 .endd
7148 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7149 returned.
7150
7151 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7152 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7153 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7154 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7155 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7156 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7157 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7158 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7159 .code
7160 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7161 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7162 .endd
7163 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7164 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7165 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7166
7167 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7168 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7169 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7170 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7171 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7172 such a list.
7173
7174 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7175 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7176 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7177 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7178 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7179 result of a successful lookup such as:
7180 .code
7181 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7182 .endd
7183 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7184 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7185 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7186
7187 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7188 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7189 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7190 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7191 .code
7192 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7193 .endd
7194
7195
7196 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7197 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7198 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7199 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7200 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7201 .code
7202 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7203 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7204 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7205 .endd
7206 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7207 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7208 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7209 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7210
7211 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7212 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7213 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7214
7215
7216
7217
7218 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7219 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7220 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7221 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7222 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7223 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7224 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7225 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7226 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7227 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7228 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7229 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7230 .code
7231 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7232 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7233 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7234 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7235 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7236 .endd
7237 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7238 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7239
7240 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7241 the way they handle the results of a query:
7242
7243 .ilist
7244 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7245 gives an error.
7246 .next
7247 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7248 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7249 .next
7250 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7251 from all of them are returned.
7252 .endlist
7253
7254
7255 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7256 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7257 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7258 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7259
7260
7261 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7262 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7263 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7264 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7265 .code
7266 data = ${lookup ldap \
7267 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7268 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7269 .endd
7270 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7271 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7272 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7273 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7274
7275 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7276 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7277 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7278
7279 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7280 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7281 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7282 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7283 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7284 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7285 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7286 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7287 &_exim.conf_&.
7288
7289
7290 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7291 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7292 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7293 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7294 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7295 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7296
7297 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7298 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7299 the string:
7300 .code
7301 * => \2A
7302 ( => \28
7303 ) => \29
7304 \ => \5C
7305 .endd
7306 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7307 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7308 .code
7309 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7310 .endd
7311 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7312 .code
7313 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7314 .endd
7315 yields
7316 .code
7317 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7318 .endd
7319 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7320 .code
7321 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7322 .endd
7323 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7324 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7325 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7326 .code
7327 , + " \ < > ;
7328 .endd
7329 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7330 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7331 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7332 .code
7333 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7334 .endd
7335 yields
7336 .code
7337 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7338 .endd
7339 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7340 .code
7341 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7342 .endd
7343 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7344 authentication below.
7345
7346
7347 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7348 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7349 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7350 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7351 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7352 by starting it with
7353 .code
7354 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7355 .endd
7356 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7357 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7358 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7359 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7360 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7361 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7362 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7363 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7364 failures, and timeouts.
7365
7366 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7367 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7368 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7369 doubled. For example
7370 .code
7371 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7372 .endd
7373 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7374 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7375 the local host) is used.
7376
7377 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7378 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7379 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7380 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7381 not available.
7382
7383 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7384 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7385 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7386 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7387 .code
7388 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7389 .endd
7390 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7391 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7392 .code
7393 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7394 .endd
7395 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7396 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7397 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7398 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7399 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7400 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7401 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7402 backup host.
7403
7404 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7405 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7406 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7407
7408 .ilist
7409 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7410 interface.
7411 .next
7412 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7413 .endlist
7414
7415
7416 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7417 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7418
7419
7420
7421 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7422 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7423 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7424 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7425 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7426 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7427 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7428 them. The following names are recognized:
7429 .display
7430 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7431 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7432 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7433 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7434 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7435 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7436 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7437 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7438 .endd
7439 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7440 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7441 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7442 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7443
7444 .cindex LDAP timeout
7445 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7446 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7447 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7448 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7449 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7450 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7451 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7452 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7453 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7454 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7455
7456 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7457 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7458
7459 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7460 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7461 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7462 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7463 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7464 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7465 alternate list (colon-separated).
7466
7467 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7468 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7469 .code
7470 ${lookup ldap
7471 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7472 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7473 {$value}fail}
7474 .endd
7475 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7476 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7477 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7478 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7479
7480 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7481 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7482 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7483
7484 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7485 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7486 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7487 quoting has two advantages:
7488
7489 .ilist
7490 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7491 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7492 .next
7493 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7494 .endlist
7495
7496 For example, a setting such as
7497 .code
7498 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7499 .endd
7500 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7501
7502 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7503 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7504 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7505 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7506 .code
7507 PASS=${quote:$3}
7508 .endd
7509 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7510 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7511 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7512
7513
7514
7515 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7516 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7517 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7518 as a sequence of values, for example
7519 .code
7520 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7521 .endd
7522 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7523 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7524 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7525 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7526 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7527 directory.
7528
7529 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7530 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7531 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7532 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7533
7534 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7535 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7536 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7537 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7538 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7539 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7540 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7541 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7542 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7543
7544 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7545 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7546 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7547 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7548 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7549
7550 .code
7551 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7552 value1.1,value1,,2
7553
7554 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7555 value two
7556
7557 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7558 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7559
7560 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7561 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7562
7563 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7564 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7565 .endd
7566 You can
7567 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7568 results of LDAP lookups.
7569 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7570 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7571 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7572 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7573 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7574 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7575
7576
7577
7578
7579 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7580 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7581 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7582 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7583 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7584 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7585 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7586 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7587 .code
7588 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7589 .endd
7590 might return the string
7591 .code
7592 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7593 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7594 .endd
7595 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7596 .code
7597 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7598 .endd
7599 would just return
7600 .code
7601 Martin Guerre
7602 .endd
7603 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7604 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7605 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7606
7607
7608
7609 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7610 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7611 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7612 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7613 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7614 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7615 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7616 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7617 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7618 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7619 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7620 .cindex lookup Redis
7621 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7622 and SQLite
7623 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7624 might be
7625 .code
7626 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7627 {$value}fail}
7628 .endd
7629 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7630 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7631 .code
7632 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7633 {$value}}
7634 .endd
7635 might be
7636 .code
7637 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7638 .endd
7639 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7640 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7641 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7642 .code
7643 Mister X
7644 .endd
7645 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7646 with a newline between the data for each row.
7647
7648
7649 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7650 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7651 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7652 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7653 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7654 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7655 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7656 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7657 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7658 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7659 .cindex lookup Redis
7660 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7661 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7662 or &%redis_servers%&
7663 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7664 information.
7665 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7666 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7667 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7668 For all but Redis
7669 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7670 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7671 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7672 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7673 .code
7674 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7675 .endd
7676 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7677 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7678 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7679 .code
7680 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7681 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7682 .endd
7683 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7684 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7685 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7686 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7687 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7688 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7689
7690 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7691 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7692 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7693 information.
7694 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7695 host, database number, and password.
7696 .olist
7697 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7698 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7699 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7700 .next
7701 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7702 .next
7703 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7704 .endlist
7705
7706 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7707 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7708 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7709 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7710
7711 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7712 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7713
7714 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7715 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7716 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7717 done by starting the query with
7718 .display
7719 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7720 .endd
7721 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7722 .olist
7723 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7724 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7725 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7726 taken from there.
7727 .next
7728 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7729 .endlist
7730 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7731 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7732 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7733
7734 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7735 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7736 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7737 like this:
7738 .code
7739 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7740 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7741 master/db/name/pw
7742 .endd
7743 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7744 .code
7745 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7746 .endd
7747 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7748 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7749 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7750 .code
7751 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7752 .endd
7753
7754
7755 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7756 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7757 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7758 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7759 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7760 the default value is &"exim"&.
7761 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7762 .display
7763 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7764 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7765 .endd
7766 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7767 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7768
7769 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7770 the queries.
7771
7772 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7773 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7774
7775 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7776 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7777 is zero because no rows are affected.
7778
7779
7780 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7781 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7782 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7783 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7784 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7785 looks like this:
7786 .code
7787 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7788 .endd
7789 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7790 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7791 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7792
7793 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7794 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7795 affected.
7796
7797 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7798 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7799 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7800 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7801 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7802 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7803 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7804 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7805 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7806 .code
7807 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7808 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7809 .endd
7810 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7811 .code
7812 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7813 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7814 .endd
7815 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7816 quote, which it doubles.
7817
7818 .cindex timeout SQLite
7819 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7820 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7821 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7822 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7823 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7824 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7825 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7826 option.
7827
7828 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7829 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7830 .cindex "redis lookup type"
7831 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7832 Examples:
7833 .code
7834 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7835 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7836 .endd
7837
7838 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7839 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7840
7841
7842 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7843 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7844
7845 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7846 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7847 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7848 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7849 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7850 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7851 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7852 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7853 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7854
7855 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7856 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7857 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7858 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7859
7860 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7861 support all the complexity available in
7862 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7863
7864
7865
7866 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7867 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7868 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7869
7870 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7871 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7872
7873 The result of
7874 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7875 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7876 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7877 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7878 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7879
7880
7881 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7882 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7883 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7884
7885 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7886 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7887 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7888 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7889 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7890 .code
7891 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7892 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7893 .endd
7894 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7895 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7896 senders based on the receiving domain.
7897
7898
7899
7900
7901 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7902 .cindex "list" "negation"
7903 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7904 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7905 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7906 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7907 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7908 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7909
7910 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7911 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7912 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7913 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7914 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7915 .code
7916 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7917 .endd
7918 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7919 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7920 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7921 .code
7922 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7923 .endd
7924 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7925 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7926 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7927
7928 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7929 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7930 item.
7931
7932
7933
7934 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7935 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7936 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7937 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7938 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7939 file names are not allowed,
7940 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7941 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7942 lines:
7943
7944 .ilist
7945 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7946 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7947 .next
7948 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7949 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7950 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7951 .code
7952 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7953 .endd
7954 .endlist
7955
7956 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7957 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7958 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7959 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7960
7961 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7962 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7963 .code
7964 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7965 .endd
7966 and the file contains the lines
7967 .code
7968 !a.b.c
7969 *.b.c
7970 .endd
7971 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7972 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7973
7974
7975
7976 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7977 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7978 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7979 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7980 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7981 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7982 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7983 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7984
7985 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7986 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7987 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7988 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7989
7990
7991
7992
7993 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7994 .cindex "named lists"
7995 .cindex "list" "named"
7996 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7997 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7998 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7999 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8000 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8001 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8002 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8003 .code
8004 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8005 .endd
8006 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8007 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8008 configured with the line
8009 .code
8010 domains = +local_domains
8011 .endd
8012 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8013 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8014 .code
8015 dnslookup:
8016 driver = dnslookup
8017 domains = ! +local_domains
8018 transport = remote_smtp
8019 no_more
8020 .endd
8021 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8022 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8023 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8024 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8025 .code
8026 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8027 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8028 .endd
8029 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8030 .code
8031 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8032 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8033 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8034 .endd
8035 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8036 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8037 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8038 .code
8039 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8040 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8041 .endd
8042 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8043 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8044 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8045 .code
8046 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8047 .endd
8048 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8049 referenced lists if you can.
8050
8051 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8052 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8053 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8054 .code
8055 domains = +local_domains
8056 .endd
8057 on several of your routers
8058 or in several ACL statements,
8059 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8060 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8061 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8062 the same each time they are referenced.
8063
8064 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8065 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8066 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8067 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8068
8069
8070
8071 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8072 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8073 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8074 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8075 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8076 write
8077 .code
8078 ALIST = host1 : host2
8079 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8080 .endd
8081 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8082 .code
8083 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8084 .endd
8085 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8086 list, and write
8087 .code
8088 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8089 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8090 .endd
8091 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8092 .code
8093 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8094 .endd
8095
8096
8097 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8098 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8099 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8100 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8101 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8102 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8103 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8104 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8105 message. For example:
8106 .code
8107 domainlist special_domains = \
8108 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8109 .endd
8110 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8111 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8112 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8113 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8114 same list each time.
8115
8116 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8117 cache the result anyway. For example:
8118 .code
8119 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8120 .endd
8121 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8122 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8123
8124
8125
8126 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8127 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8128 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8129 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8130 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8131
8132 .ilist
8133 .cindex "primary host name"
8134 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8135 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8136 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8137 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8138 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8139 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8140 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8141 differ only in their names.
8142 .next
8143 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8144 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8145 .cindex "domain literal"
8146 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8147 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8148 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8149 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8150 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8151 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8152 .next
8153 .cindex "@mx_any"
8154 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8155 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8156 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8157 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8158 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8159 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8160 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8161 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8162 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8163 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8164 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8165
8166 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8167 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8168 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8169 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8170 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8171
8172 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8173 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8174 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8175 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8176 on a router). For example:
8177 .code
8178 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8179 .endd
8180 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8181 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8182
8183 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8184 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8185 contain negative items.
8186
8187 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8188 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8189 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8190 .code
8191 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8192 an.other.domain : ...
8193 .endd
8194 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8195 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8196 .code
8197 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8198 an.other.domain ? ...
8199 .endd
8200 .next
8201 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8202 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8203 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8204 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8205 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8206 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8207 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8208 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8209 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8210 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8211
8212 .next
8213 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8214 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8215 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8216 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8217 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8218 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8219 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8220 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8221 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8222
8223 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8224 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8225 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8226 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8227 expression by expansion, of course).
8228 .next
8229 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8230 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8231 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8232 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8233 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8234 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8235 .code
8236 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8237 .endd
8238 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8239 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8240 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8241 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8242 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8243 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8244 other statements in the same ACL.
8245
8246 .next
8247 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8248 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8249 .code
8250 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8251 .endd
8252 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8253 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8254
8255 .next
8256 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8257 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8258 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8259 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8260 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8261 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8262 expansion variable.
8263 .next
8264 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8265 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8266 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8267 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8268 .code
8269 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8270 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8271 .endd
8272 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8273 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8274 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8275 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8276 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8277 .next
8278 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8279 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8280 between the pattern and the domain.
8281 .endlist
8282
8283 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8284 .code
8285 domainlist funny_domains = \
8286 @ : \
8287 lib.unseen.edu : \
8288 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8289 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8290 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8291 nis;domains.byname : \
8292 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8293 .endd
8294 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8295 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8296 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8297 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8298 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8299 patterns earlier.
8300
8301
8302
8303 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8304 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8305 .cindex "list" "host list"
8306 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8307 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8308 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8309 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8310 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8311 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8312 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8313
8314
8315 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8316 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8317 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8318 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8319 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8320 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8321 not used.
8322
8323 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8324 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8325 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8326
8327
8328
8329 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8330 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8331 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8332 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8333 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8334 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8335 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8336 concerns.)
8337
8338 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8339 inspecting its IP address:
8340
8341 .ilist
8342 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8343 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8344 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8345 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8346 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8347 with the IP address of the subject host.
8348
8349 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8350 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8351 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8352 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8353 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8354
8355 .next
8356 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8357 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8358 domain name, as just described.
8359
8360 .next
8361 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8362 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8363 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8364 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8365 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8366 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8367 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8368 that can never match a client host.
8369
8370 .next
8371 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8372 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8373 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8374 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8375 .code
8376 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8377 accept hosts = @[]
8378 .endd
8379 .next
8380 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8381 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8382 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8383 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8384 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8385 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8386 significant end of the address.
8387
8388 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8389 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8390 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8391 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8392 .code
8393 192.168.23.236/31
8394 .endd
8395 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8396 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8397 matches.
8398
8399 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8400 .code
8401 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8402 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8403 .endd
8404 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8405 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8406 For example:
8407 .code
8408 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8409 .endd
8410 could make use of a file containing
8411 .code
8412 172.16.0.0/12
8413 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8414 .endd
8415 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8416 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8417 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8418 .code
8419 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8420 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8421 .endd
8422 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8423 list.
8424 .endlist
8425
8426
8427
8428 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8429 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8430 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8431 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8432 address, the pattern takes this form:
8433 .display
8434 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8435 .endd
8436 For example:
8437 .code
8438 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8439 .endd
8440 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8441 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8442 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8443 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8444 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8445 returned by the lookup is not used.
8446
8447 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8448 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8449 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8450 patterns of this form:
8451 .display
8452 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8453 .endd
8454 For example:
8455 .code
8456 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8457 .endd
8458 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8459 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8460 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8461 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8462 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8463
8464 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8465 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8466 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8467 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8468 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8469 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8470 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8471 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8472 addresses are always used.
8473
8474 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8475 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8476 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8477 configurations.
8478
8479 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8480 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8481 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8482 case the IP address is used on its own.
8483
8484
8485
8486 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8487 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8488 .cindex "unknown host name"
8489 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8490 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8491 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8492 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8493 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8494 above.)
8495
8496 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8497 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8498 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8499 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8500 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8501 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8502 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8503
8504 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8505 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8506
8507 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8508 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8509 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8510 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8511 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8512 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8513 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8514 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8515 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8516
8517 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8518 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8519
8520 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8521 .cindex "alias for host"
8522 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8523 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8524
8525 .ilist
8526 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8527 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8528 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8529 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8530 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8531 expression.
8532 .next
8533 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8534 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8535 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8536 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8537 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8538 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8539 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8540 example,
8541 .code
8542 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8543 .endd
8544 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8545 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8546 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8547 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8548 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8549 .code
8550 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8551 .endd
8552 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8553 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8554 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8555 required.
8556 .endlist
8557
8558
8559
8560
8561 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8562 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8563 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8564 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8565 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8566 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8567
8568 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8569 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8570
8571 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8572 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8573 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8574 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8575 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8576 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8577 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8578 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8579 not recognized in an indirected file).
8580
8581 .ilist
8582 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8583 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8584 .code
8585 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8586 .endd
8587 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8588 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8589
8590 .next
8591 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8592 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8593 example:
8594 .code
8595 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8596 192.168.4.5
8597 .endd
8598 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8599 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8600 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8601 .endlist
8602
8603 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8604 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8605 list.
8606
8607 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8608 "SECTmixwilhos"
8609 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8610
8611 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8612 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8613 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8614
8615 .ilist
8616 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8617 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8618 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8619 .code
8620 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8621 .endd
8622 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8623 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8624 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8625 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8626 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8627 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8628 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8629
8630 .next
8631 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8632 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8633 .code
8634 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8635 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8636 .endd
8637 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8638 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8639 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8640 this section.
8641 .endlist
8642
8643
8644 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8645 "SECTtemdnserr"
8646 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8647 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8648 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8649 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8650 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8651 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8652 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8653 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8654 host lists such as whitelists.
8655
8656
8657
8658 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8659 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8660 .cindex "unknown host name"
8661 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8662 If a pattern is of the form
8663 .display
8664 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8665 .endd
8666 for example
8667 .code
8668 dbm;/host/accept/list
8669 .endd
8670 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8671 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8672 is not used.
8673
8674 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8675 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8676 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8677 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8678 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8679 lookup, both using the same file.
8680
8681
8682
8683 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8684 If a pattern is of the form
8685 .display
8686 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8687 .endd
8688 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8689 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8690 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8691 .code
8692 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8693 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8694 .endd
8695 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8696 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8697 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8698 operator.
8699
8700 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8701 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8702 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8703
8704 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8705 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8706 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8707 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8708 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8709 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8710
8711
8712
8713
8714
8715 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8716 .cindex "list" "address list"
8717 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8718 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8719 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8720 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8721 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8722 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8723 using this option setting:
8724 .code
8725 senders = :
8726 .endd
8727 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8728 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8729 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8730 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8731
8732 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8733 example:
8734 .code
8735 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8736 .endd
8737 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8738 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8739 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8740 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8741 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8742 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8743 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8744 .code
8745 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8746 *@+hostile_domains:\
8747 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8748 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8749 .endd
8750 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8751 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8752 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8753 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8754 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8755
8756 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8757 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8758 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8759 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8760 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8761 .code
8762 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8763 .endd
8764
8765 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8766 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8767 senders:
8768
8769 .ilist
8770 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8771 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8772 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8773 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8774 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8775 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8776 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8777 .code
8778 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8779 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8780 .endd
8781 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8782 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8783
8784 .next
8785 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8786 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8787 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8788 example:
8789 .code
8790 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8791 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8792 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8793 .endd
8794 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8795 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8796 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8797 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8798
8799 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8800 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8801 panic log.
8802 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8803 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8804 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8805 default. For example, with this lookup:
8806 .code
8807 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8808 .endd
8809 the file could contains lines like this:
8810 .code
8811 user1@domain1.example
8812 *@domain2.example
8813 .endd
8814 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8815 that are tried is:
8816 .code
8817 nimrod@jaeger.example
8818 *@jaeger.example
8819 *
8820 .endd
8821 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8822 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8823
8824 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8825 .code
8826 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8827 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8828 .endd
8829 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8830 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8831 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8832 .endlist
8833
8834
8835 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8836 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8837 always fails.
8838
8839
8840 .ilist
8841 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8842 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8843 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8844 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8845 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8846 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8847 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8848 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8849 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8850
8851 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8852 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8853 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8854 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8855 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8856 with
8857 .code
8858 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8859 .endd
8860 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8861 .code
8862 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8863 .endd
8864 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8865
8866 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8867 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8868 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8869 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8870 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8871 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8872 .code
8873 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8874 spammer3 : spammer4
8875 .endd
8876 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8877 doubling.
8878
8879 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8880 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8881 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8882 might have entries like
8883 .code
8884 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8885 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8886 *: ^\d{8}$
8887 .endd
8888 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8889 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8890 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8891 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8892
8893 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8894 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8895 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8896
8897 .next
8898 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8899 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8900 can only return a single list of local parts.
8901 .endlist
8902
8903 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8904 in these two examples:
8905 .code
8906 senders = +my_list
8907 senders = *@+my_list
8908 .endd
8909 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8910 example it is a named domain list.
8911
8912
8913
8914
8915 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8916 .cindex "case of local parts"
8917 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8918 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8919 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8920 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8921 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8922 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8923 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8924 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8925 default.
8926
8927 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8928 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8929 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8930 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8931 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8932 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8933 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8934 case-independent.
8935
8936 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8937 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8938 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8939 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8940 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8941 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8942 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8943 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8944
8945
8946
8947 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8948 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8949 .cindex "local part" "list"
8950 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8951 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8952 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8953 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8954 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8955 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8956 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8957 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8958
8959 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8960 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8961 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8962 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8963 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8964 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8965 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8966 types.
8967 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8968
8969
8970
8971
8972 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8973 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8974
8975 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8976 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8977 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8978 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8979
8980 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8981 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8982 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8983 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8984 escape character, as described in the following section.
8985
8986 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8987 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8988 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8989 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8990 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8991 reasons.
8992
8993
8994
8995 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8996 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8997 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8998 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8999 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9000 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9001 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9002 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9003
9004 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9005 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9006 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9007 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9008 .code
9009 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9010 .endd
9011 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9012 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9013 string.
9014
9015
9016
9017 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9018 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9019 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9020 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9021 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9022 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9023 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9024 encoding.
9025
9026 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9027 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9028 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9029
9030
9031 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9032 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9033 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9034 .oindex "&%-be%&"
9035 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9036 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9037 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9038 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9039 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9040 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9041 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9042 and &%nhash%&.
9043
9044 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9045 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9046 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9047
9048 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
9049 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9050 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9051 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9052 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9053 .code
9054 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9055 .endd
9056 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9057 Exim message identifier. For example:
9058 .code
9059 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9060 .endd
9061 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9062 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9063
9064
9065 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9066 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9067 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9068 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9069 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9070 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9071 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9072 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9073 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9074 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9075 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9076 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9077 being expanded.
9078
9079
9080
9081
9082 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9083 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9084 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9085 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9086 white space is significant.
9087
9088 .vlist
9089 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9090 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9091 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9092 .code
9093 $local_part
9094 ${domain}
9095 .endd
9096 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9097 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9098 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9099 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9100 given, the expansion fails.
9101
9102 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9103 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9104 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9105 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9106 .code
9107 ${lc:$local_part}
9108 .endd
9109 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9110 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9111 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9112 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9113 string easier to understand.
9114
9115 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9116 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9117 expansion item below.
9118
9119
9120 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9121 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9122 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9123 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9124 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9125 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9126 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9127 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9128 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9129 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9130 the result of the expansion.
9131 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9132 the expansion result is an empty string.
9133 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9134
9135
9136 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9137 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9138 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9139 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9140 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9141 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9142 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9143 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9144 .display
9145 &`version `&
9146 &`serial_number `&
9147 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9148 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9149 &`notbefore `& time
9150 &`notafter `& time
9151 &`sig_algorithm `&
9152 &`signature `&
9153 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9154 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9155 &`crl_uri `& list
9156 .endd
9157 If the field is found,
9158 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9159 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9160 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9161 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9162
9163 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9164 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9165 extracted is used.
9166
9167 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9168
9169 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9170 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9171 not quite
9172 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9173 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9174 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9175 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9176 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9177 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9178 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9179 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9180
9181 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9182 take an optional modifier of "int"
9183 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9184 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9185 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9186
9187 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9188 newline-separated by default,
9189 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9190 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9191 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9192
9193 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9194 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9195 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9196 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9197 if so the element tags are omitted.
9198
9199 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9200
9201 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9202 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9203 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9204 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9205 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9206 .code
9207 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9208 .endd
9209 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9210 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9211 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9212
9213 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9214 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9215 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9216 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9217 must have the following type:
9218 .code
9219 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9220 .endd
9221 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9222 function should return one of the following values:
9223
9224 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9225 into the expanded string that is being built.
9226
9227 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9228 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9229
9230 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9231 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9232
9233 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9234
9235 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9236 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9237 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9238
9239
9240 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9241 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9242 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9243 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9244 removed.
9245 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9246 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9247 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9248
9249 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9250 appear, for example:
9251 .code
9252 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9253 .endd
9254 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9255 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9256
9257 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9258 search failure.
9259 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9260 search success.
9261
9262 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9263 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9264
9265
9266 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9267 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9268 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9269 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9270 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9271 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9272 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9273 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9274 .display
9275 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9276 .endd
9277 .vindex "&$value$&"
9278 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9279 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9280 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9281 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9282 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9283 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9284 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9285 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9286 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9287
9288 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9289 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9290 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9291 yield &"2001"&:
9292 .code
9293 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9294 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9295 .endd
9296 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9297 appear, for example:
9298 .code
9299 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9300 .endd
9301 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9302 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9303
9304
9305 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9306 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9307 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9308 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9309 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9310 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9311 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9312 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9313 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9314 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9315 <&'string3'&> as before.
9316
9317 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9318 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9319 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9320 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9321 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9322 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9323 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9324 provided. For example:
9325 .code
9326 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9327 .endd
9328 yields &"42"&, and
9329 .code
9330 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9331 .endd
9332 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9333 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9334
9335
9336 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9337 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9338 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9339 .vindex "&$item$&"
9340 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9341 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9342 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9343 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9344 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9345 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9346 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9347 .code
9348 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9349 .endd
9350 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9351 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9352
9353
9354 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9355 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9356 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9357 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9358 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9359 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9360
9361 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9362 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9363 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9364 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9365 .code
9366 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9367 .endd
9368 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9369 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9370 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9371 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9372 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9373 .code
9374 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9375 .endd
9376 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9377 letters appear. For example:
9378 .display
9379 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9380 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9381 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9382 .endd
9383
9384 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9385 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9386 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9387 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9388 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9389 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9390 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9391 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9392 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9393 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9394 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9395 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9396 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9397 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9398 .code
9399 $header_reply-to:
9400 .endd
9401 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9402 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9403 lines) may be present.
9404
9405 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9406 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9407
9408 .ilist
9409 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9410 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9411 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9412
9413 .next
9414 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9415 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9416 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9417 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9418 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9419 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9420 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9421 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9422
9423 .next
9424 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9425 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9426 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9427 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9428 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9429 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9430 .endlist ilist
9431
9432 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9433 command of the following form:
9434 .code
9435 headers charset "UTF-8"
9436 .endd
9437 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9438 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9439 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9440 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9441 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9442 ISO-8859-1.
9443
9444 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9445 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9446 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9447 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9448
9449 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9450 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9451 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9452 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9453 router or transport are not accessible.
9454
9455 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9456 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9457 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9458 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9459 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9460 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9461 point they are added.
9462 When any of the above ACLs ar
9463 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9464
9465 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9466 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9467 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9468 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9469 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9470 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9471 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9472 header.)
9473
9474 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9475 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9476 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9477 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9478 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9479 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9480 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9481 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9482
9483
9484 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9485 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9486 .cindex &%hmac%&
9487 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9488 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9489 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9490 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9491 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9492 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9493 present. For example:
9494 .code
9495 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9496 .endd
9497 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9498 produces:
9499 .code
9500 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9501 .endd
9502 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9503 an Exim configuration:
9504 .code
9505 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9506 .endd
9507 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9508 .code
9509 headers_add = \
9510 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9511 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9512 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9513 .endd
9514 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9515 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9516 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9517 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9518 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9519 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9520
9521
9522 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9523 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9524 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9525 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9526 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9527 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9528 .code
9529 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9530 .endd
9531 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9532 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9533 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9534 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9535 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9536
9537 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9538 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9539 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9540 .code
9541 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9542 .endd
9543 you can use
9544 .code
9545 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9546 .endd
9547
9548
9549
9550 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9551 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9552 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9553 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9554 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9555 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9556
9557
9558
9559 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9560 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9561 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9562 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9563 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9564 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9565 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9566 some of the braces:
9567 .code
9568 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9569 .endd
9570 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9571 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9572 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9573
9574
9575 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9576 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9577 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9578 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9579 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9580 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9581 apart from an optional leading minus,
9582 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9583
9584 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9585 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9586
9587 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9588 If the number is negative, the fields are
9589 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9590 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9591 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9592
9593 If the modulus of the
9594 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9595 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9596
9597 For example:
9598 .code
9599 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9600 .endd
9601 yields &"42"&, and
9602 .code
9603 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9604 .endd
9605 yields &"result: 42"&.
9606
9607 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9608 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9609 extracted is used.
9610 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9611
9612
9613 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9614 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9615 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9616 described in the next item.
9617
9618 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9619 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9620 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9621 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9622 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9623 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9624 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9625 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9626 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9627
9628 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9629 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9630 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9631 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9632 out by the system administrator.
9633
9634 .vindex "&$value$&"
9635 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9636 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9637 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9638 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9639 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9640 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9641 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9642 original lookup fails.
9643
9644 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9645 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9646 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9647 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9648 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9649 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9650 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9651 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9652
9653 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9654 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9655 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9656 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9657
9658 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9659 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9660 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9661 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9662
9663 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9664 .code
9665 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9666 .endd
9667 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9668 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9669 .code
9670 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9671 {$value}fail}
9672 .endd
9673
9674
9675 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9676 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9677 .vindex "&$item$&"
9678 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9679 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9680 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9681 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9682 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9683 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9684 .code
9685 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9686 .endd
9687 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9688 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9689 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9690
9691 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9692 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9693 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9694 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9695 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9696 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9697 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9698 .code
9699 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9700 .endd
9701 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9702 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9703 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9704 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9705 example,
9706 .code
9707 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9708 .endd
9709 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9710
9711
9712
9713 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9714 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9715 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9716 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9717 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9718 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9719 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9720 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9721
9722 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9723 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9724 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9725 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9726 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9727 not its contents.
9728
9729 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9730 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9731 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9732
9733 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9734 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9735
9736
9737 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9738 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9739 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9740 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9741 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9742 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9743 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9744 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9745
9746 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9747 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9748 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9749 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9750 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9751 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9752 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9753 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9754 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9755 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9756
9757 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9758 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9759 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9760 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9761
9762 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9763 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9764 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9765 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9766 is the expansion of the third argument.
9767
9768 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9769 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9770 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9771
9772 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9773 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9774 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9775 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9776 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9777 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9778 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9779 newlines are left in the string.
9780 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9781 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9782 the string expansion fails.
9783
9784 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9785 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9786
9787
9788
9789 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9790 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9791 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9792 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9793 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9794 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9795 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9796 examples:
9797 .code
9798 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9799 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9800 .endd
9801 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9802 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9803 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9804 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9805 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9806 example:
9807 .code
9808 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9809 .endd
9810 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9811 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9812 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9813 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9814 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9815 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9816 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9817 .code
9818 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9819 .endd
9820 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9821 and must be present if the argument is given.
9822 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9823 One option type is currently recognised, defining whether (the default)
9824 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9825 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9826 .code
9827 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9828 .endd
9829 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9830 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9831 turns them into spaces:
9832 .code
9833 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9834 .endd
9835 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9836 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9837 addition, the following errors can occur:
9838
9839 .ilist
9840 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9841 .next
9842 Failure to connect the socket;
9843 .next
9844 Failure to write the request string;
9845 .next
9846 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9847 .endlist
9848
9849 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9850 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9851 errors occurs. For example:
9852 .code
9853 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9854 {socket failure}}
9855 .endd
9856 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9857 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9858 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9859 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9860 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9861
9862 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9863 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9864
9865
9866 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9867 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9868 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9869 .vindex "&$value$&"
9870 .vindex "&$item$&"
9871 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9872 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9873 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9874 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9875 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9876 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9877 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9878 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9879 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9880 .code
9881 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9882 .endd
9883 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9884 can be found:
9885 .code
9886 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9887 .endd
9888 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9889 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9890 expansion items.
9891
9892 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9893 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9894 expansion item above.
9895
9896 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9897 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9898 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9899 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9900 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9901 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9902 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9903 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9904 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9905
9906 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9907 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9908 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9909 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9910 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9911 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9912 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9913 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9914 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9915 character.
9916
9917 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9918 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9919 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9920 .vindex "&$value$&"
9921 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9922 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9923 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9924 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9925 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9926 &$value$&.
9927
9928 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9929 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9930 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9931 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9932
9933 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9934 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9935 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9936 troubleshoot:
9937 .code
9938 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9939 log_message = Output of id: $value
9940 .endd
9941 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9942 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9943 .code
9944 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9945 .endd
9946
9947 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9948 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9949 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9950 .code
9951 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9952 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9953 ...
9954 endif
9955 .endd
9956 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9957 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9958 commands.
9959
9960 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9961 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9962 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9963 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9964
9965 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9966 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9967
9968
9969 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9970 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9971 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9972 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9973 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9974 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9975 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9976 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9977 .code
9978 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9979 .endd
9980 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9981 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9982 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9983 .code
9984 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9985 .endd
9986 yields &"defabc"&, and
9987 .code
9988 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9989 .endd
9990 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9991 the regular expression from string expansion.
9992
9993
9994
9995 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9996 .cindex sorting "a list"
9997 .cindex list sorting
9998 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9999 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10000 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
10001 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10002 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10003 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10004 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10005 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10006 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10007 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10008 to give values for comparison.
10009
10010 The item result is a sorted list,
10011 with the original list separator,
10012 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10013
10014 Examples:
10015 .code
10016 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10017 .endd
10018 sorts a list of numbers, and
10019 .code
10020 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10021 .endd
10022 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10023
10024
10025 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10026 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10027 .cindex "substring extraction"
10028 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10029 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10030 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10031 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10032 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10033 .code
10034 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10035 .endd
10036 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10037 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10038 omitted.
10039
10040 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10041 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10042 length required. For example
10043 .code
10044 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10045 .endd
10046 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10047 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10048 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10049 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10050
10051 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10052 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10053 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10054 .code
10055 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10056 .endd
10057 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10058 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10059 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10060 .code
10061 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10062 .endd
10063 yields an empty string, but
10064 .code
10065 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10066 .endd
10067 yields &"1"&.
10068
10069 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10070 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10071 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10072 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10073 .code
10074 ${substr_-1:abcde}
10075 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10076 .endd
10077 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10078
10079
10080
10081 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10082 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10083 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10084 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10085 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10086 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10087 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10088 replacement list. For example
10089 .code
10090 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10091 .endd
10092 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10093 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10094 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10095 place.
10096 .endlist
10097
10098
10099
10100 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10101 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10102 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10103 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10104 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10105 following operations can be performed:
10106
10107 .vlist
10108 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10109 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10110 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10111 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10112 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10113 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10114
10115
10116 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10117 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10118 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10119 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10120 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10121 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10122 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10123 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10124 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10125
10126 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10127 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10128 character. For example:
10129 .code
10130 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10131 .endd
10132 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10133 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10134 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10135 separator explicitly:
10136 .code
10137 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10138 .endd
10139
10140 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10141 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10142 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10143 processing lists.
10144
10145 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10146 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10147 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10148 email address separator. For the example header line:
10149 .code
10150 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10151 .endd
10152 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10153 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10154 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10155 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10156 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10157 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10158 quoted.
10159 .code
10160 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10161 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10162 user@example.com
10163 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10164 Last:user@example.com
10165 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10166 user@example.com
10167 .endd
10168
10169 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10170 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10171 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10172 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10173 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10174 Only lowercase letters are used.
10175
10176 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10177 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10178 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10179 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10180 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10181
10182 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10183 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10184 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10185 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10186 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10187 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10188 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10189 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10190 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10191
10192 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10193 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10194 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10195 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10196 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10197 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10198 string.
10199
10200 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10201 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10202 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10203 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10204 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10205 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10206
10207 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10208 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10209
10210
10211 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10212 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10213 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10214 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10215 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10216
10217
10218 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10219 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10220 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10221 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10222 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10223
10224
10225 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10226 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10227 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10228 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10229 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10230 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10231 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10232
10233 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10234 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10235 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10236 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10237 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10238 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10239
10240
10241 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10242 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10243 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10244 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10245 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10246 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10247 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10248 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10249 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10250 C programming language):
10251 .table2 70pt 300pt
10252 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10253 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10254 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10255 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10256 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10257 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10258 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10259 .endtable
10260 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10261 space is permitted before or after operators.
10262
10263 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10264 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10265 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10266 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10267 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10268
10269 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10270 or 1024*1024*1024,
10271 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10272 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10273
10274 .display
10275 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10276 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10277 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10278 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10279 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10280 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10281 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10282 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10283 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10284 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10285 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10286 .endd
10287
10288 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10289 .code
10290 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10291 condition = \
10292 ${if and { \
10293 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10294 { \
10295 < \
10296 {$recipients_count} \
10297 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10298 } \
10299 }{yes}{no}}
10300 .endd
10301 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10302 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10303
10304
10305 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10306 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10307 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10308 example,
10309 .code
10310 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10311 .endd
10312 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10313 and then re-expands what it has found.
10314
10315
10316 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10317 .cindex "Unicode"
10318 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10319 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10320 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10321 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10322 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10323 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10324 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10325 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10326 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10327
10328 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10329 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10330 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10331 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10332 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10333 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10334 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10335
10336
10337 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10338 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10339 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10340 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10341 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10342 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10343 .code
10344 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10345 .endd
10346 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10347 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10348
10349
10350
10351 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10352 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10353 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10354 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10355 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10356 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10357
10358
10359
10360 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10361 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10362 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10363 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10364 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10365 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10366 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10367
10368
10369 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10370 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10371 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10372 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10373 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10374 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10375 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10376
10377 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10378 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10379 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10380 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10381 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10382 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10383 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10384 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10385 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10386
10387
10388 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10389 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10390 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10391 .cindex "lower casing"
10392 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10393 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10394 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10395 .code
10396 ${lc:$local_part}
10397 .endd
10398
10399 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10400 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10401 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10402 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10403 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10404 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10405 .code
10406 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10407 .endd
10408 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10409 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10410 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10411
10412
10413 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10414 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10415 .cindex "list" "item count"
10416 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10417 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10418 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10419
10420
10421 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10422 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10423 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10424 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10425 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10426 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10427 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10428 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10429 matching list is returned.
10430
10431
10432 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10433 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10434 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10435 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10436 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10437 empty.
10438
10439
10440 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10441 .cindex "masked IP address"
10442 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10443 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10444 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10445 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10446 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10447 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10448 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10449 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10450 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10451 .code
10452 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10453 .endd
10454 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10455 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10456 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10457 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10458 .code
10459 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10460 .endd
10461 returns the string
10462 .code
10463 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10464 .endd
10465 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10466
10467
10468 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10469 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10470 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10471 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10472 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10473 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10474 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10475
10476 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10477 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10478
10479
10480 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10481 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10482 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10483 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10484 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10485 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10486 .code
10487 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10488 .endd
10489 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10490
10491
10492 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10493 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10494 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10495 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10496 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10497 is an empty string or
10498 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10499 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10500 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10501 respectively For example,
10502 .code
10503 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10504 .endd
10505 becomes
10506 .code
10507 "ab\"*\"cd"
10508 .endd
10509 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10510 variable or a message header.
10511
10512 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10513 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10514 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10515 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10516 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10517 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10518 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10519
10520
10521 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10522 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10523 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10524 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10525 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10526 .code
10527 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10528 .endd
10529 returns
10530 .code
10531 two%20%5C2A%20two
10532 .endd
10533 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10534 yields an unchanged string.
10535
10536
10537 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10538 .cindex "random number"
10539 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10540 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10541 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10542 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10543 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10544 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10545 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10546 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10547 random().
10548
10549
10550 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10551 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10552 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10553 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10554 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10555 for DNS. For example,
10556 .code
10557 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10558 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10559 .endd
10560 returns
10561 .code
10562 4.2.0.192
10563 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10564 .endd
10565
10566
10567 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10568 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10569 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10570 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10571 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10572 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10573 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10574 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10575 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10576 characters
10577 .code
10578 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10579 .endd
10580 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10581 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10582 characters.
10583
10584
10585 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10586 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10587 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10588 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10589 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10590 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10591 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10592 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10593
10594 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10595 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10596 to use this operator as well.
10597
10598
10599
10600 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10601 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10602 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10603 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10604 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10605 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10606 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10607
10608
10609 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10610 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10611 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10612 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10613 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10614 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10615 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10616
10617 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10618 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10619
10620
10621 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10622 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10623 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10624 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10625 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10626 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10627 and returns
10628 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10629
10630 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10631 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10632
10633
10634 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10635 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10636 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10637 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10638 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10639 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10640 and returns
10641 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10642
10643 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10644 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10645 with 256 being the default.
10646
10647 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10648 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10649 .new
10650 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10651 .wen
10652
10653
10654 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10655 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10656 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10657 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10658 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10659 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10660 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10661 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10662 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10663 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10664 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10665 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10666 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10667
10668 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10669 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10670 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10671
10672 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10673 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10674 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10675
10676
10677
10678 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10679 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10680 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10681 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10682 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10683 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10684
10685
10686 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10687 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10688 .cindex "substring extraction"
10689 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10690 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10691 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10692 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10693 .code
10694 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10695 .endd
10696 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10697 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10698
10699 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10700 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10701 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10702 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10703 seconds.
10704
10705 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10706 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10707 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10708 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10709 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10710 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10711 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10712
10713 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10714 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10715 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10716 .cindex "upper casing"
10717 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10718 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10719 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10720
10721 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10722 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10723 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10724 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10725 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10726 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10727 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10728
10729 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10730 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10731 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10732 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10733 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10734 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10735 .cindex EAI
10736 .cindex internationalisation
10737 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10738 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10739 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10740 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10741 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10742 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10743 .endlist
10744
10745
10746
10747
10748
10749
10750 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10751 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10752 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10753 while expanding strings:
10754
10755 .vlist
10756 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10757 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10758 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10759 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10760 condition.
10761
10762 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10763 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10764 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10765 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10766 are:
10767 .display
10768 &`= `& equal
10769 &`== `& equal
10770 &`> `& greater
10771 &`>= `& greater or equal
10772 &`< `& less
10773 &`<= `& less or equal
10774 .endd
10775 For example:
10776 .code
10777 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10778 .endd
10779 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10780 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10781 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10782 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10783 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10784 zero.
10785
10786 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10787 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10788 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10789
10790
10791 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10792 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10793 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10794 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10795 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10796 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10797 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10798 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10799 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10800 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10801 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10802 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10803 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10804 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10805
10806 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10807 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10808 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10809 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10810 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10811 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10812 false if zero.
10813 An empty string is treated as false.
10814 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10815 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10816 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10817
10818 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10819 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10820 For example:
10821 .code
10822 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10823 .endd
10824
10825
10826 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10827 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10828 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10829 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10830 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10831 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10832 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10833 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10834
10835 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10836
10837 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10838 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10839 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10840 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10841 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10842 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10843 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10844 included in the binary.
10845
10846 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10847 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10848 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10849 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10850 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10851 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10852 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10853 string in LDAP form is:
10854 .code
10855 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10856 .endd
10857 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10858 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10859 .code
10860 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10861 .endd
10862 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10863 supported:
10864
10865 .ilist
10866 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10867 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10868 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10869 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10870 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10871 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10872 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10873 comparison fails.
10874
10875 .next
10876 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10877 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10878 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10879 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10880 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10881 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10882
10883 .next
10884 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10885 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10886 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10887 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10888 whatever its length.
10889
10890 .next
10891 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10892 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10893 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10894 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10895 .endlist
10896 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10897 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10898 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10899 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10900 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10901 support &[crypt16()]&.
10902
10903 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10904 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10905 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10906 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10907 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10908
10909 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10910 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10911 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10912
10913 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10914 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10915 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10916 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10917 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10918
10919 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10920 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10921 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10922 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10923 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10924 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10925 .code
10926 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10927 .endd
10928 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10929 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10930
10931 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10932 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10933 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10934 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10935 exists in the message. For example,
10936 .code
10937 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10938 .endd
10939 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10940 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10941
10942 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10943 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10944 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10945 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10946 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10947 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10948 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10949 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10950 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10951
10952 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10953 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10954 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10955 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10956 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10957 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10958 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10959 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10960
10961 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10962 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10963 .cindex "first delivery"
10964 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10965 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10966 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10967 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10968
10969
10970 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10971 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10972 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10973 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10974 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10975 .vindex "&$item$&"
10976 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10977 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10978 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10979 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10980 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10981 .ilist
10982 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10983 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10984 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10985 .next
10986 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10987 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10988 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10989 .endlist
10990 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10991 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10992 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10993 list separator is changed to a comma:
10994 .code
10995 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10996 .endd
10997 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10998 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10999
11000 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11001
11002
11003 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11004 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11005 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11006 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11007 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11008 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11009 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11010 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11011 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11012 case-independent.
11013
11014 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11015 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11016 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11017 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11018 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11019 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11020 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11021 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11022 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11023 case-independent.
11024
11025 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11026 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11027 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11028 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11029 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11030 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11031 is true.
11032
11033 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11034 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11035 .code
11036 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11037 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11038 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11039 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11040 .endd
11041
11042 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11043 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11044 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11045 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11046 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11047 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11048 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11049 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11050 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11051 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11052 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11053
11054 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11055 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11056 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11057 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11058 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11059
11060 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11061 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11062 check.
11063 This is no longer the case.
11064
11065 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11066 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11067 .code
11068 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11069 .endd
11070 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11071
11072 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11073 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11074 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11075 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11076 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11077 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11078 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11079 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11080 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11081 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11082 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11083 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11084 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11085 this can be used.
11086
11087
11088 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11089 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11090 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11091 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11092 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11093 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11094 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11095 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11096 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11097 case-independent.
11098
11099 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11100 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11101 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11102 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11103 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11104 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11105 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11106 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11107 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11108 case-independent.
11109
11110
11111 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11112 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11113 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11114 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11115 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11116 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11117 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11118 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11119 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11120 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11121 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11122 For example,
11123 .code
11124 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11125 .endd
11126 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11127 backslashes is also required.
11128
11129 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11130 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11131 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11132 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11133 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11134 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11135
11136 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11137 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11138 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11139 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11140 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11141 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11142 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11143 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11144
11145 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11146 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11147 See &*match_local_part*&.
11148
11149 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11150 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11151 See &*match_local_part*&.
11152
11153 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11154 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11155 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11156 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11157 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11158 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11159 .code
11160 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11161 .endd
11162 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11163
11164 .ilist
11165 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11166 .next
11167 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11168 .next
11169 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11170 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11171 in a single test such as
11172 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11173 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11174 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11175 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11176 .code
11177 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11178 .endd
11179 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11180 .next
11181 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11182 .next
11183 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11184 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11185 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11186 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11187 masks. For example:
11188 .code
11189 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11190 .endd
11191 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11192 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11193 address mask, for example:
11194 .code
11195 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11196 .endd
11197 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11198 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11199 .code
11200 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11201 .endd
11202 .endlist ilist
11203
11204 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11205 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11206
11207 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11208
11209 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11210 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11211 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11212 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11213 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11214 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11215 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11216 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11217 example is:
11218 .code
11219 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11220 .endd
11221 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11222 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11223 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11224 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11225 .code
11226 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11227 .endd
11228 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11229 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11230 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11231 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11232 caselessly.
11233
11234 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11235 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11236
11237 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11238 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11239 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11240 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11241
11242 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11243 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11244 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11245 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11246 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11247 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11248 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11249 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11250 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11251 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11252 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11253 .code
11254 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11255 .endd
11256 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11257 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11258
11259 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11260 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11261 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11262 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11263 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11264 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11265 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11266
11267 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11268 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11269 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11270 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11271 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11272 .code
11273 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11274 .endd
11275 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11276 .code
11277 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11278 .endd
11279 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11280 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11281 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11282 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11283 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11284 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11285 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11286 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11287
11288
11289 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11290 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11291 .cindex "Cyrus"
11292 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11293 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11294 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11295 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11296 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11297 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11298
11299 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11300 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11301 building Exim. For example:
11302 .code
11303 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11304 .endd
11305 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11306 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11307 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11308 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11309
11310 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11311 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11312 configuration, you might have this:
11313 .code
11314 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11315 .endd
11316 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11317 .code
11318 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11319 .endd
11320 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11321 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11322 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11323 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11324 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11325 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11326
11327
11328 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11329 .cindex "Radius"
11330 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11331 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11332 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11333 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11334 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11335 support.
11336
11337 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11338 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11339 this library, you need to set
11340 .code
11341 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11342 .endd
11343 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11344 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11345 .code
11346 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11347 .endd
11348 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11349 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11350 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11351
11352 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11353 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11354 the authentication is successful. For example:
11355 .code
11356 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11357 .endd
11358
11359
11360 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11361 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11362 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11363 .cindex "Cyrus"
11364 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11365 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11366 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11367 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11368 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11369 by a process that is not running as root.
11370
11371 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11372 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11373 building Exim. For example:
11374 .code
11375 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11376 .endd
11377 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11378 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11379 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11380
11381 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11382 two are mandatory. For example:
11383 .code
11384 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11385 .endd
11386 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11387 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11388 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11389 .endlist vlist
11390
11391
11392
11393 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11394 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11395 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11396 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11397 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11398 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11399 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11400
11401
11402 .vlist
11403 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11404 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11405 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11406 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11407 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11408 For example,
11409 .code
11410 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11411 .endd
11412 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11413 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11414 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11415
11416 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11417 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11418 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11419 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11420 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11421 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11422 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11423 parsed but not evaluated.
11424 .endlist
11425 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11426
11427
11428
11429
11430 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11431 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11432 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11433 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11434 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11435
11436 .vlist
11437 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11438 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11439 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11440 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11441 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11442 In the expansion condition case
11443 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11444 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11445 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11446 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11447 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11448 matching condition.
11449
11450 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11451 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11452 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11453 any unused variables being made empty.
11454
11455 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11456 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11457 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11458 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11459 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11460 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11461 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11462 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11463 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11464 during subsequent delivery.
11465
11466 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11467 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11468 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11469 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11470 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11471 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11472 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11473 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11474 delivery.
11475
11476 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11477 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11478 this variable has the number of arguments.
11479
11480 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11481 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11482 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11483 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11484 be preserved by coding like this:
11485 .code
11486 warn !verify = sender
11487 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11488 .endd
11489 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11490 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11491 failure.
11492
11493 .vitem &$address_data$&
11494 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11495 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11496 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11497 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11498 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11499 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11500 user filter files.
11501
11502 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11503 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11504 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11505 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11506 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11507 from the child's routing.
11508
11509 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11510 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11511 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11512 address.
11513
11514 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11515 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11516 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11517
11518 .vitem &$address_file$&
11519 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11520 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11521 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11522 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11523 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11524 .code
11525 /home/r2d2/savemail
11526 .endd
11527 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11528 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11529 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11530 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11531 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11532 to the relevant file.
11533
11534 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11535 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11536 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11537 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11538
11539 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11540 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11541 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11542 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11543
11544 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11545 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11546 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11547 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11548 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11549 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11550 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11551 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11552 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11553 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11554 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11555 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11556 command line option.
11557
11558 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11559 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11560 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11561 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11562 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11563 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11564 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11565 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11566 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11567 the ACL's as well.
11568
11569
11570 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11571 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11572 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11573 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11574 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11575 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11576 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11577 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11578 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11579 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11580 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11581
11582 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11583 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11584 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11585 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11586 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11587
11588
11589 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11590 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11591 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11592 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11593 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11594 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11595 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11596 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11597 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11598 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11599 an undefined mechanism.
11600
11601 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11602 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11603 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11604 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11605 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11606 the ACL malware condition.
11607
11608 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11609 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11610 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11611 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11612 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11613 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11614
11615 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11616 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11617 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11618 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11619 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11620 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11621 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11622
11623 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11624 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11625 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11626 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11627 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11628
11629 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11630 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11631 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11632 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11633 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11634
11635 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11636 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11637 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11638 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11639 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11640 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11641 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11642
11643 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11644 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11645 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11646 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11647 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11648 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11649 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11650
11651 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11652 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11653 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11654 address that was connected to.
11655
11656 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11657 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11658 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11659 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11660 compilations of the same version of the program.
11661
11662 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11663 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11664 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11665 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11666 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11667 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11668
11669 .vitem &$config_file$&
11670 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11671 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11672
11673 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11674 Results of DKIM verification.
11675 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11676
11677 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11678 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11679 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11680 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11681 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11682 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11683 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11684 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11685 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11686 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11687 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11688 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11689 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11690 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11691 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11692 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11693 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11694 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11695 &$dkim_key_length$&
11696 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11697 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11698
11699 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11700 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11701 When a message has been received this variable contains
11702 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11703 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11704
11705 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11706 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11707 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11708 &$dnslist_value$&
11709 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11710 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11711 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11712 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11713 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11714 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11715 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11716 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11717 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11718
11719 .vitem &$domain$&
11720 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11721 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11722 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11723 case for &$domain$&.
11724
11725 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11726 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11727 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11728 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11729
11730 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11731 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11732 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11733 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11734 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11735 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11736
11737 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11738 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11739 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11740
11741 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11742
11743 .ilist
11744 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11745 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11746 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11747 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11748 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11749 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11750 the &(smtp)& transport.
11751
11752 .next
11753 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11754 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11755 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11756 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11757
11758 .next
11759 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11760 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11761 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11762 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11763 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11764 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11765
11766 .next
11767 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11768 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11769 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11770 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11771 .endlist
11772
11773
11774 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11775 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11776 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11777 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11778 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11779 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11780 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11781 used.
11782
11783 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11784 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11785 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11786 to nothing.
11787
11788 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11789 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11790 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11791
11792 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11793 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11794 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11795
11796 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11797 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11798 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11799
11800 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11801 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11802 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11803 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11804 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11805 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11806
11807 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11808 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11809 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11810 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11811 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11812
11813 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11814 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11815 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11816 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11817 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11818
11819 .vitem &$home$&
11820 .vindex "&$home$&"
11821 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11822 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11823 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11824 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11825 by a setting on the transport itself.
11826
11827 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11828 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11829 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11830
11831 .vitem &$host$&
11832 .vindex "&$host$&"
11833 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11834 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11835 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11836 to local and remote transports.
11837
11838 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11839 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11840 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11841 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11842 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11843 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11844 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11845 is connected.
11846
11847 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11848 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11849 client is connected.
11850
11851
11852 .vitem &$host_address$&
11853 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11854 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11855 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11856 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11857
11858 .vitem &$host_data$&
11859 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11860 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11861 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11862 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11863 .code
11864 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11865 message = $host_data
11866 .endd
11867 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11868 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11869 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11870 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11871 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11872 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11873 variables is set to &"1"&.
11874
11875 .ilist
11876 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11877 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11878
11879 .next
11880 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11881 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11882 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11883 .endlist ilist
11884
11885 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11886 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11887 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11888 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11889 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11890 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11891 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11892 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11893 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11894 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11895
11896 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11897 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11898 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11899
11900 .vitem &$host_port$&
11901 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11902 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11903 for an outbound connection.
11904
11905 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11906 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11907 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11908 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11909 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11910 to &$spool_directory$& later.
11911
11912 .vitem &$inode$&
11913 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11914 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11915 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11916 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11917 a unique name for the file.
11918
11919 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11920 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11921 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11922
11923 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11924 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11925 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11926
11927 .vitem &$item$&
11928 .vindex "&$item$&"
11929 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11930 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11931 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11932 empty.
11933
11934 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11935 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11936 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11937 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11938 lookup.
11939
11940 .vitem &$load_average$&
11941 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11942 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11943 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11944 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11945
11946 .vitem &$local_part$&
11947 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11948 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11949 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11950 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11951 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11952
11953 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11954 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11955 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11956 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11957 once.
11958
11959 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11960 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11961 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11962 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11963 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11964 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11965
11966 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11967 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11968 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11969 &$address_pipe$&).
11970
11971 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11972 local part of the recipient address.
11973
11974 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11975 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11976 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11977
11978 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11979 the addresses
11980 .code
11981 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11982 abc\:xyz@test.example
11983 .endd
11984 the value of &$local_part$& is
11985 .code
11986 abc:xyz
11987 .endd
11988 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11989 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11990 have:
11991 .code
11992 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11993 .endd
11994 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11995 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11996 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11997
11998 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11999 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12000 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12001 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12002 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12003 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12004 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12005
12006 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12007 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12008 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12009 variable expands to nothing.
12010
12011 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12012 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12013 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12014 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12015 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12016
12017 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12018 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12019 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12020 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12021 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12022
12023 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12024 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12025 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12026 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12027
12028 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12029 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12030 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12031
12032 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12033 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12034 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12035 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12036 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12037 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12038 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12039 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12040
12041 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12042 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12043 This contains the expanded value of the
12044 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12045 been read.
12046
12047 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12048 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12049 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12050 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12051 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12052 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12053
12054 .vitem &$log_space$&
12055 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12056 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12057 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12058 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12059 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12060 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12061
12062
12063 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12064 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12065 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12066 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12067 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12068 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12069 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12070 and &"yes"& if it was.
12071 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12072 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12073 as authenticated data.
12074
12075 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12076 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12077 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12078 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12079 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12080 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12081 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12082 variable is empty.
12083
12084 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12085 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12086 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12087 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12088 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12089
12090 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12091 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12092 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12093 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12094 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12095 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12096 character(s).
12097 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12098
12099 .vitem &$message_age$&
12100 .cindex "message" "age of"
12101 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12102 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12103 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12104 delivery attempt.
12105
12106 .vitem &$message_body$&
12107 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12108 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12109 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12110 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12111 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12112 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12113 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12114 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12115 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12116
12117 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12118 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12119 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12120 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12121 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12122
12123 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12124 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12125 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12126 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12127 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12128 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12129 &$message_body$&.
12130
12131 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12132 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12133 .cindex "message body" "size"
12134 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12135 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12136 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12137 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12138 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12139
12140 If the spool file is wireformat
12141 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12142 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12143
12144 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12145 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12146 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12147 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12148 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12149 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12150 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12151 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12152
12153 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12154 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12155 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12156 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12157 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12158 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12159
12160 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12161 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12162 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12163 contents of header lines is done.
12164
12165 .vitem &$message_id$&
12166 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12167
12168 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12169 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12170 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12171 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12172 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12173 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12174 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12175 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12176 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12177 from the body is not counted.
12178
12179 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12180 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12181 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12182 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12183 header and the body).
12184
12185 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12186 .code
12187 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12188 condition = \
12189 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12190 .endd
12191 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12192 message has not yet been received.
12193
12194 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12195
12196 .vitem &$message_size$&
12197 .cindex "size" "of message"
12198 .cindex "message" "size"
12199 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12200 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12201 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12202 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12203 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12204 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12205 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12206 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12207 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12208
12209 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12210 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12211 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12212 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12213
12214 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12215 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12216 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12217 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12218
12219 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12220 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12221 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12222
12223 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12224 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12225 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12226 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12227 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12228 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12229 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12230 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12231 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12232 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12233
12234 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12235 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12236 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12237
12238 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12239 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12240 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12241 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12242 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12243 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12244 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12245 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12246 the original address.
12247
12248 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12249 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12250 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12251 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12252 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12253
12254 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12255 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12256 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12257
12258 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12259 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12260 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12261 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12262 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12263 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12264 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12265 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12266 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12267
12268 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12269 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12270 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12271 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12272 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12273 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12274 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12275 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12276 user.
12277
12278 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12279 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12280 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12281 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12282
12283 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12284 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12285 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12286 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12287
12288 .vitem &$pid$&
12289 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12290 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12291 This variable contains the current process id.
12292
12293 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12294 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12295 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12296 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12297 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12298 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12299 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12300 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12301 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12302 variable"& error if encountered.
12303
12304 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12305 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12306 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12307 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12308 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12309 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12310 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12311
12312
12313 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12314 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12315 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12316 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12317 &$proxy_session$&
12318 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12319 or SOCKS5 support.
12320 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12321
12322 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12323 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12324 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12325 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12326
12327 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12328 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12329 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12330 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12331
12332 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12333 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12334 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12335 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12336
12337 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12338 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12339 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12340 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12341
12342 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12343 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12344 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12345
12346 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12347 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12348 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12349 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12350
12351 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12352 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12353 .cindex "named queues"
12354 .cindex queues named
12355 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12356
12357 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12358 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12359 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12360 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12361 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12362
12363 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12364 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12365 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12366 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12367 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12368 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12369
12370 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12371 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12372 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12373 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12374 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12375
12376 .vitem &$received_count$&
12377 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12378 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12379 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12380 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12381 delivering.
12382
12383 .vitem &$received_for$&
12384 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12385 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12386 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12387 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12388 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12389
12390 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12391 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12392 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12393 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12394 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12395 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12396 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12397 option.
12398
12399 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12400 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12401 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12402 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12403 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12404 time.
12405 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12406
12407 .vitem &$received_port$&
12408 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12409 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12410
12411 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12412 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12413 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12414 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12415 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12416 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12417 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12418 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12419 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12420
12421 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12422 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12423 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12424 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12425 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12426 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12427
12428 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12429 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12430 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12431
12432 .vitem &$received_time$&
12433 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12434 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12435 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12436
12437 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12438 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12439 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12440 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12441 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12442 .display
12443 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12444 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12445 .endd
12446 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12447 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12448 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12449 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12450
12451 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12452 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12453 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12454 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12455
12456 .ilist
12457 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12458 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12459
12460 .next
12461 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12462
12463 .next
12464 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12465 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12466 MAIL).
12467
12468 .next
12469 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12470 .next
12471
12472 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12473 .endlist
12474
12475 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12476 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12477
12478 .vitem &$recipients$&
12479 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12480 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12481 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12482 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12483 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12484 cases:
12485
12486 .olist
12487 In a system filter file.
12488 .next
12489 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12490 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12491 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12492 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12493 .next
12494 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12495 .endlist
12496
12497
12498 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12499 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12500 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12501 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12502 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12503 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12504
12505
12506 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12507 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12508 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12509 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12510
12511 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12512 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12513 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12514 these variables contain the
12515 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12516
12517
12518 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12519 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12520 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12521 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12522 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12523 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12524 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12525
12526 .vitem &$return_path$&
12527 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12528 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12529 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12530 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12531 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12532 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12533 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12534 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12535 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12536 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12537 envelope sender.
12538
12539 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12540 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12541 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12542
12543 .vitem &$router_name$&
12544 .cindex "router" "name"
12545 .cindex "name" "of router"
12546 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12547 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12548
12549 .vitem &$runrc$&
12550 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12551 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12552 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12553 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12554 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12555 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12556 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12557 another.
12558
12559 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12560 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12561 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12562 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12563 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12564 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12565 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12566 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12567
12568 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12569 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12570 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12571 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12572 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12573 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12574
12575 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12576 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12577 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12578 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12579 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12580 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12581 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12582 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12583
12584 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12585 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12586 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12587
12588 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12589 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12590 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12591
12592 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12593 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12594 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12595 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12596 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12597 this:
12598 .display
12599 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12600 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12601 .endd
12602 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12603 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12604 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12605 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12606
12607 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12608 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12609 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12610 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12611 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12612 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12613 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12614 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12615 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12616 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12617 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12618 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12619 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12620
12621 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12622 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12623 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12624 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12625 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12626
12627 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12628 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12629 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12630 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12631 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12632 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12633
12634 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12635 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12636 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12637 this variable contains that
12638 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12639
12640 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12641 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12642 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12643 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12644 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12645 &$authenticated_id$&.
12646
12647 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12648 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12649 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12650 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12651 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12652 resolver library states that both
12653 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12654 other times, this variable is false.
12655
12656 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12657 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12658 library, by setting:
12659 .code
12660 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12661 .endd
12662
12663 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12664 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12665
12666 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12667 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12668
12669 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12670 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12671 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12672 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12673
12674
12675 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12676 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12677 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12678 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12679 other means, this variable is empty.
12680
12681 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12682 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12683 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12684 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12685 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12686 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12687 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12688
12689 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12690 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12691 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12692 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12693
12694 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12695 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12696 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12697 is set to &"1"&.
12698
12699 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12700 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12701 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12702 following are true:
12703
12704 .ilist
12705 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12706 .next
12707 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12708 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12709 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12710 .next
12711 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12712 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12713 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12714 .next
12715 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12716 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12717 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12718 .next
12719 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12720 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12721 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12722 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12723 .code
12724 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12725 .endd
12726 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12727 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12728 .endlist
12729
12730
12731 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12732 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12733 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12734 number that was used on the remote host.
12735
12736 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12737 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12738 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12739 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12740 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12741 called Exim.
12742
12743 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12744 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12745 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12746 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12747
12748 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12749 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12750 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12751 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12752 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12753 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12754 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12755 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12756 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12757 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12758 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12759 the parentheses.
12760
12761 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12762 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12763 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12764 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12765 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12766
12767 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12768 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12769 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12770 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12771 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12772
12773 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12774 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12775 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12776 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12777 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12778 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12779 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12780
12781 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12782 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12783 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12784 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12785 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12786
12787 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12788 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12789 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12790 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12791 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12792 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12793
12794 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12795 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12796 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12797 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12798 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12799 .code
12800 MAIL FROM:<>
12801 MAIL FROM: <>
12802 .endd
12803 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12804 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12805 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12806 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12807
12808 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12809 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12810 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12811 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12812 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12813 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12814 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12815
12816 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
12817 .cindex SMTP "command history"
12818 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
12819 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
12820 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
12821 are remembered.
12822
12823 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12824 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12825 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12826 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12827 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12828 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12829 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12830 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12831 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12832 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12833 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12834
12835 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12836 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12837 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12838 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12839 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12840 message is junk mail.
12841
12842 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12843 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12844 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12845 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12846
12847 .new
12848 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
12849 &$spf_received$& &&&
12850 &$spf_result$& &&&
12851 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
12852 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
12853 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
12854 .wen
12855
12856 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12857 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12858 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12859
12860 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12861 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12862 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12863 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12864 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12865 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12866
12867 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12868 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12869 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12870 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12871 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12872 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12873 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12874 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12875 .code
12876 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12877 .endd
12878 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12879
12880
12881 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12882 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12883 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12884 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12885 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12886 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12887
12888 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12889 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12890 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12891 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12892 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12893 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12894 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12895 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12896
12897 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12898 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12899 the outbound.
12900
12901 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12902 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12903 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12904 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12905 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12906 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12907
12908 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12909 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12910 .cindex certificate variables
12911 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12912 inbound connection when the message was received.
12913 It is only useful as the argument of a
12914 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12915 or a &%def%& condition.
12916
12917 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
12918 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
12919
12920 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12921 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12922 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12923 inbound connection when the message was received.
12924 It is only useful as the argument of a
12925 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12926 or a &%def%& condition.
12927 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12928 which is not the leaf.
12929
12930 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12931 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12932 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12933 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12934 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12935 or a &%def%& condition.
12936
12937 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12938 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12939 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12940 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12941 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12942 or a &%def%& condition.
12943 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12944 which is not the leaf.
12945
12946 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12947 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12948 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12949 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12950
12951 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12952 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12953 the outbound.
12954
12955 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12956 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12957 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12958 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12959 and &"0"& otherwise.
12960
12961 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12962 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12963 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12964 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12965 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12966 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12967 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12968 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12969 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12970
12971 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12972 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12973 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12974
12975 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12976 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12977 This variable is
12978 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12979 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12980 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12981 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12982
12983 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12984 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12985 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12986 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12987 .code
12988 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12989 1 No response to request
12990 2 Response not verified
12991 3 Verification failed
12992 4 Verification succeeded
12993 .endd
12994
12995 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12996 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12997 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12998 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12999 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13000
13001 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13002 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13003 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13004 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13005 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13006 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13007 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13008 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13009 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13010 which is not the leaf.
13011
13012 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13013 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13014 the outbound.
13015
13016 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13017 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13018 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13019 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13020 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13021 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13022 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13023 which is not the leaf.
13024
13025 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13026 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13027 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13028 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13029 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13030 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13031 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13032 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13033 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13034 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13035 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13036
13037 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13038 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13039 the outbound.
13040
13041 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13042 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13043 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13044 During outbound
13045 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13046 the transport.
13047
13048 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13049 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13050 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13051 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13052
13053 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13054 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13055 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13056
13057 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13058 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13059 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13060
13061 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13062 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13063 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13064 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13065 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13066 values for those that are behind (west).
13067
13068 .vitem &$tod_log$&
13069 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13070 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13071 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13072
13073 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13074 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13075 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13076 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13077 flag.
13078
13079 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13080 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13081 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13082 -0500.
13083
13084 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13085 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13086 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13087 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13088
13089 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13090 .cindex "transport" "name"
13091 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13092 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13093 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13094
13095 .vitem &$value$&
13096 .vindex "&$value$&"
13097 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13098 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13099 &*reduce*& expansion.
13100
13101 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13102 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13103 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13104 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13105 Otherwise, empty.
13106
13107 .vitem &$version_number$&
13108 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13109 The version number of Exim.
13110
13111 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13112 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13113 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13114 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13115
13116 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13117 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13118 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13119 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13120 .endlist
13121 .ecindex IIDstrexp
13122
13123
13124
13125 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13126 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13127
13128 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13129 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13130 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13131 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13132 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13133 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13134 the line
13135 .code
13136 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13137 .endd
13138 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13139
13140
13141 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13142 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13143 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13144 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13145 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13146 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13147 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13148 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13149 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13150
13151 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13152 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13153 should usually be something like
13154 .code
13155 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13156 .endd
13157 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13158 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13159 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13160 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13161 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13162 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13163 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13164 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13165 two ways:
13166
13167 .ilist
13168 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13169 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13170 a startup when Exim is entered.
13171 .next
13172 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13173 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13174 .endlist
13175
13176 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13177 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13178
13179 .ilist
13180 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13181 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13182 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13183 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13184 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13185 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13186 defaults to false.
13187
13188
13189 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13190 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13191 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13192 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13193 forms:
13194 .code
13195 ${perl{foo}}
13196 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13197 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13198 .endd
13199 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13200 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13201 with an error message of the form
13202 .code
13203 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13204 .endd
13205 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13206 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13207 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13208 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13209 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13210 that was passed to &%die%&.
13211
13212
13213 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13214 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13215 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13216 the Perl code
13217 .code
13218 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13219 .endd
13220 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13221 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13222 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13223
13224 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13225 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13226 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13227 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13228
13229 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13230 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13231 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13232 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13233 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13234 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13235 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13236
13237
13238 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13239 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13240 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13241 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13242 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13243 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13244 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13245 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13246 avoided, but the output is lost.
13247
13248 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13249 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13250 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13251 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13252 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13253 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13254 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13255 .code
13256 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13257 .endd
13258 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13259 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13260 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13261 as the first subroutine argument.
13262 .ecindex IIDperl
13263
13264
13265 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13266 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13267
13268 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13269 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13270 "Starting the daemon"
13271 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13272 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13273 .cindex "network interface"
13274 .cindex "interface" "network"
13275 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13276 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13277 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13278 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13279 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13280 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13281 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13282 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13283 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13284 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13285 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13286
13287 .olist
13288 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13289 and ports to listen on.
13290 .next
13291 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13292 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13293 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13294 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13295 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13296 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13297 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13298 as an error situation.
13299 .next
13300 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13301 for the outgoing connection.
13302 .endlist
13303
13304
13305 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13306 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13307 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13308 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13309 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13310
13311 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13312 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13313 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13314 chapter describes how they operate.
13315
13316 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13317 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13318
13319
13320
13321 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13322 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13323 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13324 following options:
13325
13326 .ilist
13327 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13328 or service names.
13329 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13330 .next
13331 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13332 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13333 .endlist
13334
13335 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13336 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13337 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13338 colons. For example:
13339 .code
13340 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13341 192.168.23.65 ; \
13342 ::1 ; \
13343 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13344 .endd
13345 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13346 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13347
13348 .olist
13349 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13350 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13351 .code
13352 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13353 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13354 .endd
13355 .next
13356 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13357 with a colon separator, for example:
13358 .code
13359 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13360 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13361 .endd
13362 .endlist
13363
13364 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13365 default setting contains just one port:
13366 .code
13367 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13368 .endd
13369 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13370 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13371 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13372 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13373 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13374
13375
13376
13377 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13378 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13379 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13380 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13381 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13382 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13383 .code
13384 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13385 .endd
13386 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13387 .code
13388 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13389 .endd
13390 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13391
13392
13393
13394 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13395 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13396 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13397 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13398 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13399 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13400 exim.
13401
13402 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13403 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13404 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13405 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13406 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13407 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13408 .code
13409 -oX 1225
13410 .endd
13411 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13412 whereas
13413 .code
13414 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13415 .endd
13416 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13417 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13418 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13419
13420
13421
13422 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13423 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13424 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13425 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13426 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13427 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13428 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13429 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13430 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13431 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13432 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13433 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13434 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13435 the 465 TCP ports.
13436
13437 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13438 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13439 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13440
13441 The common use of this option is expected to be
13442 .code
13443 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13444 .endd
13445 per RFC 8314.
13446 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13447 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13448
13449 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13450 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13451 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13452 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13453 connections via the daemon.)
13454
13455
13456
13457
13458 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13459 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13460 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13461 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13462 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13463 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13464 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13465 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13466 .code
13467 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13468 .endd
13469 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13470 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13471 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13472 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13473 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13474 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13475 .code
13476 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13477 .endd
13478 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13479 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13480 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13481 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13482 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13483
13484 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13485 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13486 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13487 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13488 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13489 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13490 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13491 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13492 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13493 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13494 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13495 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13496
13497 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13498 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13499 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13500 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13501 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13502
13503
13504
13505 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13506 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13507 .code
13508 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13509 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13510 .endd
13511 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13512 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13513 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13514 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13515
13516 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13517 .code
13518 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13519 .endd
13520 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13521 .code
13522 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13523 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13524 .endd
13525 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13526 IPv4 loopback address only:
13527 .code
13528 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13529 .endd
13530 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13531 .code
13532 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13533 .endd
13534 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13535
13536
13537
13538 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13539 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13540 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13541 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13542 treated as local.
13543
13544 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13545 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13546 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13547 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13548
13549 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13550 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13551 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13552 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13553 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13554 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13555 used for listening. Consider this example:
13556 .code
13557 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13558 192.168.53.235 ; \
13559 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13560
13561 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13562 .endd
13563 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13564 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13565 Exim is routing.
13566
13567 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13568 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13569 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13570 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13571 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13572 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13573 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13574 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13575
13576
13577
13578 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13579 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13580 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13581 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13582 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13583 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13584 details.
13585
13586
13587
13588
13589 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13590 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13591
13592 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13593 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13594 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13595 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13596
13597 .ilist
13598 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13599 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13600 .next
13601 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13602 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13603 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13604 .next
13605 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13606 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13607 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13608 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13609 settings.
13610 .endlist
13611
13612 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13613 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13614 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13615 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13616 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13617 listed in more than one group.
13618
13619 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13620 .table2
13621 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13622 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13623 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13624 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13625 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13626 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13627 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13628 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13629 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13630 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13631 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13632 .endtable
13633
13634
13635 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13636 .table2
13637 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13638 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13639 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13640 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13641 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13642 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13643 .endtable
13644
13645
13646
13647 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13648 .table2
13649 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13650 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13651 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13652 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13653 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13654 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13655 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13656 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13657 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13658 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13659 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13660 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13661 .endtable
13662
13663
13664
13665 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13666 .table2
13667 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13668 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13669 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13670 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13671 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13672 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13673 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13674 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13675 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13676 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13677 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13678 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13679 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13680 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13681 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13682 .endtable
13683
13684
13685
13686 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13687 .table2
13688 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13689 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13690 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13691 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13692 .endtable
13693
13694
13695
13696 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13697 .table2
13698 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13699 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13700 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13701 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13702 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13703 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13704 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13705 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13706 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13707 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13708 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13709 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13710 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13711 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13712 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13713 .endtable
13714
13715
13716
13717 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13718 .table2
13719 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13720 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13721 .endtable
13722
13723
13724
13725 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13726 .table2
13727 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13728 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13729 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13730 .endtable
13731
13732
13733
13734 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13735 .table2
13736 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13737 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13738 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13739 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13740 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13741 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13742 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13743 .endtable
13744
13745
13746
13747 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13748 .table2
13749 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13750 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13751 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13752 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13753 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13754 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13755 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13756 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13757 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13758 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13759 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13760 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13761 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13762 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13763 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13764 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13765 connection"
13766 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13767 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13768 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13769 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13770 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13771 .endtable
13772
13773
13774
13775 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13776 .table2
13777 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13778 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13779 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13780 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13781 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13782 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13783 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13784 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13785 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13786 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13787 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13788 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13789 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13790 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13791 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13792 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13793 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13794 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13795 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13796 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13797 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13798 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13799 words""&"
13800 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13801 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13802 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13803 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13804 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13805 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13806 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13807 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13808 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13809 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13810 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13811 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13812 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13813 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13814 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13815 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13816 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13817 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13818 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13819 .endtable
13820
13821
13822
13823 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13824 .table2
13825 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13826 item"
13827 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13828 item"
13829 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13830 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13831 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13832 .endtable
13833
13834
13835
13836 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13837 .table2
13838 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13839 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13840 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13841 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13842 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13843 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13844 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13845 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13846 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13847 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13848 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13849 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13850 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13851 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13852 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13853 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13854 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13855 .endtable
13856
13857
13858
13859 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13860 .table2
13861 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13862 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13863 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13864 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13865 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13866 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13867 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13868 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13869 .endtable
13870
13871
13872
13873 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13874 .table2
13875 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13876 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13877 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13878 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13879 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13880 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13881 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13882 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13883 .endtable
13884
13885
13886
13887
13888 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13889 .table2
13890 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13891 .endtable
13892
13893
13894
13895
13896
13897 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13898 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13899
13900 .table2
13901 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13902 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13903 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13904 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13905 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13906 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13907 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13908 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13909 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13910 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13911 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13912 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13913 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13914 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13915 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13916 connection"
13917 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13918 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13919 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13920 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13921 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13922 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13923 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13924 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13925 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13926 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13927 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13928 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13929 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13930 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13931 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13932 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13933 .endtable
13934
13935
13936
13937 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13938 .table2
13939 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13940 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13941 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
13942 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13943 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13944 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13945 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13946 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13947 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
13948 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13949 .endtable
13950
13951
13952
13953 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13954 .table2
13955 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13956 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13957 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13958 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13959 words""&"
13960 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13961 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13962 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13963 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13964 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13965 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13966 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13967 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13968 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13969 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13970 .endtable
13971
13972
13973
13974 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13975 .table2
13976 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13977 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13978 directory"
13979 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13980 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13981 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13982 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13983 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13984 .endtable
13985
13986
13987
13988 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13989 .table2
13990 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13991 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13992 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13993 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13994 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13995 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13996 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13997 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13998 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13999 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14000 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14001 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14002 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14003 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14004 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14005 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14006 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14007 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14008 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14009 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14010 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14011 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14012 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14013 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14014 .endtable
14015
14016
14017
14018 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14019 .table2
14020 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14021 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14022 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14023 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14024 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14025 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14026 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14027 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14028 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14029 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14030 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14031 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14032 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14033 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14034 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14035 .endtable
14036
14037
14038
14039 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14040 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14041 &dagger;.
14042
14043 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14044 .cindex "8BITMIME"
14045 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14046 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14047 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14048 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14049 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14050 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14051 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14052
14053 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14054 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14055 It now defaults to true.
14056 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14057 .display
14058 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14059 .endd
14060
14061 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14062 .code
14063 log_selector = +8bitmime
14064 .endd
14065
14066 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14067 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14068 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14069 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14070 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14071 further details.
14072
14073 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14074 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14075 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14076 SMTP messages.
14077
14078 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14079 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14080 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14081 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14082 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14083
14084 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14085 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14086 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14087 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14088 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14089
14090 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14091 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14092 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14093 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14094
14095 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14096 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14097 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14098 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14099 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14100
14101 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14102 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14103 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14104 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14105 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14106 This option defines the ACL that,
14107 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14108 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14109 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14110 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14111
14112 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14113 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14114 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14115 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14116 of a received message.
14117 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14118
14119 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14120 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14121 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14122 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14123
14124 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14125 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14126 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14127 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14128
14129 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14130 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14131 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14132 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14133 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14134
14135
14136 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14137 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14138 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14139 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14140
14141 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14142 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14143 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14144 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14145 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14146
14147 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14148 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14149 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14150 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14151 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14152
14153 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14154 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14155 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14156 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14157 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14158
14159 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14160 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14161 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14162 further details.
14163
14164 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14165 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14166 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14167 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14168
14169 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14170 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14171 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14172 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14173
14174 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14175 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14176 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14177 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14178
14179 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14180 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14181 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14182 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14183
14184 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14185 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14186 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14187 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14188 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14189
14190 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14191 .cindex "admin user"
14192 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14193 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14194 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14195 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14196 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14197 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14198 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14199
14200 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14201 .cindex "domain literal"
14202 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14203 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14204 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14205 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14206
14207 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14208 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14209 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14210 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14211 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14212 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14213 the local host's IP addresses.
14214
14215
14216 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14217 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14218 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14219 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14220 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14221 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14222 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14223 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14224 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14225
14226 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14227 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14228 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14229 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14230 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14231 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14232 experiment if they wish.
14233
14234 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14235 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14236 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14237 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14238 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14239 suitable setting is:
14240 .code
14241 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14242 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14243 .endd
14244 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14245 .code
14246 dns_check_names_pattern =
14247 .endd
14248 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14249
14250
14251 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14252 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14253 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14254 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14255 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14256 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14257 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14258 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14259 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14260 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14261 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14262
14263 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14264 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14265 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14266 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14267 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14268 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14269
14270 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14271 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14272 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14273 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14274 .code
14275 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14276 .endd
14277 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14278 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14279 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14280 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14281
14282
14283 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14284 .cindex "thawing messages"
14285 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14286 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14287 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14288 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14289 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14290 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14291
14292 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14293 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14294 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14295
14296
14297 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14298 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14299 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14300 .code
14301 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14302 .endd
14303 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14304 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14305
14306
14307 .option bi_command main string unset
14308 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14309 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14310 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14311 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14312 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14313
14314
14315 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14316 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14317 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14318 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14319 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14320 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14321
14322
14323 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14324 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14325 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14326 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14327
14328 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14329 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14330 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14331 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14332 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14333 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14334 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14335 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14336 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14337 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14338
14339 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14340 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14341 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14342 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14343 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14344 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14345 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14346 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14347 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14348 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14349
14350 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14351 during reception of a message.
14352 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14353
14354 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14355
14356
14357 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14358 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14359 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14360 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14361
14362
14363 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14364 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14365 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14366 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14367 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14368 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14369 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14370 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14371 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14372
14373 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14374 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14375 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14376 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14377 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14378 messages.
14379
14380 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14381 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14382 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14383 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14384 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14385 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14386 connection. A typical setting might be:
14387 .code
14388 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14389 .endd
14390 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14391 .code
14392 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14393 .endd
14394 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14395 address.
14396
14397 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14398 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14399 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14400 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14401 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14402 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14403
14404
14405 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14406 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14407 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14408 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14409
14410
14411 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14412 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14413 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14414 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14415
14416
14417 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14418 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14419 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14420 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14421
14422
14423 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14424 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14425 callout verification. The default value is
14426 .code
14427 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14428 .endd
14429 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14430
14431
14432 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14433 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14434
14435
14436 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14437 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14438
14439 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14440 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14441 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14442 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14443 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14444 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14445 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14446 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14447 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14448 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14449
14450
14451 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14452 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14453
14454
14455 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14456 .cindex "checking disk space"
14457 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14458 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14459 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14460 message is accepted.
14461
14462 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14463 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14464 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14465 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14466 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14467 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14468 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14469 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14470
14471
14472 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14473 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14474 .code
14475 check_spool_space = 100M
14476 check_spool_inodes = 100
14477 .endd
14478 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14479 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14480 transit.
14481
14482 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14483 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14484 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14485
14486 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14487 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14488 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14489 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14490 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14491 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14492
14493 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14494 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14495 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14496
14497 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14498 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14499 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14500
14501 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14502 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14503 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14504 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14505
14506 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14507 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14508 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14509 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14510 these hosts.
14511 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14512
14513 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14514 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14515 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14516 administrative user.
14517 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14518
14519 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14520 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14521 .cindex memory debugging
14522 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14523 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14524 it should normally be left as default.
14525
14526 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14527 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14528 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14529 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14530 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14531 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14532
14533 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14534 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14535 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14536 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14537 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14538 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14539 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14540
14541 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14542 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14543
14544 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14545 .cindex "warning of delay"
14546 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14547 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14548 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14549 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14550 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14551 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14552 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14553 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14554 with
14555 .code
14556 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14557 .endd
14558 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14559 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14560 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14561 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14562 .code
14563 delay_warning = 6h
14564 .endd
14565 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14566 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14567 .code
14568 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14569 .endd
14570 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14571 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14572 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14573
14574 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14575 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14576 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14577 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14578 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14579 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14580 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14581 not sent. The default is:
14582 .code
14583 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14584 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14585 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14586 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14587 } {no}{yes}}
14588 .endd
14589 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14590 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14591 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14592 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14593
14594 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14595 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14596 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14597 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14598 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14599 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14600 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14601 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14602
14603 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14604 .cindex "load average"
14605 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14606 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14607 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14608 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14609 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14610
14611
14612 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14613 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14614 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14615 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14616 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14617 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14618 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14619 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14620
14621 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14622 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14623 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14624 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14625 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14626 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14627 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14628 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14629
14630 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14631 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14632 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14633 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14634
14635
14636 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14637 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14638 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14639 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14640 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14641 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14642 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14643
14644
14645 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14646 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14647 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14648 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14649 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14650 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
14651
14652
14653 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14654 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14655 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14656 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14657 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14658 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14659 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14660 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14661 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14662 by a setting such as this:
14663 .code
14664 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14665 .endd
14666 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14667 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14668 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14669 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14670 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14671 options are applied after this global option.
14672
14673 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14674 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14675 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14676 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14677 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14678 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14679 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14680 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14681 value of this option. The default pattern is
14682 .code
14683 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14684 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14685 .endd
14686 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14687 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14688 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14689 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14690 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14691 empty string.
14692
14693 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14694 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14695 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14696
14697 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14698 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14699 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14700 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14701
14702
14703 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14704 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14705 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14706 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14707 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14708 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14709
14710 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14711
14712
14713 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14714 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14715 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14716 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
14717 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14718 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14719 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14720 domain matches this list.
14721
14722 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14723 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14724 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14725
14726
14727 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14728 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14729 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14730 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14731 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14732 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14733 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14734 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14735 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14736 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14737 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14738 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14739 to set in them.
14740 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14741
14742
14743 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14744 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14745
14746
14747 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14748 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14749 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14750 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14751 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14752 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14753 match with this expanded domain list.
14754
14755 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14756 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14757 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14758 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14759 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14760 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14761
14762 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14763 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14764 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14765
14766 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14767 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14768 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14769 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14770 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14771
14772 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14773 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14774 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14775 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14776 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14777 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14778 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14779 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14780 on.
14781
14782 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14783
14784 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14785 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14786 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14787
14788
14789 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14790 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14791 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14792 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14793
14794 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14795 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14796 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14797 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14798 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14799 and accepted from, these hosts.
14800 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14801 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14802 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14803 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14804 are sent.
14805
14806 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14807 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14808 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14809 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14810 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14811 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14812 .code
14813 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14814 .endd
14815 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14816 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14817
14818 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14819 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14820 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14821 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14822 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14823 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14824 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14825 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14826 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14827
14828
14829 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14830 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14831 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14832 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14833 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14834 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14835 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14836 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14837 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14838
14839 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14840 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14841 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14842 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14843 are examined. For example:
14844 .code
14845 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14846 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14847 postmaster@mydomain.example
14848 .endd
14849 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14850 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14851 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14852 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14853 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14854 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14855 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14856
14857
14858 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14859 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14860 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14861 .display
14862 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14863 .endd
14864 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14865 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14866 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14867 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14868 overrides the default.
14869
14870 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14871 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14872 and warning messages. For example:
14873 .code
14874 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14875 .endd
14876 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14877 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14878 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14879 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14880 not used.
14881
14882
14883 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14884 .cindex events
14885 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14886 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14887
14888
14889 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14890 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14891 .cindex "Exim group"
14892 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14893 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14894 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14895 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14896 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14897 security issues.
14898
14899
14900 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14901 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14902 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14903 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14904 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14905 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14906 other place.
14907 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14908 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14909 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14910 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14911
14912
14913 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14914 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14915 .cindex "Exim user"
14916 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14917 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14918 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14919 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14920
14921 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14922 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14923 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14924 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14925
14926
14927 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14928 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14929 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14930 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14931
14932
14933 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14934 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14935
14936 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14937 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14938 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14939 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14940 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14941 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14942 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14943 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14944 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14945 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14946 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14947 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14948 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14949 addresses.
14950
14951
14952 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14953 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14954 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14955 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14956 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14957 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14958 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14959 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14960 retries.
14961
14962 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14963 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14964 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14965 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14966
14967
14968
14969 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14970 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14971 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14972 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14973 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14974 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14975 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14976 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14977 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14978 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14979 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14980 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14981 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14982 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14983 logging that you require.
14984
14985
14986 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14987 .cindex "HP-UX"
14988 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14989 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14990 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14991 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14992 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14993 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14994 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14995 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14996
14997 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14998 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14999 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15000 user's name.
15001
15002 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15003 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15004 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15005 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15006 .code
15007 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15008 gecos_name = $1
15009 .endd
15010
15011 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15012 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15013
15014
15015 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15016 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15017 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15018 implementations of TLS.
15019
15020
15021 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15022 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15023 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15024
15025 See
15026 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15027 for documentation.
15028
15029
15030
15031 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15032 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15033 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15034 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15035 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15036 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15037
15038
15039
15040 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15041 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15042 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15043 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15044 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15045 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15046 sections are rejected.
15047
15048
15049 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15050 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15051 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15052 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15053 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15054 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15055 zero means &"no limit"&.
15056
15057
15058
15059
15060 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15061 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15062 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15063 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15064 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15065 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15066 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15067 if you want to do semantic checking.
15068 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15069 set.
15070
15071
15072 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15073 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15074 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15075 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15076 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15077 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15078 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15079 .code
15080 helo_allow_chars = _
15081 .endd
15082 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15083
15084
15085 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15086 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15087 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15088 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15089 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15090 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15091 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15092 do.
15093
15094
15095 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15096 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15097 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15098 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15099 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15100 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15101 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15102 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15103 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15104 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15105 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15106 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15107
15108 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15109 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15110 EHLO command either:
15111
15112 .ilist
15113 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15114 .next
15115 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15116 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15117 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15118 calling host address, or
15119 .next
15120 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15121 .endlist
15122
15123 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15124 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15125 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15126
15127 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15128 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15129 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15130
15131 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15132 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15133 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15134 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15135 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15136 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15137 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15138 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15139 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15140 error.
15141
15142 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15143 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15144 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15145 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15146 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15147 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15148 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15149 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15150 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15151
15152 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15153 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15154 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15155 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15156 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15157
15158 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15159 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15160 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15161 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15162
15163
15164 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15165 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15166 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15167 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15168 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15169 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15170 default configuration file contains
15171 .code
15172 host_lookup = *
15173 .endd
15174 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15175 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15176
15177 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15178 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15179 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15180
15181 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15182 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15183 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15184 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15185 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15186 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15187
15188
15189 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15190 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15191 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15192 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15193 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15194 if you want.
15195
15196 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15197 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15198 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15199 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15200
15201
15202
15203 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15204 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15205 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15206 as soon as the connection is made.
15207 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15208 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15209 connections immediately.
15210
15211 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15212 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15213 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15214 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15215 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15216
15217
15218 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15219 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15220 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15221 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15222 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15223 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15224 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15225 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15226 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15227 .code
15228 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15229 .endd
15230 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15231
15232
15233
15234 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15235 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15236 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15237 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15238
15239
15240 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15241 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15242 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15243 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15244 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15245 records
15246 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15247 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15248
15249 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15250 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15251 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15252 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15253 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15254 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15255 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15256
15257
15258 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15259 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15260 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15261 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15262 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15263
15264
15265
15266 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15267 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15268 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15269 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15270 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15271 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15272
15273 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15274 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15275 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15276 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15277 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15278 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15279 for frozen messages. For example,
15280 .code
15281 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15282 .endd
15283 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15284 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15285 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15286 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15287 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15288 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15289
15290
15291 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15292 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15293 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15294 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15295 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15296 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15297 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15298 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15299 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15300 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15301
15302
15303 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15304 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15305
15306 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15307 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15308 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15309 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15310 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15311 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15312 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15313 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15314 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15315
15316 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15317 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15318
15319 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15320 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15321 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15322 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15323
15324 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15325 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15326 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15327 anymore.
15328
15329 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15330 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15331 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15332 details.
15333
15334
15335 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15336 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15337 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15338 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15339 logged.
15340
15341
15342 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15343 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15344 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15345 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15346 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15347 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15348 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15349 and constrained to be a directory.
15350
15351
15352 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15353 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15354 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15355 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15356 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15357 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15358 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15359 and constrained to be a file.
15360
15361
15362 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15363 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15364 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15365 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15366 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15367 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15368
15369
15370 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15371 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15372 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15373 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15374 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15375 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15376 identity to be proven.
15377
15378
15379 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15380 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15381 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15382 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15383 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15384
15385
15386 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15387 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15388 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15389 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15390 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15391 with LDAP support.
15392
15393
15394 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15395 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15396 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15397 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15398 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15399 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15400 to hard/demand.
15401
15402
15403 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15404 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15405 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15406 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15407 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15408 of SSL-on-connect.
15409 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15410 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15411 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15412
15413
15414 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15415 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15416 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15417 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15418 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15419 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15420 has been built with LDAP support.
15421
15422
15423
15424 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15425 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15426 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15427 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15428 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15429 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15430 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15431
15432 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15433 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15434 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15435
15436 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15437 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15438 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15439 and the default qualify domain.
15440
15441 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15442 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15443 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15444 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15445
15446 .cindex "envelope sender"
15447 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15448 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15449 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15450
15451 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15452 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15453 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15454
15455
15456
15457
15458 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15459 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15460 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15461 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15462 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15463 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15464 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15465 example, if
15466 .code
15467 local_from_prefix = *-
15468 .endd
15469 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15470 .code
15471 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15472 .endd
15473 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15474 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15475 qualify domain.
15476
15477
15478 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15479 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15480
15481
15482 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15483 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15484 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15485 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15486 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15487 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15488 &%local_interfaces%& is
15489 .code
15490 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15491 .endd
15492 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15493 .code
15494 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15495 .endd
15496
15497 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15498 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15499 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15500 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15501 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15502 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15503 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15504 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15505
15506
15507
15508 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15509 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15510 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15511 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15512 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15513 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15514 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15515 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15516
15517
15518
15519
15520 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15521 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15522 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15523 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15524 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15525 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15526 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15527 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15528 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15529 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15530 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15531 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15532 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15533 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15534 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15535
15536
15537
15538 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15539 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15540 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15541 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15542 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15543 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15544 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15545 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15546 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15547 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15548 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15549 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15550 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15551 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15552 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15553
15554
15555 .option log_selector main string unset
15556 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15557 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15558 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15559 minus characters. For example:
15560 .code
15561 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15562 .endd
15563 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15564 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15565
15566
15567 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15568 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15569 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15570 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15571 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15572 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15573 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15574 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15575 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15576 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15577 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15578 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15579 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15580
15581
15582 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15583 .cindex "too many open files"
15584 .cindex "open files, too many"
15585 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15586 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15587 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15588 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15589 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15590 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15591 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15592 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15593 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15594 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15595 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15596 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15597
15598
15599 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15600 .cindex "length of login name"
15601 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15602 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15603 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15604 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15605 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15606 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15607
15608
15609 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15610 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15611 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15612 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15613 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15614 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15615 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15616 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15617
15618
15619 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15620 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15621 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15622 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15623 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15624 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15625 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15626
15627
15628 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15629 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15630 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15631 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15632 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15633 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15634 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15635 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15636 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15637 empty string, the option is ignored.
15638
15639
15640 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15641 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15642 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15643 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15644 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15645 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15646 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15647 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15648 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15649 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15650 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15651 colons will become hyphens.
15652
15653
15654 .option message_logs main boolean true
15655 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15656 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15657 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15658 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15659 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15660 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15661 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15662 which is not affected by this option.
15663
15664
15665 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15666 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15667 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15668 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15669 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15670 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15671 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15672 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15673 optionally followed by K or M.
15674
15675 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15676 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15677 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15678 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15679 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15680
15681 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15682 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15683 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15684 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15685 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15686 message that an individual transport can process.
15687
15688 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15689 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15690 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15691 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15692 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15693 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15694 some problems may result.
15695
15696 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15697 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15698 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15699
15700
15701 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15702 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15703 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15704 .code
15705 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15706 .endd
15707 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15708 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15709 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15710 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15711 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15712
15713
15714 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15715 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15716 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15717 contains a full description of this facility.
15718
15719
15720
15721 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15722 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15723 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15724 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15725 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15726
15727
15728 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15729 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15730 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15731 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15732 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15733 safety precaution.
15734
15735 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15736 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15737 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15738 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15739 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15740
15741 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15742 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15743 example is
15744 .code
15745 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15746 .endd
15747 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15748 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15749 transport driver.
15750
15751
15752 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15753 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15754 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15755 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15756 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15757
15758 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15759 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15760 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15761 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15762 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15763 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15764 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15765
15766 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15767 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15768 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15769 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15770 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15771
15772 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15773
15774 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15775 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15776 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15777 some now infamous attacks.
15778
15779 Examples:
15780 .code
15781 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15782 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15783 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15784
15785 # Disable older protocol versions:
15786 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15787 .endd
15788
15789 Possible options may include:
15790 .ilist
15791 &`all`&
15792 .next
15793 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15794 .next
15795 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15796 .next
15797 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15798 .next
15799 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15800 .next
15801 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15802 .next
15803 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15804 .next
15805 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15806 .next
15807 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15808 .next
15809 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15810 .next
15811 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15812 .next
15813 &`no_compression`&
15814 .next
15815 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15816 .next
15817 &`no_sslv2`&
15818 .next
15819 &`no_sslv3`&
15820 .next
15821 &`no_ticket`&
15822 .next
15823 &`no_tlsv1`&
15824 .next
15825 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15826 .next
15827 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15828 .next
15829 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15830 .next
15831 &`single_dh_use`&
15832 .next
15833 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15834 .next
15835 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15836 .next
15837 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15838 .next
15839 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15840 .next
15841 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15842 .next
15843 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15844 .endlist
15845
15846 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15847 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15848 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15849 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15850 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15851 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15852
15853
15854 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15855 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15856 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15857 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15858 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15859
15860
15861 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15862 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15863 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15864 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15865 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15866 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15867 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15868 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15869 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15870 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15871 an ACL.
15872
15873 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15874 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15875 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15876 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15877 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15878 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15879 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15880
15881
15882 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15883 .cindex "Perl"
15884 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15885 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15886
15887
15888 .option perl_startup main string unset
15889 .cindex "Perl"
15890 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15891 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15892
15893 .option perl_startup main boolean false
15894 .cindex "Perl"
15895 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15896
15897
15898 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15899 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15900 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15901 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15902 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15903 PostgreSQL support.
15904
15905
15906 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15907 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15908 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15909 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15910 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15911 to the host name:
15912 .code
15913 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15914 .endd
15915 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15916 spool directory.
15917 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15918 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15919 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15920
15921
15922 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15923 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15924 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15925 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15926 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15927 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15928 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15929 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15930 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15931
15932
15933 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15934 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15935 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15936 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15937 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15938 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15939 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15940 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15941
15942 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15943 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15944 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15945 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15946 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15947 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15948 volume of mail. Use with care!
15949
15950
15951 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15952 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15953 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15954 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15955 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15956 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15957 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15958 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15959 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15960 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15961
15962 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15963 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15964 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15965 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15966 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15967 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15968
15969
15970 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15971 .cindex "printing characters"
15972 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15973 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15974 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15975 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15976 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15977 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15978 characters.
15979
15980 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15981 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15982 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15983 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15984 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15985 standards.
15986
15987
15988 .option process_log_path main string unset
15989 .cindex "process log path"
15990 .cindex "log" "process log"
15991 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15992 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15993 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15994 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15995 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15996 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15997 different spool directories.
15998
15999
16000 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16001 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16002 .oindex "&%-M%&"
16003 .oindex "&%-R%&"
16004 .oindex "&%-q%&"
16005 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16006 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16007 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16008
16009
16010 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16011 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16012 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16013 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16014 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16015 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16016 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16017 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16018 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16019
16020 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16021 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16022 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16023 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16024 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16025 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16026 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16027
16028
16029 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16030 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16031 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16032
16033
16034
16035 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16036 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16037 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16038 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16039 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16040 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16041 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16042 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16043
16044
16045 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16046 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16047 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
16048 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16049 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16050 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16051 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16052
16053
16054 .option queue_only main boolean false
16055 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16056 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16057 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16058 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16059 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16060 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16061
16062 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16063 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16064 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16065 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16066
16067
16068 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16069 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16070 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16071 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16072 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16073 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16074 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16075 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16076 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16077 .code
16078 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16079 .endd
16080 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16081 &_/some/file_& exists.
16082
16083
16084 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16085 .cindex "load average"
16086 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16087 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16088 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16089 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16090 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16091 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16092 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16093 false.
16094
16095 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16096 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16097 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16098 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16099
16100
16101 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16102 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16103 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16104 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16105 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16106 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16107 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16108 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16109 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16110 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16111 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16112 re-evaluated for each message.
16113
16114
16115 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16116 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16117 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16118 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16119 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16120 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16121
16122
16123 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16124 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16125 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16126 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16127 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16128 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16129 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16130 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16131 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16132 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16133 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16134 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16135 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16136
16137
16138
16139 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16140 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16141 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16142 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16143 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16144 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16145 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16146 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16147 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16148
16149 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16150 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16151 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16152 the daemon's command line.
16153
16154 .cindex queues named
16155 .cindex "named queues"
16156 To set limits for different named queues use
16157 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16158
16159 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16160 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16161 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16162 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16163 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16164 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16165 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16166 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16167 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16168 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16169 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16170 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16171 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16172 &%queue_domains%&.
16173
16174
16175 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16176 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16177 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16178 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16179 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16180 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16181 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16182
16183 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16184 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16185 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16186 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16187 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16188 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16189 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16190 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16191 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16192 header lines. The default setting is:
16193
16194 .code
16195 received_header_text = Received: \
16196 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16197 {${if def:sender_ident \
16198 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16199 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16200 by $primary_hostname \
16201 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16202 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16203 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16204 ${if def:sender_address \
16205 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16206 id $message_exim_id\
16207 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16208 .endd
16209
16210 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16211 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16212 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16213 header lines such as the following:
16214 .code
16215 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16216 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16217 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16218 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16219 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16220 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16221 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16222 .endd
16223 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16224 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16225 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16226 message was accepted.
16227
16228
16229 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16230 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16231 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16232 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16233 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16234 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16235 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16236 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16237
16238
16239 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16240 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16241 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16242 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16243 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16244 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16245 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16246 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16247 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16248 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16249 option was not set.
16250
16251
16252 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16253 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16254 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16255 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16256 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16257 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16258 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16259 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16260 done.
16261
16262 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16263 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16264 RCPT commands in a single message.
16265
16266
16267 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16268 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16269 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16270 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16271 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16272 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16273 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16274
16275
16276 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16277 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16278 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16279 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16280 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16281 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16282 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16283 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16284 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16285 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16286 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16287 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16288 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16289 tagged with its process id.
16290
16291 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16292 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16293 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16294 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16295 is received.
16296
16297 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16298 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16299 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16300 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16301 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16302 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16303 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16304 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16305 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16306 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16307 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16308
16309 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16310 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16311 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16312 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16313
16314
16315 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16316 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16317 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16318 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16319 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16320 .code
16321 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16322 .endd
16323 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16324 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16325
16326
16327 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16328 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16329 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16330 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16331 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16332 past failures.
16333
16334
16335 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16336 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16337 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16338 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16339 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16340 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16341 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16342 the default value.
16343
16344
16345 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16346 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16347 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16348 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16349 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16350 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16351 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16352 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16353 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16354 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16355
16356
16357 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16358 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16359
16360
16361 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16362 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16363 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16364 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16365 an item in the list.
16366 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16367 for the system.
16368
16369 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16370 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16371 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16372 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16373 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16374
16375
16376 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16377 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16378 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16379 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16380 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16381 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16382 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16383 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16384 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16385 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16386
16387 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16388 .cindex "environment"
16389 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16390 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16391 default list is empty,
16392
16393
16394 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16395 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16396 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16397 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16398 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16399 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16400 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16401
16402
16403
16404 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16405 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16406 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16407 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16408 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16409 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16410 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16411 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16412 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16413 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16414 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16415
16416
16417
16418 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16419 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16420 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16421 .cindex "inetd"
16422 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16423 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16424 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16425 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16426 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16427 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16428
16429 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16430 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16431 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16432 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16433
16434
16435 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16436 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16437 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16438 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16439 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16440 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16441 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16442 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16443
16444 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16445 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16446 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16447 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16448 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16449 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16450 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16451 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16452
16453
16454 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16455 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16456 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16457 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16458 live with.
16459
16460
16461 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16462 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16463 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16464 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16465 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16466 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16467 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16468 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16469 . the option name to split.
16470
16471 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16472 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16473 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16474 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16475 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16476 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16477 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16478 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16479 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16480 seen).
16481
16482
16483 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16484 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16485 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16486 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16487 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16488 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16489 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16490 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16491 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16492 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16493 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16494
16495 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16496 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16497 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16498 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16499 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16500 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16501
16502
16503
16504 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16505 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16506 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16507 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16508 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16509 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16510 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16511 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16512 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16513 to all messages received in the same connection.
16514
16515 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16516 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16517 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16518 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16519
16520
16521 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16522
16523 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16524 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16525 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16526 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16527 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16528 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16529 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16530 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16531 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16532 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16533 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16534 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16535 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16536
16537
16538 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16539 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16540 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16541 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16542 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16543 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16544 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16545 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16546 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16547 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16548 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16549 individual host.
16550
16551 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16552 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16553 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16554 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16555
16556
16557 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16558 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16559 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16560 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16561 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16562 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16563 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16564 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16565 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16566
16567 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16568 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16569 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16570 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16571
16572 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16573 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16574 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16575 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16576 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16577 For example:
16578 .code
16579 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16580 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16581 .endd
16582
16583 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16584 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16585 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16586 &%helo_data%& value.
16587
16588 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16589 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16590 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16591 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16592 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16593 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16594 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16595 .code
16596 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16597 $version_number $tod_full
16598 .endd
16599 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16600 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16601 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16602 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16603 multiline response).
16604
16605
16606 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16607 .cindex "checking disk space"
16608 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16609 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16610 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16611 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16612 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16613 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16614 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16615
16616
16617 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16618 .cindex "connection backlog"
16619 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16620 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16621 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16622 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16623 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16624 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16625 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16626 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16627 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16628 attacks by SYN flooding.
16629
16630
16631 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16632 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16633 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16634 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16635 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16636 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16637 fewer, but they still exist.
16638
16639 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16640 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16641 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16642 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16643 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16644 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16645 does detect many instances.
16646
16647 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16648 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16649 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16650 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16651
16652
16653
16654 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16655 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16656 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16657 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16658 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16659 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16660 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16661 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16662 example:
16663 .code
16664 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16665 $sender_host_address
16666 .endd
16667 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16668 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16669 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16670 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16671 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16672 the command.
16673
16674
16675 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16676 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16677 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16678 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16679 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16680
16681
16682 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16683 .cindex "load average"
16684 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16685 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16686 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16687 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16688 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16689 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16690
16691
16692
16693 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16694 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16695 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16696 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16697 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16698 .code
16699 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16700 .endd
16701 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16702 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16703 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16704 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16705 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16706
16707 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16708 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16709 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16710 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16711 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16712 not count towards the limit.
16713
16714
16715
16716 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16717 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16718 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16719 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16720 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16721 that subvert web
16722 clients
16723 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16724 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16725
16726
16727
16728 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16729 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16730 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16731 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16732 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16733 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16734 recipients.
16735
16736 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16737 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16738 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16739 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16740
16741 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16742 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16743 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16744 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16745 values:
16746
16747 .ilist
16748 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16749 .next
16750 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16751 fractional parts are allowed here.
16752 .next
16753 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16754 .next
16755 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16756 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16757 .endlist
16758
16759 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16760 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16761 .code
16762 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16763 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16764 .endd
16765 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16766 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16767 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16768 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16769
16770
16771 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16772 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16773
16774
16775 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16776 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16777
16778
16779 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16780 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16781 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16782 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16783 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16784 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16785 the message is abandoned.
16786 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16787 .code
16788 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16789 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16790 .endd
16791 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16792 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16793
16794 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16795 expanded before use and may depend on
16796 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16797
16798
16799 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16800 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16801 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16802 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16803 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16804 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16805
16806
16807 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16808 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16809 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16810
16811
16812 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16813 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16814 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16815 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16816 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16817 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16818 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16819 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16820 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16821 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16822 .code
16823 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16824 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16825 .endd
16826
16827
16828 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16829 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16830 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16831 the availability thereof is advertised in
16832 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16833 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16834
16835
16836 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
16837 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16838 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16839 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16840
16841
16842
16843 .new
16844 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
16845 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
16846 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
16847 .wen
16848
16849
16850
16851 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16852 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16853 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16854 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16855 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16856 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16857 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16858 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16859 arrival of the message.
16860
16861 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16862 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16863 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16864 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16865 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16866
16867 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16868 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16869 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16870 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16871 automatically deleted.
16872
16873 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16874 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16875 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16876 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16877 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16878 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16879 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16880 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16881 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16882
16883
16884 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16885 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16886 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16887 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16888 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16889 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16890 &$primary_hostname$&.
16891
16892 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16893 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16894 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16895 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16896 as failures in the configuration file.
16897
16898 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16899 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16900
16901 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
16902 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
16903 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternate format
16904 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
16905 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
16906 Currently it is only done for messages received using the EMSTP CHUNKING
16907 option.
16908
16909 The following variables will not have useful values:
16910 .code
16911 $max_received_linelength
16912 $body_linecount
16913 $body_zerocount
16914 .endd
16915
16916 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
16917 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
16918 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
16919 will need to be aware of the potential different format.
16920
16921 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
16922 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is contructed for them).
16923 The transimssion benefit is maintained.
16924
16925 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16926 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16927 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16928 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16929
16930 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16931 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16932 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16933 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16934 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16935 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16936
16937 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16938 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16939 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16940 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16941 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16942 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16943 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16944
16945
16946 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16947 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16948 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16949 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16950 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16951 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16952 domain causes a syntax error.
16953 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16954 syntax checking.
16955
16956
16957 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16958 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16959 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16960 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16961 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16962 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16963 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16964 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16965 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16966 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16967 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16968 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16969
16970
16971 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16972 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16973 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16974 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16975 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16976 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16977 details of Exim's logging.
16978
16979
16980 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
16981 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
16982 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
16983 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
16984 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
16985 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
16986 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16987
16988
16989
16990 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16991 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16992 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16993 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16994 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16995
16996
16997
16998 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16999 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17000 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17001 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17002 details of Exim's logging.
17003
17004
17005 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17006 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17007 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17008 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17009 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17010 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17011 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17012 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17013 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17014 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17015 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17016 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17017
17018
17019 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17020 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17021 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17022 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17023 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17024 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17025
17026
17027 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17028 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17029 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17030 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17031 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17032
17033 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17034 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17035 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17036 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17037 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17038
17039 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17040 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17041 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17042 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17043 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17044 contains the pipe command.
17045
17046
17047 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17048 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17049 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17050 is used in a system filter.
17051
17052
17053 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17054 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17055 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17056 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17057 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17058 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17059 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17060 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17061 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17062 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17063
17064 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17065 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17066 transport option overrides.
17067
17068
17069 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17070 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17071 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17072 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17073 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17074 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17075 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17076 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17077 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17078 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17079 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17080 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17081 TCP_NODELAY.
17082
17083
17084 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17085 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17086 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17087 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17088 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17089 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17090 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17091 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17092 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17093 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17094
17095 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17096 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17097 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17098
17099
17100 .option timezone main string unset
17101 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17102 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17103 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17104 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17105 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17106 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17107 .code
17108 timezone = UTC
17109 .endd
17110 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17111 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17112 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17113 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17114 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17115 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17116
17117
17118 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17119 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17120 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17121 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17122 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17123 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17124 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17125 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17126 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17127 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17128 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17129
17130
17131 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17132 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17133 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17134 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17135 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17136 needed.
17137 The server's private key is also
17138 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17139 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17140
17141 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17142 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17143 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17144 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17145
17146 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17147 separator in the usual way to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17148
17149 &*Note*&: Under current versions of OpenSSL, when a list of more than one
17150 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& veriable is unreliable.
17151
17152 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17153 when a list of more than one file is used.
17154
17155 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17156 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17157 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17158 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17159
17160 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17161 generated for every connection.
17162
17163 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17164 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17165 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17166 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17167 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17168
17169 .new
17170 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17171
17172 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17173 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17174 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17175 .wen
17176
17177 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17178
17179
17180 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17181 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17182 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17183 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17184 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17185 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17186
17187 The value must be at least 1024.
17188
17189 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17190 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17191 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17192
17193 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17194 number.
17195
17196 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17197 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17198 larger prime than requested.
17199
17200
17201 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17202 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17203 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17204 to be used by Exim.
17205
17206 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17207 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17208 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17209 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17210
17211 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17212 then it names a file from which DH
17213 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17214 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17215 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17216 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17217 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17218 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17219
17220 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17221 loaded by Exim.
17222
17223 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17224 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17225 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17226 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17227
17228 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17229 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17230
17231 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17232 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17233 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17234
17235 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17236 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17237 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17238 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17239 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17240
17241 The available standard primes are:
17242 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17243 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17244 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17245 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17246
17247 The available additional primes are:
17248 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17249
17250 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17251 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17252 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17253 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17254 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17255
17256 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17257 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17258 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17259
17260 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17261 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17262 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17263 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17264 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17265 userbase.
17266
17267 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17268 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17269 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17270 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17271 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17272 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17273 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17274
17275
17276 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17277 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17278 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17279 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17280
17281 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17282 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17283 for valid selections.
17284
17285 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17286 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17287 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17288
17289 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17290
17291
17292 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17293 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17294 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17295 This option
17296 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17297 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17298 Certificate Authority.
17299
17300 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17301
17302 .new
17303 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17304 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17305 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17306 .wen
17307
17308
17309 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17310 .cindex SSMTP
17311 .cindex SMTPS
17312 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17313 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17314 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17315 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17316
17317
17318
17319 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17320 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17321 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17322 files which contains the server's private keys.
17323 If this option is unset, or if
17324 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17325 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17326 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17327
17328 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17329
17330
17331 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17332 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17333 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17334 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17335 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17336 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17337 TLS session.
17338
17339
17340 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17341 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17342 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17343 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17344 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17345 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17346 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17347 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17348 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17349 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17350 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17351
17352
17353 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17354 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17355 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17356 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17357
17358
17359 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17360 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17361 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17362 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17363 word "system"
17364 or the absolute path to
17365 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17366 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17367
17368 The "system" value for the option will use a
17369 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17370 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17371 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17372 must be specified.
17373
17374 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17375 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17376
17377 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17378 explicitly
17379 either by file or directory
17380 are added to those given by the system default location.
17381
17382 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17383 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17384 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17385 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17386 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17387 use the explicit directory version.
17388
17389 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17390
17391 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17392 being unset.
17393
17394
17395 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17396 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17397 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17398 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17399 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17400 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17401 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17402 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17403
17404 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17405 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17406 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17407 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17408 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17409 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17410 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17411
17412 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17413 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17414 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17415 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17416 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17417 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17418 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17419 certificate"&.
17420
17421 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17422 certificates.
17423
17424
17425 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17426 .cindex "trusted groups"
17427 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17428 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17429 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17430 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17431 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17432 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17433 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17434 are trusted.
17435
17436 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17437 .cindex "trusted users"
17438 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17439 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17440 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17441 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17442 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17443 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17444 Exim user are trusted.
17445
17446 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17447 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17448 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17449 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17450 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17451 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17452 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17453 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17454 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17455 &%-F%& option.
17456
17457 .option unknown_username main string unset
17458 See &%unknown_login%&.
17459
17460 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17461 .cindex "trusted users"
17462 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17463 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17464 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17465 .cindex "envelope sender"
17466 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17467 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17468 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17469 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17470 is used) is ignored.
17471
17472 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17473 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17474 .code
17475 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17476 .endd
17477 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17478 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17479 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17480 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17481 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17482 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17483 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17484 followed by a hyphen
17485 by a setting like this:
17486 .code
17487 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17488 .endd
17489 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17490 restriction, you can use
17491 .code
17492 untrusted_set_sender = *
17493 .endd
17494 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17495 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17496 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17497 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17498 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17499 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17500 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17501 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17502
17503 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17504 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17505 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17506 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17507 sender address.
17508
17509
17510 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17511 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17512 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17513 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17514 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17515 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17516 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17517 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17518 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17519 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17520 .code
17521 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17522 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17523 .endd
17524 The pattern can be seen by running
17525 .code
17526 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17527 .endd
17528 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17529 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17530 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17531 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17532 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17533 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17534
17535
17536 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17537 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17538
17539
17540 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17541 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17542 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17543 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17544 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17545 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17546 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17547 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17548
17549
17550 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17551 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17552 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17553 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17554 .ecindex IIDconfima
17555 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17556
17557
17558
17559
17560 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17561 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17562
17563 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17564 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17565 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17566 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17567 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17568
17569 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17570 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17571 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17572 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17573 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17574
17575
17576
17577 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17578 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17579 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17580 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17581 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17582 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17583 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17584
17585 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17586 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17587 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17588 routers, and the eventual transport.
17589
17590 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17591 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17592 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17593 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17594 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17595
17596 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17597 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17598 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17599 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17600 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17601
17602 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17603 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17604 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17605 .code
17606 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17607 .endd
17608 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17609 .code
17610 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17611 .endd
17612 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17613 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17614
17615 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17616 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17617 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17618 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17619 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17620 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17621 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17622
17623
17624
17625 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17626 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17627 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17628 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17629 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17630 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17631 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17632 routing.
17633
17634
17635
17636 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17637 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17638 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17639 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17640 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17641 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17642 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17643 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17644 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17645 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17646 you could put:
17647 .code
17648 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17649 .endd
17650 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17651 and
17652 .code
17653 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17654 .endd
17655 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17656 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17657 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17658 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17659
17660
17661 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17662 .cindex "case of local parts"
17663 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17664 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17665 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17666 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17667 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17668 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17669 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17670 more details.
17671
17672 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17673 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17674 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17675 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17676 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17677 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17678 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17679 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17680 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17681
17682 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17683 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17684 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17685 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17686
17687
17688
17689 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17690 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17691 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17692 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17693 .vindex "&$home$&"
17694 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17695 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17696 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17697 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17698 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17699 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17700 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17701 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17702 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17703 the router is skipped.
17704
17705 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17706 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17707 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17708 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17709 setting to achieve this. For example:
17710 .code
17711 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17712 .endd
17713 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17714 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17715 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17716
17717
17718
17719 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17720 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17721 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17722 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17723 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17724 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17725 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17726 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17727
17728 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17729 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17730
17731 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17732 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17733
17734 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17735 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17736 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17737 .code
17738 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17739 .endd
17740 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17741 .code
17742 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17743 .endd
17744
17745 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17746 .code
17747 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17748 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17749 condition = foobar
17750 .endd
17751
17752 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17753 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17754 be specified using &%condition%&.
17755
17756 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17757 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17758 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17759 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17760 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17761 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17762 Router rules processing behavior.
17763
17764 This is best illustrated in an example:
17765 .code
17766 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17767 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17768
17769 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17770 true {yes} {no}}
17771
17772 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17773 {yes} {no}}
17774 .endd
17775 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17776 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17777 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17778 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17779 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17780 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17781 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17782 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17783
17784 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17785 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17786 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17787 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17788 string characters.
17789
17790 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17791 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17792 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17793 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17794 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17795
17796
17797 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17798 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17799 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17800 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17801 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17802 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17803 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17804 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17805 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17806 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17807 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17808 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17809 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17810 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17811
17812
17813
17814 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17815 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17816 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17817 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17818 transport option of the same name.
17819
17820 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17821 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17822 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17823 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17824 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17825 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17826 the dnssec request bit set.
17827 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17828
17829 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17830 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17831 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17832 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17833 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17834 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17835 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17836 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17837 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17838
17839
17840 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17841 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17842 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17843 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17844 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17845 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17846 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17847 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17848
17849
17850
17851 .option driver routers string unset
17852 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17853 to be used.
17854
17855
17856 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17857 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17858 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17859 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17860 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17861 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17862 Not effective on redirect routers.
17863
17864
17865
17866 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17867 .cindex "envelope sender"
17868 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17869 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17870 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17871 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17872 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17873 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17874 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17875
17876 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17877 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17878 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17879 setting.
17880
17881 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17882 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17883 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17884 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17885
17886 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17887 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17888 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17889 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17890 settings:
17891 .code
17892 errors_to =
17893 errors_to = ""
17894 .endd
17895 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17896 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17897 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17898 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17899 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17900
17901 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17902 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17903 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17904 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17905 setting &%return_path%&.
17906
17907 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17908 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17909 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17910
17911
17912
17913 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17914 .cindex "address" "testing"
17915 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17916 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17917 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17918 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17919 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17920 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17921 on for the system alias file.
17922 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17923 are evaluated.
17924
17925 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17926 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17927 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17928
17929
17930
17931 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17932 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17933 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17934 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17935
17936
17937
17938 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17939 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17940 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17941
17942
17943
17944 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17945 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17946 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17947
17948
17949
17950 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17951 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17952 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17953 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17954 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17955 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17956 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17957 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17958 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17959
17960 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17961 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17962 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17963 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17964 transport for further details.
17965
17966
17967 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17968 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17969 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17970 .cindex "transport" "local"
17971 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17972 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17973 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17974 process.
17975 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17976 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17977 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17978 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17979 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17980
17981
17982
17983 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17984 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17985 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17986 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17987 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17988 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17989 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17990 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17991 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17992 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17993 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17994 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17995 &"see"& the added header lines.
17996
17997 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17998 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17999 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18000 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18001
18002 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18003 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18004
18005 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18006 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18007
18008 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18009 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18010 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18011 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18012 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18013 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18014 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18015 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18016 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18017 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18018
18019
18020
18021 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18022 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18023 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18024 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18025 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18026 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18027 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18028 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18029 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18030 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18031 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18032 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18033 &"see"& the original header lines.
18034
18035 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18036 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18037 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18038 errors.
18039
18040 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18041 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18042
18043 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18044 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18045
18046 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18047 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18048 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18049 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18050
18051 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18052 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18053 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18054
18055
18056
18057 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18058 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18059 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18060 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18061 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18062 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18063 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18064 like
18065 .code
18066 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18067 .endd
18068 by setting
18069 .code
18070 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18071 .endd
18072 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18073 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18074 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18075 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18076 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18077 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18078
18079 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18080 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18081 .code
18082 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18083 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18084 .endd
18085 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18086 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18087
18088 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18089 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18090 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18091 domain that is being routed.
18092
18093 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18094 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18095 checked.
18096
18097 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18098 .cindex "additional groups"
18099 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18100 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18101 .cindex "transport" "local"
18102 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18103 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18104 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18105 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18106 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18107
18108
18109
18110 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18111 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18112 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18113 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18114 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18115 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18116 evaluated.
18117
18118 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18119 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18120 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18121 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18122 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18123 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18124 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18125 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18126 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18127
18128 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18129 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18130 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18131 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18132 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18133 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18134 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18135 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18136 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18137 the relevant transport.
18138
18139 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18140 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18141 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18142 callout.
18143
18144 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18145 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18146 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18147 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18148 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18149 .code
18150 real_localuser:
18151 driver = accept
18152 local_part_prefix = real-
18153 check_local_user
18154 transport = local_delivery
18155 .endd
18156 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18157 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18158 .code
18159 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18160 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18161 .endd
18162
18163 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18164 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18165 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18166 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18167
18168
18169 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18170 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18171
18172
18173
18174 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18175 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18176 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18177 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18178 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18179 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18180 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18181 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18182 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18183 &%username-foo%&.
18184
18185
18186 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18187 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18188
18189
18190
18191 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18192 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18193 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18194 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18195 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18196 are evaluated, and
18197 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18198 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18199 example:
18200 .code
18201 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18202 .endd
18203 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18204 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18205 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18206 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18207 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18208 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18209 each virtual domain:
18210 .code
18211 postmaster:
18212 driver = redirect
18213 local_parts = postmaster
18214 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18215 .endd
18216
18217
18218 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18219 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18220 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18221 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18222 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18223 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18224 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18225 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18226 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18227 redirect addresses.
18228
18229
18230
18231 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18232 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18233 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18234 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18235 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18236 delivery to be deferred.
18237
18238 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18239 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18240 .oindex "&%self%&"
18241 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18242 means of the setting
18243 .code
18244 self = pass
18245 .endd
18246 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18247 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18248 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18249
18250 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18251 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18252 controls what happens next.
18253
18254
18255 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18256 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18257 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18258 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18259 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18260 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18261 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18262 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18263
18264 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18265 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18266 applies to all of them.
18267
18268
18269
18270 .option pass_router routers string unset
18271 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18272 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18273 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18274 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18275 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18276 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18277 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18278 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18279 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18280 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18281
18282
18283
18284 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18285 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18286 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18287 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18288 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18289 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18290
18291 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18292 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18293 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18294 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18295
18296
18297
18298 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18299 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18300 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18301 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18302 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18303 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18304 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18305
18306 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18307 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18308 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18309 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18310
18311 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18312 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18313 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18314 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18315 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18316
18317 .cindex "NFS"
18318 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18319 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18320 unavailable.
18321
18322 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18323 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18324 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18325 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18326 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18327 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18328 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18329 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18330
18331 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18332 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18333 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18334 operates as follows:
18335
18336 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18337 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18338 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18339 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18340 used. For example:
18341 .code
18342 require_files = mail:/some/file
18343 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18344 .endd
18345 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18346 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18347
18348 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18349 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18350 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18351 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18352
18353 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18354 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18355 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18356 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18357 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18358
18359 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18360 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18361 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18362 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18363 check again in that process.
18364
18365 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18366 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18367 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18368 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18369 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18370 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18371 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18372 .code
18373 require_files = +/some/file
18374 .endd
18375 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18376 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18377 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18378
18379
18380
18381 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18382 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18383 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18384 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18385 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18386 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18387 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18388 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18389 latter kind.
18390
18391 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18392 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18393 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18394 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18395 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18396 same name.
18397
18398 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18399 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18400 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18401
18402
18403
18404 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18405 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18406 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18407 .vindex "&$home$&"
18408 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18409 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18410 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18411 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18412 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18413 cause the router to defer.
18414
18415 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18416 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18417 place.
18418 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18419 are evaluated.)
18420 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18421 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18422
18423 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18424 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18425 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18426 of these values that is set:
18427
18428 .ilist
18429 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18430 .next
18431 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18432 .next
18433 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18434 .next
18435 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18436 .endlist
18437
18438 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18439 router, but not for the transport.
18440
18441
18442
18443 .option self routers string freeze
18444 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18445 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18446 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18447 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18448 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18449 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18450 of remote hosts.
18451 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18452 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18453 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18454 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18455 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18456
18457 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18458 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18459 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18460 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18461 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18462 cases:
18463
18464 .vlist
18465 .vitem &%defer%&
18466 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18467
18468 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18469 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18470 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18471 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18472
18473 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18474 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18475 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18476 rewritten.
18477
18478 .vitem &%pass%&
18479 .oindex "&%more%&"
18480 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18481 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18482 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18483 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18484 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18485 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18486 combination
18487 .code
18488 self = pass
18489 no_more
18490 .endd
18491 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18492 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18493 be passed to the next router.
18494
18495 .vitem &%fail%&
18496 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18497
18498 .vitem &%send%&
18499 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18500 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18501 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18502 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18503 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18504 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18505 .endlist
18506
18507
18508
18509 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18510 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18511 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18512 address matches something on the list.
18513 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18514 are evaluated.
18515
18516 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18517 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18518 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18519 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18520 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18521 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18522 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18523 matters.
18524
18525
18526 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18527 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18528 .cindex "packet radio"
18529 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18530 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18531 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18532 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18533 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18534 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18535 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18536 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18537
18538 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18539 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18540 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18541 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18542 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18543 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18544 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18545 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18546 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18547 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18548 .code
18549 translate_ip_address = \
18550 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18551 {$value}fail}}
18552 .endd
18553 The file would contain lines like
18554 .code
18555 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18556 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18557 .endd
18558 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18559 are doing.
18560
18561
18562
18563 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18564 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18565 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18566 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18567 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18568 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18569 delivery is deferred.
18570
18571 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18572 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18573 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18574
18575
18576
18577 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18578 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18579 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18580 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18581 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18582 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18583 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18584 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18585 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18586 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18587 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18588 environment.
18589
18590
18591
18592
18593 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18594 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18595 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18596 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18597 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18598 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18599 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18600 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18601 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18602 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18603
18604 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18605 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18606 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18607 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18608 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18609
18610 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18611 environment.
18612
18613
18614
18615
18616 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18617 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18618 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18619 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18620 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18621 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18622 delivery to be deferred.
18623
18624 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18625 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18626 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18627 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18628 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18629 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18630
18631 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18632 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18633 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18634 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18635 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18636 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18637 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18638 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18639
18640 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18641 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18642 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18643 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18644 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18645 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18646 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18647 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18648 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18649 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18650
18651 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18652 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18653 subsequent routers.
18654
18655
18656 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18657 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18658 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18659 .cindex "transport" "local"
18660 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18661 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18662 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18663 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18664 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18665 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18666 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18667 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18668 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18669 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18670 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18671 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18672
18673
18674
18675 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18676 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18677 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18678
18679
18680 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18681 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18682 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18683 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18684 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18685 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18686 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18687 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18688 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18689 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18690
18691 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18692 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18693 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18694 user or group.
18695
18696
18697 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18698 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18699 addresses,
18700 delivering in cutthrough mode
18701 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18702 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18703 are evaluated.
18704 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18705
18706
18707 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18708 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18709 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18710 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18711 are evaluated.
18712 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18713 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18714 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18715
18716
18717
18718
18719
18720
18721 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18723
18724 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18725 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18726 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18727 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18728 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18729 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18730 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18731 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18732 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18733 .code
18734 localusers:
18735 driver = accept
18736 domains = mydomain.example
18737 check_local_user
18738 transport = local_delivery
18739 .endd
18740 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18741 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18742 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18743 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18744
18745
18746
18747
18748
18749
18750 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18752
18753 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18754 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18755 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18756 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18757 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18758 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18759
18760 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18761 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18762 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18763 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18764 records.
18765
18766 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18767 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18768 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18769 .new
18770 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18771 .wen
18772 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18773 generic option, the router declines.
18774
18775 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18776 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18777 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18778
18779 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18780 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18781 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18782 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18783 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18784 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18785
18786
18787 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18788 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18789 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18790 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18791 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18792 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18793
18794 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18795 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18796 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18797 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18798 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18799 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18800 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18801 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18802 case routing fails.
18803
18804
18805 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18806 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18807 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18808 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18809 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18810
18811 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18812 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18813
18814 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18815 .ilist
18816 The domain does not exist in DNS
18817 .next
18818 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18819 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18820 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18821 .next
18822 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18823 .next
18824 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18825 .next
18826 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18827 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18828 .next
18829 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18830 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18831 .next
18832 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18833 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18834 .next
18835 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18836 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18837 .endlist
18838
18839
18840
18841
18842 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18843 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18844 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18845
18846 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18847 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18848 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18849 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18850 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18851 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18852 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18853
18854
18855 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18856 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18857 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18858 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18859 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18860 required. For example,
18861 .code
18862 check_srv = smtp
18863 .endd
18864 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18865 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18866 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18867 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18868 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18869 normal way.
18870
18871 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18872 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18873 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18874 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18875 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18876 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18877
18878 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18879 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18880 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18881 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18882 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18883 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18884 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18885 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18886
18887 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18888 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18889
18890
18891
18892
18893 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18894 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18895 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18896 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18897 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18898 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18899 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18900 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18901 also being queued.
18902
18903
18904 .new
18905 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
18906 .cindex IPv6 disabling
18907 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
18908 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18909 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18910 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18911 only A records are used.
18912
18913 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
18914 .cindex IPv4 preference
18915 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
18916 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
18917 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
18918 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
18919 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
18920 .wen
18921
18922 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18923 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18924 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18925 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18926 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18927 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18928 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18929 setting:
18930 .code
18931 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18932 .endd
18933 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18934 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18935 the address record.
18936
18937
18938 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18939 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18940 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18941 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18942
18943
18944
18945
18946 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18947 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18948 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18949 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18950 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18951 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18952 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18953 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18954 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18955 &'resolv.conf'&.
18956
18957
18958
18959 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18960 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18961 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18962 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18963 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18964 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18965 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18966 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18967 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18968 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18969 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18970
18971 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18972 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18973 sense.
18974
18975 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18976 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18977 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18978 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18979 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18980 header rewriting.
18981
18982
18983 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18984 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18985 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18986 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18987 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18988 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18989 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18990 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18991
18992 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18993 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18994 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18995 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18996 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18997 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18998 without processing them independently,
18999 provided the following conditions are met:
19000
19001 .ilist
19002 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19003 &%headers_remove%&.
19004 .next
19005 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19006 the domain.
19007 .endlist
19008
19009
19010
19011
19012 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19013 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19014 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19015 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19016 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19017 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19018 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19019 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19020 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19021 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19022
19023 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19024 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19025 local wildcard.
19026
19027
19028
19029 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19030 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19031 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19032 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19033
19034
19035
19036
19037 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19038 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19039 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19040 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19041 if
19042 .code
19043 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19044 .endd
19045 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19046 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19047 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19048 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19049 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19050 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19051
19052
19053 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19054 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19055 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19056 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19057 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19058
19059 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19060 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19061 such as that implied by
19062 .code
19063 domains = @mx_any
19064 .endd
19065 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19066 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19067 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19068 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19069
19070
19071
19072
19073
19074
19075
19076
19077
19078 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19079 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19080
19081 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19082 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19083 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19084 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19085 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19086 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19087 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19088 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19089 router handles the address
19090 .code
19091 root@[192.168.1.1]
19092 .endd
19093 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19094 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19095 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19096 .code
19097 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19098 .endd
19099 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19100 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19101
19102 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19103 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19104 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19105 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19106
19107 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19108 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19109 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19110 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19111
19112
19113
19114 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19115 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19116
19117 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19118 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19119 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19120 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19121 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19122 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19123 must set
19124 .code
19125 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19126 .endd
19127 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19128
19129 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19130 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19131 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19132 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19133 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19134 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19135 must not be specified for it.
19136
19137 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19138 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19139 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19140 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19141 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19142 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19143 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19144
19145
19146 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19147 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19148 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19149 delivery to the address is deferred.
19150
19151
19152 .option port iplookup integer 0
19153 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19154 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19155 call.
19156
19157
19158 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19159 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19160 protocols is to be used.
19161
19162
19163 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19164 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19165 default value is:
19166 .code
19167 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19168 .endd
19169 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19170 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19171
19172
19173 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19174 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19175 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19176 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19177 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19178 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19179 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19180 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19181
19182
19183 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19184 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19185 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19186 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19187 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19188 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19189 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19190 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19191 following could be used:
19192 .code
19193 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19194 reroute = $local_part@$1
19195 .endd
19196
19197 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19198 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19199 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19200 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19201
19202
19203
19204
19205 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19206 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19207
19208 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19209 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19210 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19211 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19212 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19213 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19214 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19215 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19216 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19217 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19218
19219 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19220 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19221 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19222 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19223 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19224 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19225 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19226
19227 .vindex "&$host$&"
19228 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19229 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19230 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19231 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19232 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19233 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19234 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19235 text string.
19236
19237 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19238 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19239 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19240 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19241 below, following the list of private options.
19242
19243
19244 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19245
19246 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19247 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19248
19249 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19250 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19251
19252 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19253 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19254 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19255 of the following values:
19256 .code
19257 decline
19258 defer
19259 fail
19260 freeze
19261 ignore
19262 pass
19263 .endd
19264 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19265 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19266 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19267 &%pass_router%&),
19268 .oindex "&%more%&"
19269 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19270 router only if &%more%& is true.
19271
19272 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19273 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19274 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19275 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19276
19277 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19278 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19279 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19280
19281
19282 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19283 .cindex "randomized host list"
19284 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19285 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19286 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19287 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19288 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19289 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19290 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19291 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19292
19293 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19294 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19295 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19296 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19297 .code
19298 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19299 .endd
19300 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19301 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19302 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19303 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19304 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19305
19306
19307 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19308 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19309 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19310 example:
19311 .code
19312 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19313 .endd
19314 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19315 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19316 deferred.
19317
19318
19319 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19320 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19321 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19322 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19323
19324
19325 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19326 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19327 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19328 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19329 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19330 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19331 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19332 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19333
19334 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19335 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19336 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19337 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19338 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19339 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19340 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19341 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19342
19343
19344
19345
19346 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19347 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19348 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19349 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19350 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19351 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19352 .display
19353 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19354 .endd
19355 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19356 no options:
19357 .code
19358 route_list = \
19359 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19360 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19361 .endd
19362 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19363 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19364 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19365 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19366 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19367 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19368 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19369 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19370 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19371 in a &%route_list%&).
19372
19373 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19374 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19375 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19376 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19377
19378
19379
19380 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19381 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19382 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19383 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19384 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19385 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19386 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19387 like this:
19388 .code
19389 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19390 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19391 .endd
19392 This data can be accessed by setting
19393 .code
19394 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19395 .endd
19396 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19397 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19398 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19399 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19400 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19401
19402
19403
19404
19405 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19406 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19407 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19408 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19409 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19410 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19411 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19412
19413 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19414 variables are set during its expansion:
19415
19416 .ilist
19417 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19418 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19419 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19420 .code
19421 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19422 .endd
19423 .next
19424 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19425 .next
19426 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19427
19428 .next
19429 .vindex "&$value$&"
19430 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19431 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19432 .code
19433 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19434 .endd
19435 .endlist
19436
19437 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19438 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19439
19440
19441
19442 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19443 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19444 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19445 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19446 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19447 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19448
19449 .ilist
19450 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19451 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19452 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19453 .code
19454 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19455 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19456 .endd
19457 .next
19458 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19459 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19460 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19461 number follows. For example:
19462 .code
19463 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19464 .endd
19465 .endlist
19466
19467 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19468 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19469 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19470 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19471 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19472 transport.
19473
19474 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19475 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19476 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19477 records in the DNS. For example:
19478 .code
19479 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19480 .endd
19481 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19482 example:
19483 .code
19484 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19485 .endd
19486 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19487 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19488 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19489 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19490 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19491 happens is controlled by the
19492 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19493 &%self%& option of the router.
19494
19495 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19496 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19497 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19498 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19499 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19500 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19501 defined by MX preferences.
19502
19503 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19504 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19505 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19506
19507 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19508 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19509 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19510 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19511
19512 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19513 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19514 router.
19515
19516 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19517 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19518 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19519
19520 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19521 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19522
19523
19524
19525 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19526 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19527 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19528 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19529 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19530 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19531 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19532
19533 .ilist
19534 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19535 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19536 .next
19537 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19538 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19539 .next
19540 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19541 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19542 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19543 .next
19544 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19545 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19546 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19547 .new
19548 .next
19549 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19550 .next
19551 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19552 .wen
19553 .endlist
19554
19555 For example:
19556 .code
19557 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19558 domain2 host4:host5
19559 .endd
19560 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19561 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19562 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19563 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19564 call.
19565
19566 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19567 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19568 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19569 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19570 function called.
19571
19572 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19573 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19574 option specified.
19575
19576
19577
19578 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19579 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19580
19581 .vindex "&$host$&"
19582 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19583 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19584
19585
19586
19587 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19588 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19589 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19590
19591 .ilist
19592 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19593 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19594 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19595 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19596 .code
19597 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19598 .endd
19599 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19600 your first router something like this:
19601 .code
19602 smart_route:
19603 driver = manualroute
19604 domains = !+local_domains
19605 transport = remote_smtp
19606 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19607 .endd
19608 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19609 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19610 they are tried in order
19611 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19612 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19613 .code
19614 smart_route:
19615 driver = manualroute
19616 transport = remote_smtp
19617 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19618 .endd
19619 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19620 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19621 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19622 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19623 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19624 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19625 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19626 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19627
19628 .next
19629 .cindex "mail hub example"
19630 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19631 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19632 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19633 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19634 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19635 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19636 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19637 lookup is easier to manage.
19638
19639 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19640 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19641 example:
19642 .code
19643 hub_route:
19644 driver = manualroute
19645 transport = remote_smtp
19646 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19647 .endd
19648 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19649 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19650 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19651 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19652 domain can be used to find the host:
19653 .code
19654 through_firewall:
19655 driver = manualroute
19656 transport = remote_smtp
19657 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19658 .endd
19659 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19660 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19661 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19662 next router.
19663
19664 .next
19665 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19666 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19667 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19668 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19669 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19670 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19671 .code
19672 save_in_file:
19673 driver = manualroute
19674 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19675 route_list = saved.domain.example
19676 .endd
19677 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19678 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19679 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19680 .code
19681 save_in_file:
19682 driver = manualroute
19683 route_list = \
19684 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19685 *.saved.domain2.example \
19686 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19687 batch_pipe
19688 .endd
19689 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19690 .vindex "&$host$&"
19691 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19692 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19693 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19694 the address if the lookup fails.
19695
19696 .next
19697 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19698 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19699 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19700 one way it can be done:
19701 .code
19702 # Transport
19703 uucp:
19704 driver = pipe
19705 user = nobody
19706 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19707 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19708 return_fail_output = true
19709
19710 # Router
19711 uucphost:
19712 transport = uucp
19713 driver = manualroute
19714 route_data = \
19715 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19716 .endd
19717 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19718 .code
19719 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19720 .endd
19721 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19722 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19723 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19724 .endlist
19725 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19726 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19727
19728
19729
19730
19731
19732
19733
19734
19735 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19736 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19737
19738 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19739 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19740 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19741 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19742 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19743 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19744 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19745 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19746 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19747 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19748 options:
19749 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19750
19751 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19752 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19753 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19754 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19755 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19756
19757
19758 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19759 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19760 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19761 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19762 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19763 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19764
19765
19766 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19767 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19768 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19769 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19770 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19771 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19772 not set, a value for the gid also.
19773
19774 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19775 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19776 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19777 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19778 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19779 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19780 gid.
19781
19782
19783 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19784 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19785 before running the command.
19786
19787
19788 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19789 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19790 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19791 timeout.
19792
19793
19794 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19795 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19796 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19797 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19798 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19799
19800 .ilist
19801 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19802 below).
19803 .next
19804 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19805 &%no_more%& is set.
19806 .next
19807 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19808 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19809 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19810 included in the SMTP response.
19811 .next
19812 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19813 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19814 included in any SMTP response.
19815 .next
19816 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19817 .next
19818 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19819 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19820 .next
19821 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19822 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19823 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19824 .endlist
19825
19826 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19827 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19828 the page):
19829 .code
19830 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19831 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19832 .endd
19833 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19834 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19835 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19836 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19837
19838 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19839 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19840 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19841 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19842 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19843
19844 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19845 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19846 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19847 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19848 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19849
19850 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19851 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19852 variable. For example, this return line
19853 .code
19854 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19855 .endd
19856 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19857 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19858 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19859 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19860
19861
19862
19863
19864 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19865 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19866
19867 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19868 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19869 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19870 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19871 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19872 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19873 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19874 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19875 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19876 redirected in several different ways:
19877
19878 .ilist
19879 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19880 independently.
19881 .next
19882 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19883 .next
19884 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19885 .next
19886 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19887 .next
19888 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19889 .next
19890 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19891 .next
19892 It can be discarded.
19893 .endlist
19894
19895 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19896 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19897 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19898 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19899
19900 If success DSNs have been requested
19901 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19902 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19903 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19904
19905
19906
19907 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19908 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19909 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19910 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19911 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19912 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19913 .code
19914 system_aliases:
19915 driver = redirect
19916 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19917 .endd
19918 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19919 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19920 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19921 cause delivery to be deferred.
19922
19923 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19924 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19925 .code
19926 userforward:
19927 driver = redirect
19928 check_local_user
19929 file = $home/.forward
19930 no_verify
19931 .endd
19932 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19933 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19934 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19935 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19936 comments.
19937
19938
19939
19940 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19941 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19942 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19943 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19944
19945 .ilist
19946 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19947 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19948 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19949 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19950 .next
19951 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19952 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19953 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19954 saves some resources.
19955 .endlist
19956
19957
19958
19959
19960
19961
19962 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19963 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19964 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19965 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19966 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19967
19968 .ilist
19969 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19970 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19971 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19972 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19973 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19974 document is intended for use by end users.
19975 .next
19976 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19977 described in the next section.
19978 .endlist
19979
19980 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19981 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19982 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19983 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19984 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19985
19986
19987
19988 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19989 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19990 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19991 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19992 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19993 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19994 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19995 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19996 commas or newlines.
19997 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19998 quotes.
19999
20000 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20001 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20002 next newline character is ignored.
20003
20004 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20005 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20006 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20007 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20008 removed.
20009
20010 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20011 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20012 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20013 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20014 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20015 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20016 setting:
20017 .code
20018 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20019 .endd
20020
20021
20022 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20023 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20024 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20025 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20026 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20027 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20028 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20029 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20030 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20031 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20032 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20033
20034 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20035 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20036 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20037 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20038 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20039 .code
20040 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20041 .endd
20042 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20043 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20044 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20045 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20046 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20047 synonymously.
20048
20049 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20050 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20051 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20052 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20053 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20054
20055 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20056 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20057 contains:
20058 .code
20059 Sam.Reman: spqr
20060 .endd
20061 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20062 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20063 this forward file:
20064 .code
20065 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20066 .endd
20067 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20068 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20069 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20070 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20071 should really contain
20072 .code
20073 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20074 .endd
20075 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20076 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20077 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20078
20079
20080
20081 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20082 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20083 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20084
20085 .ilist
20086 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20087 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20088 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20089 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20090 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20091 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20092 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20093
20094 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20095 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20096 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20097 in double quotes, for example:
20098 .code
20099 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20100 .endd
20101 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20102 quote just the command. An item such as
20103 .code
20104 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20105 .endd
20106 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20107
20108 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20109 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20110 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20111 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20112 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20113 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20114 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20115 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20116 an &%accept%& router.
20117
20118 .next
20119 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20120 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20121 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20122 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20123 .code
20124 /home/world/minbari
20125 .endd
20126 is treated as a file name, but
20127 .code
20128 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20129 .endd
20130 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20131 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20132 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20133 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20134
20135 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20136 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20137
20138 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20139 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20140 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20141 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20142
20143 .next
20144 .cindex "included address list"
20145 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20146 If an item is of the form
20147 .code
20148 :include:<path name>
20149 .endd
20150 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20151 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20152 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20153 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20154 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20155 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20156 .code
20157 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20158 .endd
20159 It must be given as
20160 .code
20161 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20162 .endd
20163 .next
20164 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20165 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20166 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20167 .cindex "black hole"
20168 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20169 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20170 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20171 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20172 .code
20173 :blackhole:
20174 .endd
20175 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20176 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20177 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20178
20179 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20180 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20181 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20182 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20183 &_/dev/null_&.
20184
20185 .next
20186 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20187 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20188 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20189 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20190 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20191 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20192 redirection items of the form
20193 .code
20194 :defer:
20195 :fail:
20196 .endd
20197 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20198 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20199 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20200 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20201 .code
20202 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20203 .endd
20204 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20205 of a
20206 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20207 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20208 default.
20209 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20210 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20211 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20212
20213 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20214 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20215 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20216 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20217 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20218 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20219 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20220 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20221 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20222 ignored.
20223
20224 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20225 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20226 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20227 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20228
20229 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20230 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20231 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20232 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20233 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20234
20235 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20236 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20237 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20238 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20239 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20240 rules still apply.
20241
20242 .next
20243 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20244 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20245 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20246 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20247 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20248 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20249 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20250 .endlist
20251
20252
20253 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20254 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20255 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20256 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20257 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20258 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20259 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20260 aliasing scheme of the type
20261 .code
20262 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20263 localpart1: pipe
20264 localpart2: pipe
20265 .endd
20266 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20267 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20268 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20269 such as
20270 .code
20271 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20272 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20273 .endd
20274 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20275 the pipes are distinct.
20276
20277
20278
20279 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20280 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20281 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20282 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20283 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20284 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20285 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20286 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20287 can be used to avoid this.
20288
20289
20290 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20291 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20292 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20293 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20294 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20295 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20296 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20297
20298
20299
20300 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20301
20302 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20303 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20304
20305
20306 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20307 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20308 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20309
20310
20311 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20312 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20313 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20314 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20315
20316
20317 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20318 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20319 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20320 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20321 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20322 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20323 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20324
20325 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20326 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20327
20328
20329 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20330 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20331 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20332 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20333 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20334
20335
20336
20337 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20338 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20339 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20340 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20341 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20342 let ordinary users do.
20343
20344
20345
20346 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20347 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20348 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20349 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20350 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20351 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20352
20353 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20354 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20355 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20356 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20357 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20358 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20359 .code
20360 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20361 .endd
20362 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20363 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20364 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20365 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20366 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20367 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20368 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20369 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20370
20371
20372 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20373 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20374 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20375 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20376 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20377 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20378 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20379 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20380
20381
20382
20383 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20384 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20385 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20386 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20387 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20388 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20389
20390
20391 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20392 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20393 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20394 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20395 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20396 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20397
20398 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20399 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20400 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20401 .code
20402 data = #Exim filter\n\
20403 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20404 .endd
20405 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20406 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20407 choice into a newline.
20408
20409
20410 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20411 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20412 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20413 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20414 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20415
20416
20417 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20418 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20419 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20420 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20421 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20422 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20423 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20424 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20425
20426 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20427 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20428 runs a check on the containing directory,
20429 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20430 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20431 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20432 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20433 not, the router declines.
20434
20435
20436 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20437 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20438 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20439 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20440 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20441 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20442 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20443
20444
20445 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20446 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20447 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20448 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20449 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20450
20451
20452 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20453 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20454 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20455 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20456 redirection list.
20457
20458
20459 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20460 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20461 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20462 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20463 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20464
20465
20466
20467
20468 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20469 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20470 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20471 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20472 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20473 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20474 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20475 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20476 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20477 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20478 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20479
20480
20481 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20482 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20483 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20484 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20485 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20486 functions.
20487
20488 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20489 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20490 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20491 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20492 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20493 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20494
20495 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20496 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20497 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20498 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20499 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20500 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20501 &_.forward_& files).
20502
20503
20504 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20505 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20506 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20507 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20508 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20509
20510
20511 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20512 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20513 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20514 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20515 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20516 of the embedded Perl support.
20517
20518
20519 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20520 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20521 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20522 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20523 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20524
20525
20526 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20527 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20528 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20529 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20530 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20531
20532
20533 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20534 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20535 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20536 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20537 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20538 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20539 &%one_time%& is set.
20540
20541
20542 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20543 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20544 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20545 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20546 to make use of &%run%& items.
20547
20548
20549 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20550 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20551 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20552 If this option is true, items of the form
20553 .code
20554 :include:<path name>
20555 .endd
20556 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20557
20558
20559 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20560 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20561 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20562 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20563 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20564 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20565 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20566
20567
20568 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20569 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20570 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20571 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20572 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20573
20574
20575 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20576 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20577 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20578 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20579 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20580
20581
20582
20583
20584 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20585 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20586 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20587 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20588 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20589 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20590 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20591
20592
20593 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20594 .cindex "EACCES"
20595 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20596 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20597 file did not exist.
20598
20599
20600 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20601 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
20602 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20603 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20604 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20605
20606 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20607 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20608 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20609 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20610 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20611 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20612 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20613 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20614
20615
20616
20617 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20618 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20619 redirection list must start with this directory.
20620
20621
20622 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20623 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20624 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20625
20626
20627 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20628 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20629 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20630 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20631 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20632 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20633 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20634 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20635 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20636 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20637 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20638 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20639 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20640 before they subscribed.
20641
20642 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20643 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20644 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20645 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20646 attempt.
20647
20648 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20649 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20650 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20651 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20652
20653 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20654 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20655 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20656
20657 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20658 &%one_time%&.
20659
20660 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20661 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20662 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20663 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20664 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20665 expansion.
20666
20667
20668 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20669 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20670 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20671 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20672 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20673 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20674 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20675 See &%check_owner%& above.
20676
20677
20678 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20679 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20680 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20681 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20682
20683
20684 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20685 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20686 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20687 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20688 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20689 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20690 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20691
20692
20693 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20694 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20695 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20696 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20697 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20698 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20699 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20700 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20701
20702 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20703 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20704 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20705 addresses.
20706
20707 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20708 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20709 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20710 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20711 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20712 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20713 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20714 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20715 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20716 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20717
20718
20719 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20720 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20721 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20722 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20723 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20724 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20725
20726
20727 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20728 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20729 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20730 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20731 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20732 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20733
20734
20735 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20736 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20737 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20738 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20739 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20740
20741
20742 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20743 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20744 :subaddress part of an address.
20745
20746 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20747 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20748 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20749 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20750
20751
20752 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20753 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20754 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20755 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20756 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20757 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20758 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20759
20760
20761
20762 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20763 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20764 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20765 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20766 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20767 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20768 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20769 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20770 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20771 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20772 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20773 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20774 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20775 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20776 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20777 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20778
20779 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20780 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20781 the following routers.
20782
20783 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20784 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20785 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20786 so it is passed to the following routers.
20787
20788 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20789 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20790 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20791 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20792
20793 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20794 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20795 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20796 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20797 .code
20798 userforward:
20799 driver = redirect
20800 allow_filter
20801 check_local_user
20802 file = $home/.forward
20803 file_transport = address_file
20804 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20805 reply_transport = address_reply
20806 no_verify
20807 skip_syntax_errors
20808 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20809 syntax_errors_text = \
20810 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20811 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20812 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20813 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20814 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20815 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20816 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20817 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20818 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20819 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20820 .endd
20821 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20822 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20823 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20824 .code
20825 real_localuser:
20826 driver = accept
20827 check_local_user
20828 local_part_prefix = real-
20829 transport = local_delivery
20830 .endd
20831 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20832 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20833 .code
20834 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20835 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20836 .endd
20837
20838
20839 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20840 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20841
20842
20843 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20844 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20845 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20846 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20847
20848
20849
20850
20851
20852
20853 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20854 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20855
20856 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20857 "Environment for local transports"
20858 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20859 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20860 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20861 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20862 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20863 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20864 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20865
20866 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20867 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20868 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20869 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20870
20871 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20872 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20873 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20874 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20875 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20876
20877
20878
20879 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20880 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20881 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20882 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20883 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20884 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20885 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20886 time.
20887
20888 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20889 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20890 .code
20891 my_transport:
20892 driver = pipe
20893 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20894 .endd
20895 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20896 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20897 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20898 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20899
20900
20901
20902
20903 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20904 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20905 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20906 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20907 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20908 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20909 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20910 group (set by the transport). For example:
20911 .code
20912 # Routers ...
20913 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20914 local_users:
20915 driver = accept
20916 check_local_user
20917 transport = group_delivery
20918
20919 # Transports ...
20920 # This transport overrides the group
20921 group_delivery:
20922 driver = appendfile
20923 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20924 group = mail
20925 .endd
20926 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20927 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20928 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20929 set.
20930
20931 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20932 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20933 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20934 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20935 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20936 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20937
20938 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20939 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20940 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20941 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20942 original gid is also used.
20943
20944 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20945 following that is set is used:
20946
20947 .ilist
20948 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20949 .next
20950 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20951 .next
20952 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20953 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20954 .next
20955 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20956 .next
20957 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20958 the uid is the creator's uid;
20959 .next
20960 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20961 .endlist
20962
20963 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20964 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20965 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20966 The first of the following that is set is used:
20967
20968 .ilist
20969 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20970 .next
20971 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20972 .next
20973 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20974 .next
20975 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20976 .next
20977 The Exim uid.
20978 .endlist
20979
20980 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20981 &%never_users%& list.
20982
20983
20984
20985
20986
20987 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20988 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20989 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20990 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20991 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20992 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20993 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20994 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20995 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20996 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20997
20998 .ilist
20999 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21000 .next
21001 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21002 .next
21003 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21004 .next
21005 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21006 .endlist
21007
21008 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21009
21010 .ilist
21011 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21012 .next
21013 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21014 .endlist
21015
21016
21017 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21018 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21019 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21020
21021
21022
21023 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21024 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21025 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21026 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21027 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21028 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21029 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21030 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21031 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21032 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21033 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21034 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21035 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21036 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21037
21038
21039
21040
21041
21042
21043
21044 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21045 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21046
21047 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21048 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21049 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21050 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21051 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21052
21053
21054 .option body_only transports boolean false
21055 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21056 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21057 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21058 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21059 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21060 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21061 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21062 automatically suppress them.
21063
21064
21065 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21066 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21067 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21068 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21069 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21070 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21071
21072
21073 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21074 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21075 deliveries by the transport or for any
21076 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21077 what you are doing.
21078
21079
21080 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21081 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21082 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21083 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21084 transport is run.
21085 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21086 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21087 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21088 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21089 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21090 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21091 one.
21092 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21093 transport and the router that called it.
21094
21095 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21096 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21097 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21098 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21099 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21100 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21101 safely be resent to other recipients.
21102
21103
21104 .option driver transports string unset
21105 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21106 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21107
21108
21109 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21110 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21111 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21112 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21113 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21114 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21115 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21116 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21117 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21118 resent to other recipients.
21119
21120
21121 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21122 .cindex events
21123 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21124 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21125
21126
21127 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21128 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21129 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21130 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21131 &%user%& (see below).
21132
21133
21134 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21135 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21136 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21137 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21138 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21139 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21140 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21141 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21142 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21143 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21144 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21145
21146 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21147 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21148
21149
21150 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21151 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21152 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21153 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21154 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21155 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21156 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21157 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21158
21159
21160 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21161 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21162 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21163 This option specifies a list of header names,
21164 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21165 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21166 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21167 routers.
21168 Each list item is separately expanded.
21169 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21170 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21171 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21172
21173 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21174 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21175
21176 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21177 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21178 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21179
21180
21181
21182 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21183 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21184 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21185 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21186 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21187 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21188 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21189 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21190 example,
21191 .code
21192 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21193 x@y w@z
21194 .endd
21195 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21196 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21197 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21198 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21199 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21200 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21201 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21202 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21203 change envelope recipients at this time.
21204
21205
21206 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21207 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21208 .vindex "&$home$&"
21209 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21210 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21211 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21212 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21213 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21214 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21215 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21216 deferred.
21217
21218
21219 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21220 .cindex "additional groups"
21221 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21222 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21223 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21224 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21225 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21226
21227
21228 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21229 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21230 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21231 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21232 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21233 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21234 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21235 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21236
21237 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21238 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21239 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21240 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21241 Obviously there is scope for
21242 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21243 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21244
21245 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21246 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21247 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21248 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21249 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21250
21251
21252 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21253 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21254 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21255 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21256 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21257 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21258 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21259 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21260 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21261 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21262 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21263 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21264 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21265 delivered.
21266
21267
21268
21269 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21270 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21271 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21272 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21273 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21274 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21275 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21276 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21277 that contains
21278 .code
21279 local_part_prefix = *-
21280 .endd
21281 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21282 is delivered with
21283 .code
21284 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21285 .endd
21286 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21287 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21288 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21289 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21290 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21291
21292
21293 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21294 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21295 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21296 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21297 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21298 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21299 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21300 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21301 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21302
21303 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21304 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21305 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21306 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21307
21308 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21309 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21310 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21311
21312
21313 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21314 .cindex "envelope sender"
21315 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21316 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21317 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21318 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21319 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21320 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21321 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21322 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21323 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21324
21325 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21326 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21327
21328 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21329 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21330 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21331 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21332 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21333 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21334 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21335
21336 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21337 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21338 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21339 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21340 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21341
21342
21343
21344 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21345 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21346 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21347 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21348 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21349 have easy access to it.
21350
21351 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21352 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21353 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21354 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21355 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21356 recipients.
21357
21358
21359 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21360 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21361
21362
21363 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21364 .cindex "shadow transport"
21365 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21366 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21367 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21368
21369 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21370 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21371 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21372 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21373 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21374 cause a log line to be written.
21375
21376 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21377 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21378 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21379 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21380 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21381 of the form
21382 .code
21383 ST=<shadow transport name>
21384 .endd
21385 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21386 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21387 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21388 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21389 headers that some sites insist on.
21390
21391
21392 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21393 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21394 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21395 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21396 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21397 individual users or via a system filter.
21398 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21399
21400 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21401 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21402 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21403 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21404 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21405
21406 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21407 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21408 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21409 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21410 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21411 &(pipe)& transports.
21412
21413 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21414 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21415 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21416 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21417 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21418
21419 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21420 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21421 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21422 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21423
21424 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21425 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21426 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21427 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21428 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21429 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21430
21431 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21432 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21433 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21434 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21435 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21436 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21437 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21438 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21439
21440 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21441 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21442 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21443 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21444 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21445 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21446 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21447 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21448 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21449 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21450
21451 .vindex "&$host$&"
21452 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21453 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21454 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21455 which the message is being sent. For example:
21456 .code
21457 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21458 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21459 .endd
21460
21461 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21462 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21463 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21464 .ilist
21465 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21466 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21467 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21468 example:
21469 .code
21470 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21471 .endd
21472 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21473 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21474 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21475 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21476 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21477 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21478 .next
21479 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21480 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21481 arguments. Consider this example:
21482 .code
21483 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21484 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21485 .endd
21486 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21487 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21488 .code
21489 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21490 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21491 .endd
21492 .endlist
21493
21494 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21495 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21496 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21497 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21498 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21499 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21500 bounced from a transport filter.
21501
21502 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21503 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21504 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21505
21506
21507 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21508 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21509 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21510 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21511 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21512 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21513 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21514 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21515 becomes a temporary error.
21516
21517
21518 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21519 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21520 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21521 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21522 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21523 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21524 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21525 option is not set.
21526
21527 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21528 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21529 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21530
21531 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21532 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21533 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21534 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21535 retry data.
21536 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21537 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21538 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21539
21540
21541
21542
21543
21544
21545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21547
21548 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21549 "Address batching"
21550 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21551 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21552 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21553 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21554 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21555 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21556 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21557
21558 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21559 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21560 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21561 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21562 local transport, for example:
21563
21564 .ilist
21565 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21566 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21567 recipients saves space.
21568 .next
21569 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21570 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21571 .next
21572 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21573 to a scanner program or
21574 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21575 acceptable.
21576 .endlist
21577
21578 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21579 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21580 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21581
21582 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21583 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21584 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21585 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21586 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21587 to certain conditions:
21588
21589 .ilist
21590 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21591 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21592 batching is possible.
21593 .next
21594 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21595 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21596 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21597 .next
21598 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21599 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21600 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21601 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21602 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21603 from taking place.
21604 .next
21605 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21606 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21607 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21608 be the same.
21609 .endlist
21610
21611 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21612 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21613 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21614 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21615 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21616 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21617 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21618 .code
21619 check_string = "."
21620 escape_string = ".."
21621 .endd
21622 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21623 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21624 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21625
21626 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21627 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21628 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21629 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21630 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21631 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21632
21633 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21634 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21635 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21636 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21637 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21638 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21639 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21640 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21641 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21642
21643
21644
21645
21646 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21647 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21648
21649 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21650 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21651 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21652 .cindex "directory creation"
21653 .cindex "creating directories"
21654 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21655 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21656 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21657 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21658 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21659 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21660 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21661 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21662 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21663 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21664
21665 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21666 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21667 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21668 included.
21669
21670 .cindex "quota" "system"
21671 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21672 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21673 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21674
21675 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21676 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21677 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21678 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21679
21680 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21681 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21682 private options.
21683
21684 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21685 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21686 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21687 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21688 option).
21689
21690
21691
21692 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21693 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21694 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21695 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21696 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21697
21698 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21699 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21700 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21701 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21702 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21703 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21704 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21705 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21706 operation. There are two cases:
21707
21708 .ilist
21709 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21710 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21711 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21712 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21713 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21714 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21715 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21716 .next
21717 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21718 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21719 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21720 .endlist
21721
21722
21723 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21724 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21725 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21726 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21727 form:
21728 .code
21729 save folder23
21730 .endd
21731 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21732 .code
21733 require "fileinto";
21734 fileinto "folder23";
21735 .endd
21736 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21737 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21738 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21739 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21740 way of handling this requirement:
21741 .code
21742 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21743 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21744 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21745 {$address_file} \
21746 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21747 }} \
21748 }
21749 .endd
21750 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21751 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21752 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21753
21754 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21755 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21756 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21757 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21758 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21759 path to the transport.
21760
21761 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21762 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21763
21764
21765
21766
21767 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21768 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21769
21770
21771
21772 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21773 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21774 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21775 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21776 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21777 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21778 delivery is deferred.
21779
21780
21781 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21782 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21783 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21784 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21785 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21786 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21787 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21788 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21789
21790
21791 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21792 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21793 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21794 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21795 file.
21796
21797
21798 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21799 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21800
21801
21802 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21803 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21804 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21805 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21806 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21807
21808
21809 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21810 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21811 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21812 process is running.
21813
21814
21815 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21816 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21817 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21818 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21819 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21820 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21821 contains is significant.
21822
21823 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21824 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21825 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21826 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21827 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21828
21829 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21830 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21831 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21832 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21833 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21834 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21835 .code
21836 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21837 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21838 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21839 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21840 .endd
21841 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21842 .cindex "directory creation"
21843 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21844 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21845 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21846
21847 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21848 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21849 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21850 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21851 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21852
21853
21854
21855 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21856 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21857 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21858 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21859 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21860 beneath.
21861
21862 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21863 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21864 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21865 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21866 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21867 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21868 &%file_must_exist%&.
21869
21870
21871 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21872 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21873 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21874 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21875
21876 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21877 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21878 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21879 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21880 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21881
21882
21883 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21884 .cindex "base62"
21885 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21886 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21887 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21888 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21889 .code
21890 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21891 .endd
21892 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21893 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21894 option.
21895
21896
21897 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21898 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21899 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21900
21901
21902 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21903 See &%check_string%& above.
21904
21905
21906 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21907 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21908 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21909 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21910 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21911 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21912 &%file%&.
21913
21914 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21915 .cindex "locking files"
21916 .cindex "lock files"
21917 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21918 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21919
21920 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21921 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21922 examples:
21923 .code
21924 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21925 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21926 file = $home/inbox
21927 .endd
21928 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21929 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21930 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21931 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21932 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21933 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21934
21935
21936
21937 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21938 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21939 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21940 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21941 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21942 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21943 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21944 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21945 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21946 this added to it:
21947 .code
21948 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21949 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21950 .endd
21951 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21952 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21953 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21954 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21955 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21956 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21957 delivery is deferred.
21958
21959
21960 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21961 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21962 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21963 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21964
21965
21966 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21967 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21968 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21969 .cindex "locking files"
21970 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21971 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21972 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21973 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21974 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21975 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21976 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21977 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21978
21979 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21980 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21981 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21982 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21983
21984 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21985 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21986 retries is
21987 .code
21988 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21989 .endd
21990 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21991 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21992 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21993
21994 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21995 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21996 .code
21997 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21998 .endd
21999
22000 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22001 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22002 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22003 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22004
22005
22006 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22007 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22008 for details of locking.
22009
22010
22011 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22012 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22013 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22014
22015
22016 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22017 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22018 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22019
22020
22021 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22022 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22023 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22024 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22025 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22026
22027
22028 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22029 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22030 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22031 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22032 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22033 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22034 external source that maintains the data.
22035
22036
22037 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22038 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22039 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22040 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22041 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22042 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22043 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22044 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22045
22046
22047
22048 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22049 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22050 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22051 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22052 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22053 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22054 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22055 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22056 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22057 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22058
22059
22060 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22061 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22062 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22063 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22064 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22065 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22066 calculation. The default value is:
22067 .code
22068 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22069 .endd
22070 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22071 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22072 &_Trash_&
22073 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22074 .code
22075 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22076 .endd
22077 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22078 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22079 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22080 directly into that directory.
22081
22082
22083 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22084 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22085 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22086
22087
22088 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22089 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22090 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22091
22092
22093 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22094 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22095 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22096 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22097 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22098 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22099 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22100 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22101
22102 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22103 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22104 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22105 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22106 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22107 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22108 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22109 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22110 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22111 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22112
22113
22114 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22115 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22116 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22117 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22118 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22119 below for further details.
22120
22121
22122 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22123 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22124 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22125
22126
22127 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22128 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22129 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22130
22131
22132 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22133 .cindex "locking files"
22134 .cindex "file" "locking"
22135 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22136 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22137 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22138 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22139 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22140 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22141 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22142
22143 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22144 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22145 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22146 combination:
22147 .code
22148 mbx_format = true
22149 message_prefix =
22150 message_suffix =
22151 .endd
22152 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22153 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22154 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22155 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22156 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22157 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22158 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22159 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22160
22161 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22162 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22163 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22164 append messages to it.
22165
22166
22167 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22168 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22169 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22170 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22171 in which case it is:
22172 .code
22173 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22174 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22175 .endd
22176 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22177 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22178
22179 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22180 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22181 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22182 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22183 setting
22184 .code
22185 message_suffix =
22186 .endd
22187 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22188 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22189
22190 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22191 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22192 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22193 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22194 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22195 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22196 value, and this option is ignored.
22197
22198
22199 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22200 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22201 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22202 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22203 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22204
22205
22206 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22207 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22208 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22209 on users about incoming mail.
22210
22211
22212 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22213 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22214 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22215 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22216 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22217 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22218 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22219 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22220 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22221
22222 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22223 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22224 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22225
22226 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22227 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22228 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22229 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22230 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22231 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22232
22233 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22234 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22235 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22236 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22237 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22238 be handled.
22239
22240 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22241 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22242
22243 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22244
22245 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22246 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22247 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22248 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22249 system quota failures.
22250
22251 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22252 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22253 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22254 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22255 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22256 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22257 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22258 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22259 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22260 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22261
22262
22263 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22264 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22265 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22266 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22267 delivery directory.
22268
22269
22270 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22271 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22272 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22273 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22274 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22275 &"no quota"&.
22276
22277 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22278 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22279
22280 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22281 See &%quota%& above.
22282
22283
22284 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22285 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22286 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22287 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22288 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22289 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22290 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22291
22292 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22293 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22294 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22295 the file length to the file name. For example:
22296 .code
22297 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22298 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22299 .endd
22300 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22301 number of lines in the message.
22302
22303 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22304 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22305 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22306
22307 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22308
22309
22310 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22311 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22312 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22313 .code
22314 quota_warn_message = "\
22315 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22316 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22317 This message is automatically created \
22318 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22319 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22320 a warning threshold that is\n\
22321 set by the system administrator.\n"
22322 .endd
22323
22324
22325 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22326 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22327 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22328 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22329 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22330 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22331 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22332 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22333 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22334 sign. For example:
22335 .code
22336 quota = 10M
22337 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22338 .endd
22339 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22340 percent sign is ignored.
22341
22342 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22343 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22344 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22345 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22346 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22347 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22348 .code
22349 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22350 .endd
22351 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22352 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22353 option.
22354
22355 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22356 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22357 percentage.
22358
22359
22360 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22361 .cindex "envelope sender"
22362 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22363 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22364 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22365 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22366 for details of batch SMTP.
22367
22368
22369 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22370 .cindex "carriage return"
22371 .cindex "linefeed"
22372 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22373 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22374 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22375 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22376
22377 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22378 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22379 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22380 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22381 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22382 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22383
22384
22385 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22386 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22387 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22388 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22389 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22390 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22391
22392
22393 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22394 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22395 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22396 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22397 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22398
22399 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22400 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22401 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22402 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22403
22404 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22405 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22406 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22407 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22408 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22409 error.
22410
22411 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22412 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22413
22414
22415 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22416 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22417 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22418 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22419 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22420 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22421 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22422
22423 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22424 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22425 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22426 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22427 file corruption.
22428
22429 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22430 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22431 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22432
22433
22434 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22435 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22436 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22437 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22438 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22439 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22440 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22441 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22442 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22443
22444 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22445 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22446 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22447 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22448
22449
22450
22451
22452 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22453 .cindex "appending to a file"
22454 .cindex "file" "appending"
22455 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22456
22457 .ilist
22458 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22459 return is given.
22460
22461 .next
22462 .cindex "directory creation"
22463 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22464 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22465 &%directory_mode%& option.
22466
22467 .next
22468 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22469 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22470 transport.
22471
22472 .next
22473 .cindex "file" "locking"
22474 .cindex "locking files"
22475 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22476 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22477 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22478
22479 .olist
22480 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22481 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22482 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22483 .next
22484 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22485 .next
22486 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22487 Unlink the hitching post name.
22488 .next
22489 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22490 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22491 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22492 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22493 .next
22494 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22495 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22496 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22497 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22498 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22499 it before trying again.
22500 .endlist olist
22501
22502 .next
22503 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22504 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22505 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22506
22507 .next
22508 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22509 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22510 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22511 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22512 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22513 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22514 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22515 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22516 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22517 checked.
22518
22519 .next
22520 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22521 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22522 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22523 delivery is deferred.
22524
22525 .next
22526 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22527 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22528 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22529 permissions.
22530
22531 .next
22532 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22533 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22534 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22535
22536 .next
22537 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22538 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22539 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22540
22541 .next
22542 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22543 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22544 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22545 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22546 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22547 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22548 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22549 that prevents link following.
22550
22551 .next
22552 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22553 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22554 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22555 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22556 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22557
22558 .next
22559 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22560
22561 .next
22562 .cindex "file" "locking"
22563 .cindex "locking files"
22564 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22565 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22566 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22567 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22568 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22569 .code
22570 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22571 .endd
22572 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22573 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22574 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22575
22576 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22577 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22578 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22579
22580 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22581 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22582 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22583 delivery is deferred.
22584
22585 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22586 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22587 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22588 immediately. It retries up to
22589 .code
22590 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22591 .endd
22592 times (rounded up).
22593 .endlist
22594
22595 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22596 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22597
22598
22599 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22600 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22601 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22602 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22603 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22604 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22605 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22606 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22607 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22608 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22609
22610 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22611 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22612 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22613 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22614 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22615 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22616 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22617
22618 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22619 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22620 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22621 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22622
22623
22624 .cindex "maildir format"
22625 .cindex "mailstore format"
22626 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22627 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22628 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22629 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22630 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22631
22632 .cindex "directory creation"
22633 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22634 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22635 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22636 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22637 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22638 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22639 deferred.
22640
22641
22642
22643 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22644 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22645 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22646 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22647 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22648 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22649 &_new_& subdirectory.
22650
22651 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22652 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22653 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22654 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22655 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22656 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22657 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22658
22659 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22660 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22661 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22662 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22663 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22664 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22665 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22666 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22667
22668 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22669 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22670 folders. Consider this example:
22671 .code
22672 maildir_format = true
22673 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22674 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22675 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22676 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22677 .endd
22678 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22679 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22680 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22681 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22682 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22683 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22684
22685 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22686 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22687 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22688 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22689 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22690
22691 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22692 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22693 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22694
22695 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22696 .cindex "maildir++"
22697 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22698 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22699 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22700 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22701 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22702 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22703 amount of space used.
22704
22705 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22706 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22707 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22708 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22709 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22710 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22711
22712
22713
22714
22715 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22716 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22717 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22718 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22719 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22720 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22721
22722
22723 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22724 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22725 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22726 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22727 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22728 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22729 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22730 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22731 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22732 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22733 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22734 backwards compatibility).
22735
22736 For one common implementation, you might set:
22737 .code
22738 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22739 .endd
22740 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22741
22742 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22743 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22744 &[stat()]& each message file.
22745
22746
22747 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22748 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22749 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22750 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22751 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22752 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22753 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22754 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22755 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22756
22757 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22758 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22759 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22760 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22761 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22762 need to know the quota.
22763
22764 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22765 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22766
22767 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22768 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22769 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22770 details.
22771
22772
22773 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22774 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22775 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22776 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22777 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22778 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22779 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22780 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22781
22782 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22783 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22784 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22785 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22786 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22787 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22788
22789 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22790 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22791 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22792 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22793 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22794 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22795
22796 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22797 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22798 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22799 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22800
22801
22802 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22803 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22804 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22805 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22806 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22807 .code
22808 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22809 .endd
22810 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22811 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22812 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22813 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22814 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22815
22816
22817
22818
22819
22820
22821 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22822 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22823
22824 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22825 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22826 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22827 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22828 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22829 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22830 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22831 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22832
22833 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22834 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22835 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22836 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22837 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22838
22839
22840 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22841 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22842 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22843 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22844 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22845
22846 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22847 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22848 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22849 transport is run as a consequence of a
22850 &%mail%&
22851 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22852 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22853 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22854 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22855 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22856 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22857
22858 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22859 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22860 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22861 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22862
22863 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22864 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22865 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22866 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22867 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22868 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22869 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22870
22871 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22872 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22873 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22874 the transport defers.
22875 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22876 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22877
22878 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22879 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22880 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22881 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22882
22883 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22884 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22885 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22886 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22887 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22888 problems. They are just discarded.
22889
22890
22891
22892 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22893 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22894
22895 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22896 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22897 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22898
22899
22900 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22901 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22902 when the message is specified by the transport.
22903
22904
22905 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22906 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22907 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22908 string comes first.
22909
22910
22911 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22912 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22913 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22914
22915
22916 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22917 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22918 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22919
22920
22921 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22922 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22923 specified by the transport.
22924
22925
22926 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22927 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22928 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22929 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22930
22931
22932 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22933 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22934 the message is specified by the transport.
22935
22936
22937 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22938 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22939 used.
22940
22941
22942 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22943 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22944 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22945 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22946 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22947
22948
22949
22950 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22951 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22952 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22953 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22954
22955 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22956 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22957 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22958 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22959 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22960 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22961 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22962 infinity.
22963
22964 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22965 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22966 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22967 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22968 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22969
22970 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22971 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22972 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22973 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22974 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22975 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22976
22977
22978 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22979 See &%once%& above.
22980
22981
22982 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22983 See &%once%& above.
22984 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22985
22986
22987 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22988 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22989 specified by the transport.
22990
22991
22992 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22993 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22994 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22995 configuration option.
22996
22997
22998 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22999 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23000 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23001 automatic responses. For example:
23002 .code
23003 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23004 .endd
23005 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23006 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23007 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23008 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23009 small.
23010
23011
23012
23013 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23014 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23015 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23016 the text comes first.
23017
23018
23019 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23020 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23021 when the message is specified by the transport.
23022 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23023 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23024
23025
23026
23027
23028 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23029 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23030
23031 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23032 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23033 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23034 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23035 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23036 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23037 specified command
23038 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23039 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23040 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23041 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23042 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23043 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23044 .code
23045 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23046 .endd
23047 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23048 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23049 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23050 as follows:
23051
23052 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23053 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23054
23055
23056 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23057 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23058 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23059 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23060 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23061
23062
23063 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23064 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23065 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23066 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23067 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23068 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23069 LMTP protocol.
23070
23071 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23072 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23073 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23074 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23075 in its response to the LHLO command.
23076
23077 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23078 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23079 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23080 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23081
23082
23083 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23084 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23085 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23086 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23087 LMTP transport:
23088 .code
23089 lmtp:
23090 driver = lmtp
23091 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23092 batch_max = 20
23093 user = exim
23094 .endd
23095 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23096 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23097
23098
23099
23100 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23101 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23102
23103 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23104 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23105 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23106 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23107 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23108 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23109 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23110 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23111 following ways:
23112
23113 .ilist
23114 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23115 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23116 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23117 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23118 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23119 .next
23120 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23121 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23122 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23123 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23124 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23125 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23126 that are routed to the transport.
23127 .next
23128 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23129 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23130 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23131 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23132 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23133 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23134 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23135 .endlist
23136
23137
23138 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23139 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23140 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23141
23142 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23143 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23144 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23145 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23146 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23147 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23148 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23149
23150
23151 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23152 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23153 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23154 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23155 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23156 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23157 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23158
23159
23160
23161
23162 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23163 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23164 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23165 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23166 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23167 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23168 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23169 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23170 &"local delivery failed"&.
23171
23172 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23173 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23174 will be sent as normal.
23175
23176 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23177 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23178 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23179 apply in this case.
23180
23181 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23182 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23183 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23184 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23185
23186 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23187 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23188 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23189 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23190 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23191 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23192 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23193 &%temp_errors%&.
23194
23195
23196
23197 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23198 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23199 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23200 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23201 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23202 run.
23203
23204 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23205 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23206 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23207 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23208
23209 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23210 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23211 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23212 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23213 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23214 .code
23215 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23216 .endd
23217 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23218 arguments. You have to write
23219 .code
23220 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23221 .endd
23222 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23223 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23224 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23225 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23226 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23227 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23228 example:
23229 .code
23230 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23231 .endd
23232
23233 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23234 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23235 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23236 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23237 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23238 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23239 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23240 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23241 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23242 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23243
23244 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23245 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23246 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23247 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23248 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23249 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23250 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23251 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23252
23253 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23254 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23255 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23256 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23257 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23258 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23259 control what is done with it.
23260
23261 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23262 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23263 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23264 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23265 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23266 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23267 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23268 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23269 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23270 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23271 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23272
23273
23274
23275 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23276 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23277 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23278 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23279 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23280 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23281 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23282 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23283 .display
23284 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23285 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23286 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23287 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23288 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23289 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23290 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23291 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23292 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23293 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23294 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23295 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23296 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23297 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23298 &`USER `& see below
23299 .endd
23300 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23301 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23302 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23303 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23304 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23305 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23306 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23307
23308 .cindex "HOST"
23309 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23310 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23311 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23312 the router.
23313
23314 .cindex "HOME"
23315 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23316 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23317 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23318 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23319
23320
23321 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23322 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23323
23324
23325
23326 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23327 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23328 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23329 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23330 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23331 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23332 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23333 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23334 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23335 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23336 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23337 example, if
23338 .code
23339 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23340 .endd
23341 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23342 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23343 &%use_shell%& is set.
23344
23345
23346 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23347 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23348
23349
23350 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23351 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23352 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23353
23354
23355 .option check_string pipe string unset
23356 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23357 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23358 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23359 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23360 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23361 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23362 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23363 ignored.
23364
23365
23366 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23367 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23368 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23369 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23370 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23371 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23372 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23373
23374
23375 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23376 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23377 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23378 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23379 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23380 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23381 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23382
23383
23384 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23385 See &%check_string%& above.
23386
23387
23388 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23389 .cindex "exec failure"
23390 .cindex "failure of exec"
23391 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23392 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23393 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23394 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23395 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23396
23397
23398 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23399 .cindex "signal exit"
23400 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23401 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23402 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23403 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23404
23405
23406 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23407 .cindex "force command"
23408 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23409 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23410 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23411 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23412 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23413 command. For example:
23414 .code
23415 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23416 force_command
23417 .endd
23418
23419 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23420 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23421 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23422
23423
23424 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23425 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23426 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23427 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23428 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23429 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23430
23431 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23432 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23433
23434
23435 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23436 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23437 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23438 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23439 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23440 written to the main log.
23441
23442
23443 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23444 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23445 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23446 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23447 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23448 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23449 be set.
23450
23451
23452 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23453 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23454 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23455 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23456 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23457
23458
23459 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23460 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23461 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23462 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23463 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23464 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23465 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23466 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23467
23468
23469 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23470 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23471 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23472 .code
23473 message_prefix = \
23474 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23475 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23476 .endd
23477 .cindex "Cyrus"
23478 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23479 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23480 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23481 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23482 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23483 setting
23484 .code
23485 message_prefix =
23486 .endd
23487 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23488 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23489
23490
23491 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23492 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23493 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23494 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23495 .code
23496 message_suffix =
23497 .endd
23498 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23499 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23500
23501
23502 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23503 This option is expanded and
23504 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23505 variable of the subprocess.
23506 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23507 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23508 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23509
23510
23511 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23512 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23513 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23514 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23515 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23516 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23517 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23518 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23519 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23520
23521
23522 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23523 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23524 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23525 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23526 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23527 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23528 accept the message is used.
23529
23530
23531 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23532 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23533 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23534 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23535 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23536 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23537
23538
23539 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23540 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23541 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23542 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23543 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23544 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23545 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23546
23547
23548
23549 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23550 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23551 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23552 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23553 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23554 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23555 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23556 of them may be set.
23557
23558
23559
23560 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23561 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23562 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23563 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23564 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23565 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23566 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23567 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23568 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23569 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23570 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23571 and 73, respectively.
23572
23573
23574 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23575 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23576 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23577 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23578 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23579 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23580 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23581
23582 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23583 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23584 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23585 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23586 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23587 delivery to be deferred.
23588
23589 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23590 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23591
23592
23593 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23594 .cindex "envelope sender"
23595 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23596 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23597 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23598 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23599 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23600
23601 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23602 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23603 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23604 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23605 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23606 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23607 class database.
23608
23609
23610 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23611 .cindex "carriage return"
23612 .cindex "linefeed"
23613 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23614 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23615 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23616 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23617
23618 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23619 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23620 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23621 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23622 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23623
23624
23625 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23626 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23627 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23628 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23629 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23630 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23631 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23632 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23633 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23634 its &%-c%& option.
23635
23636
23637
23638 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23639 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23640 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23641 .cindex "external local delivery"
23642 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23643 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23644 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23645 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23646 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23647 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23648 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23649 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23650 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23651 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23652 .code
23653 # transport
23654 procmail_pipe:
23655 driver = pipe
23656 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23657 return_path_add
23658 delivery_date_add
23659 envelope_to_add
23660 check_string = "From "
23661 escape_string = ">From "
23662 umask = 077
23663 user = $local_part
23664 group = mail
23665
23666 # router
23667 procmail:
23668 driver = accept
23669 check_local_user
23670 transport = procmail_pipe
23671 .endd
23672 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23673 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23674 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23675 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23676 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23677 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23678
23679 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23680 .code
23681 IFS=" "
23682 .endd
23683 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23684 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23685
23686 .cindex "Cyrus"
23687 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23688 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23689 .code
23690 # transport
23691 local_delivery_cyrus:
23692 driver = pipe
23693 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23694 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23695 user = cyrus
23696 group = mail
23697 return_output
23698 log_output
23699 message_prefix =
23700 message_suffix =
23701
23702 # router
23703 local_user_cyrus:
23704 driver = accept
23705 check_local_user
23706 local_part_suffix = .*
23707 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23708 .endd
23709 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23710 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23711 sender.
23712 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23713 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23714
23715
23716 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23717 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23718
23719 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23720 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23721 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23722 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23723 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23724 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23725 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23726 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23727
23728
23729 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23730 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23731 two ways:
23732
23733 .ilist
23734 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23735 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23736 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23737 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23738 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23739 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23740 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23741 .next
23742 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23743 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23744 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23745 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23746 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23747 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23748 process.
23749 .endlist
23750
23751
23752 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23753 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23754 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23755
23756
23757
23758 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23759 .vindex "&$host$&"
23760 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23761 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23762 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23763 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23764 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23765 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23766 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23767 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23768
23769
23770 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23771 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23772 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23773 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23774 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23775 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23776 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23777 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23778 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23779 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23780 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23781 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23782 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23783 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23784
23785 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23786 and will be removed in a future release.
23787
23788
23789 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23790 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23791 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23792
23793
23794 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23795 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23796 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23797 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23798 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23799 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23800 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23801 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23802
23803 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23804 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23805 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23806 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23807 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23808 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23809 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23810 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23811 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23812
23813
23814 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23815 .cindex "Cyrus"
23816 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23817 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23818 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23819 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23820 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23821 ignored.
23822
23823 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23824 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23825 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23826 particular connection.
23827
23828 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23829 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23830 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23831 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23832
23833 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23834 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23835 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23836 .code
23837 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23838 .endd
23839 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23840 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23841
23842 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23843 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23844 value.
23845
23846
23847 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23848 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23849 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23850 authenticated as a client.
23851
23852
23853 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23854 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23855 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23856 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23857
23858
23859 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23860 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23861 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23862 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23863 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23864 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23865 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23866
23867
23868 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23869 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23870 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23871 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23872 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23873 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23874 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23875 option.
23876
23877
23878 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23879 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23880 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23881 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23882
23883
23884 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23885 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23886 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23887 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23888 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23889 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
23890 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
23891 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
23892 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23893
23894
23895 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23896 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23897 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23898 cutoff times.
23899
23900 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23901 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23902 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23903 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23904 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23905 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23906
23907 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23908 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23909 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23910 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23911 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23912 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23913 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23914 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23915 to them.
23916
23917
23918 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23919 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23920 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23921 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23922 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23923
23924
23925 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23926 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23927 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23928 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23929 details.
23930
23931
23932 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23933 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23934 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23935 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23936 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23937 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23938 the dnssec request bit set.
23939 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23940
23941
23942
23943 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23944 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23945 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23946 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23947 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23948 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
23949 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23950 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23951 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23952
23953
23954
23955 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23956 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23957 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23958 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23959 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23960 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23961 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23962
23963 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23964 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23965 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23966 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23967 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23968
23969
23970 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23971 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23972 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23973 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23974 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23975 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23976 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23977 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23978
23979 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23980 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23981 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23982 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23983 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23984 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23985
23986 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23987 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23988 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23989 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23990 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23991
23992 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23993 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23994 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23995 copy of the message is sent.
23996
23997 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23998 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23999 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24000 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24001 fails"& facility.
24002
24003
24004 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24005 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24006 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24007 zero.
24008
24009 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24010 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24011 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24012 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24013 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24014 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24015
24016 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24017 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24018 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24019 implementations of TLS.
24020
24021 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24022 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24023 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24024 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24025 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24026 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24027 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24028 option is:
24029 .code
24030 $primary_hostname
24031 .endd
24032 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24033 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24034 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24035 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24036 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24037 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24038 interface address, you could use this:
24039 .code
24040 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24041 {$primary_hostname}}
24042 .endd
24043 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24044 callouts.
24045
24046 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24047 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24048 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24049 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24050 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24051 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24052
24053 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24054 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24055 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24056 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24057
24058 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24059 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24060 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24061 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24062 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24063 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24064 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24065
24066 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24067 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24068 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24069 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24070 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24071 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24072 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24073 address are used.
24074
24075 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24076 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24077
24078
24079 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24080 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24081 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24082 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24083 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24084 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24085 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24086 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24087 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24088 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24089
24090
24091 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24092 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24093 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24094 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24095
24096
24097 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24098 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24099 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24100 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24101
24102 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24103 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24104 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24105 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24106 to any host that matches this list.
24107
24108
24109 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24110 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24111 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24112 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24113 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24114 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24115 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24116 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24117
24118
24119 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24120 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24121 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24122 why it exists.
24123
24124
24125
24126 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24127 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24128 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24129 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24130 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24131 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24132 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24133 explanation of when this might be needed.
24134
24135 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24136 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24137 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24138 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24139 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24140 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24141 message on the same session.
24142
24143 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24144 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24145 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24146 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24147 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24148 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24149 logging.
24150
24151
24152
24153 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24154 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24155 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24156 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24157 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24158
24159
24160 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24161 .cindex "randomized host list"
24162 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24163 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24164 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24165 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24166 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24167 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24168 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24169 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24170
24171 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24172 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24173 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24174 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24175 .code
24176 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24177 .endd
24178 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24179 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24180 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24181
24182 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24183 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24184 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24185 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24186 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24187 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24188 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24189 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24190 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24191
24192
24193 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24194 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24195 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24196 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24197 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24198
24199 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24200 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24201 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24202 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24203 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24204
24205 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24206 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24207 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24208 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24209 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24210 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24211
24212 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24213 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24214 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24215 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24216 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24217 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24218 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24219
24220 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24221 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24222 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24223 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24224 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24225 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24226 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24227
24228 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24229 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24230 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24231 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24232 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24233 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24234 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24235 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24236 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24237 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24238
24239 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24240 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24241
24242 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24243 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24244 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24245 it it is always enebled. Note that legthy operations in the connect ACL,
24246 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24247
24248 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24249 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24250 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24251 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24252 for multi-recipient messages.
24253 The option can usually be left as default.
24254
24255 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24256 .cindex "bind IP address"
24257 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24258 .vindex "&$host$&"
24259 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24260 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24261 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24262 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24263 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24264 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24265 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24266 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24267 unknown.
24268
24269 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24270 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24271 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24272 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24273 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24274 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24275 .code
24276 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24277 .endd
24278 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24279 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24280 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24281 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24282
24283
24284 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24285 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24286 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24287 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24288 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24289 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24290 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24291 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24292 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24293 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24294 unreachable hosts.
24295
24296
24297 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24298 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24299 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24300 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24301 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24302
24303 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24304 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24305 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24306 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24307 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24308 permits this.
24309
24310
24311 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24312 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24313 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24314 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24315 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24316 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24317 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24318 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24319
24320 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24321 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24322 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24323
24324 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24325 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24326 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24327 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24328 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24329 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24330 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24331 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24332
24333 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24334 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24335 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24336 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24337 is deferred.
24338
24339
24340
24341 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24342 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24343 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24344 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24345 .vindex "&$port$&"
24346 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24347 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24348 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24349 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24350 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24351
24352 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24353 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24354 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24355 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24356
24357
24358 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24359 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24360 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24361 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24362 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24363 addresses is not affected.
24364
24365 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24366 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24367 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24368 Exim to use only the host name.
24369 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24370
24371
24372 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24373 .cindex "serializing connections"
24374 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24375 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24376 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24377 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24378 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24379 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24380 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24381
24382 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24383 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24384 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24385 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24386 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24387 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24388
24389 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24390 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24391 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24392 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24393 are used for ETRN serialization.
24394
24395 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24396
24397
24398 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24399 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24400 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24401 .cindex "size" "of message"
24402 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24403 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24404 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24405 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24406 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24407 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24408 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24409 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24410
24411 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24412 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24413
24414
24415 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24416 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24417 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24418 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24419
24420
24421 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24422 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24423 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24424 .vindex "&$host$&"
24425 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24426 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24427 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24428 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24429 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24430 details of TLS.
24431
24432 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24433 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24434 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24435 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24436 client.
24437
24438
24439 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24440 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24441 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24442 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24443 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24444
24445
24446 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24447 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24448 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24449 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24450 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24451 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24452 will fail.
24453
24454 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24455
24456
24457 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24458 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24459 .vindex "&$host$&"
24460 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24461 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24462 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24463 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24464 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24465 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24466 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24467 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24468
24469
24470 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24471 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24472 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24473 .vindex "&$host$&"
24474 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24475 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24476 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24477 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24478 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24479 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24480 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24481 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24482 ciphers is a preference order.
24483
24484
24485
24486 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24487 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24488 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24489 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24490 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24491 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24492 certificate and private key for the session.
24493
24494 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24495
24496 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24497 TLS extensions.
24498
24499
24500
24501
24502 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24503 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24504 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24505 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24506 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24507 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24508 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24509 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24510 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24511 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24512 in clear.
24513
24514
24515 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24516 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24517 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24518 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24519 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24520 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24521 Note that unless the host is in this list
24522 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24523 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24524 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24525 certificate verification succeeds.
24526
24527
24528 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24529 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24530 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24531 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24532 while verifying the server certificate,
24533 checks will be included on the host name
24534 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24535 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24536 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24537
24538 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24539
24540
24541 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24542 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24543 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24544 .vindex "&$host$&"
24545 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24546 The value of this option must be either the
24547 word "system"
24548 or the absolute path to
24549 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24550 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24551
24552 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24553 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24554 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24555 must be specified.
24556
24557 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24558 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24559
24560 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24561 explicitly
24562 either by file or directory
24563 are added to those given by the system default location.
24564
24565 The values of &$host$& and
24566 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24567 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24568
24569 For back-compatibility,
24570 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24571 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24572 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24573
24574
24575 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24576 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24577 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24578 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24579 certificate verification must succeed.
24580 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24581 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24582 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24583
24584
24585
24586
24587 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24588 "SECTvalhosmax"
24589 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24590 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24591 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24592 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24593 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24594
24595
24596 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24597 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24598 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24599 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24600 retrying.
24601
24602 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24603 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24604 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24605
24606 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24607 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24608 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24609 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24610 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24611
24612 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24613 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24614 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24615 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24616 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24617 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24618 see below for an exception).
24619
24620 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24621 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24622 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24623 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24624 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24625
24626 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24627 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24628 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24629 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24630 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24631 reached their retry times.
24632
24633 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24634 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24635 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24636 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24637 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24638 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24639 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24640 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24641 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24642 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24643 reached.
24644
24645 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24646 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24647 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24648 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24649 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24650 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24651
24652 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24653 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24654 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24655 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24656 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24657 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24658
24659
24660
24661
24662
24663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24665
24666 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24667 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24668 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24669 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24670 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24671 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24672
24673 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24674 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24675 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24676 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24677 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24678 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24679 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24680
24681 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24682 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24683 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24684 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24685
24686
24687 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24688 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24689 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24690 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24691
24692 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24693 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24694 facility; you do not have to use it.
24695
24696 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24697 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24698 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24699 address to which it applies.
24700
24701 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24702 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24703 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24704 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24705 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24706 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24707 rules.
24708
24709 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24710 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24711 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24712 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24713
24714
24715 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24716 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24717 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24718 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24719 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24720 discouraged.
24721
24722 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24723 illustrated by these examples:
24724
24725 .ilist
24726 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24727 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24728 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24729 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24730 .next
24731 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24732 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24733 .endlist
24734
24735
24736
24737 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24738 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24739 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24740 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24741 message's processing.
24742
24743 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24744 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24745 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24746 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24747 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24748 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24749 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24750 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24751 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24752
24753 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24754 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24755 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24756 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24757 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24758 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24759 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24760 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24761 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24762 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24763
24764 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24765 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24766 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24767 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24768 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24769 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24770
24771 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24772 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24773 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24774
24775 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24776 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24777 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24778 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24779 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24780 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24781 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24782 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24783 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24784
24785 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24786 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24787 transport time.
24788
24789
24790
24791
24792 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24793 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24794 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24795 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24796 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24797 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24798 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24799 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24800 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24801 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24802 .code
24803 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24804 .endd
24805 might produce the output
24806 .code
24807 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24808 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24809 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24810 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24811 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24812 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24813 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24814 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24815 .endd
24816 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24817 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24818 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24819 set for a particular transport.
24820
24821
24822 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24823 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24824 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24825 rules in the form
24826 .display
24827 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24828 .endd
24829 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24830 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24831 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24832 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24833
24834 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24835 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24836 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24837 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24838 ignored.
24839
24840 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24841 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24842 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24843
24844 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24845 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24846 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24847 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24848 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24849 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24850 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24851
24852 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24853 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24854 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24855 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24856 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24857 .code
24858 *@* ${lookup ...
24859 .endd
24860 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24861 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24862
24863
24864 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24865 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24866 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24867 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24868 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24869 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24870 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24871 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24872 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24873
24874 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24875 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24876 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24877
24878 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24879 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24880 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24881 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24882 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24883 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24884 of pattern they are set as follows:
24885
24886 .ilist
24887 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24888 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24889 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24890 pattern
24891 .code
24892 *queen@*.fict.example
24893 .endd
24894 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24895 .code
24896 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24897 $1 = hearts-
24898 $2 = wonderland
24899 .endd
24900 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24901 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24902
24903 .next
24904 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24905 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24906 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24907 rewriting rule of the form
24908 .display
24909 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24910 .endd
24911 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24912 .code
24913 $1 = foo
24914 $2 = bar
24915 $3 = baz.example
24916 .endd
24917 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24918 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24919 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24920 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24921 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24922 .endlist
24923
24924
24925 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24926 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24927 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24928 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24929 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24930 .code
24931 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24932 .endd
24933 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24934 &'From:'& headers.
24935
24936 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24937 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24938 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24939 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24940 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24941 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24942 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24943 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24944 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24945 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24946 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24947 entry written to the panic log.
24948
24949
24950
24951 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24952 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24953
24954 .ilist
24955 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24956 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24957 .next
24958 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24959 .next
24960 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24961 .endlist
24962
24963 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24964 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24965
24966
24967
24968 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24969 "SECID154"
24970 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24971 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24972 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24973 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24974 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24975 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24976 .display
24977 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24978 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24979 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24980 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24981 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24982 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24983 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24984 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24985 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24986 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24987 .endd
24988 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24989 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24990 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24991
24992 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24993 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24994
24995
24996 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24997 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24998 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24999 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25000 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25001 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25002 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25003 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25004 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25005
25006 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25007 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25008 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25009 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25010 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25011 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25012 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25013 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25014
25015
25016 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25017 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25018 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25019 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25020
25021 .ilist
25022 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25023 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25024 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25025 .next
25026 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25027 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25028 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25029 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25030 .next
25031 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25032 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25033 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25034 .next
25035 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25036 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25037 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25038 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25039 .code
25040 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25041 .endd
25042 into
25043 .code
25044 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25045 .endd
25046 .cindex "RFC 2047"
25047 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25048 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25049 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25050 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25051 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25052 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25053 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25054 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25055
25056 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25057 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25058 .endlist
25059
25060
25061 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25062 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25063 .code
25064 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25065 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25066 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25067 .endd
25068 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25069 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25070 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25071 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25072 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25073 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25074 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25075 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25076
25077 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25078 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25079 .code
25080 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25081 .endd
25082 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25083 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25084
25085 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25086 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25087 messages that originate outside the local host:
25088 .code
25089 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25090 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25091 .endd
25092 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25093 space.
25094
25095 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25096 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25097 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25098 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25099 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25100 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25101 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25102 components. For example, the rule
25103 .code
25104 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25105 .endd
25106 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25107 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25108 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25109 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25110 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25111 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25112 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25113 .ecindex IIDaddrew
25114
25115
25116
25117
25118
25119 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25120 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25121
25122 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25123 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25124 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25125 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25126 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25127 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25128 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25129 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25130 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25131 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25132 address, domain and error.
25133
25134 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25135 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25136 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25137 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25138 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25139 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25140 log selector is set, the message
25141 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25142 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25143 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25144 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25145
25146 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25147 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25148 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25149 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25150 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25151 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25152 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25153 domain are maintained independently.
25154
25155 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25156 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25157 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25158 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25159 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25160 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25161 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25162 the local address is reached.
25163
25164 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25165 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25166 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25167 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25168 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25169
25170 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25171 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25172 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25173 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25174 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25175 messages that it should now be retaining.
25176
25177
25178
25179 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25180 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25181 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25182 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25183 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25184 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25185 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25186 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25187 message's sender, respectively.
25188
25189
25190 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25191 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25192 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25193 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25194 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25195 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25196 example,
25197 .code
25198 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25199 .endd
25200 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25201 whereas
25202 .code
25203 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25204 .endd
25205 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25206 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25207 part.
25208
25209 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25210 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25211 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25212 expressions work in address lists.
25213 .display
25214 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25215 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25216 .endd
25217
25218
25219 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25220 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25221 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25222 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25223 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25224 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25225 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25226 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25227 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25228
25229 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25230 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25231 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25232 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25233 local transports).
25234
25235 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25236 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25237 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25238 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25239 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25240 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25241 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25242 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25243 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25244 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25245 commands.
25246
25247
25248
25249 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25250 "SECID160"
25251 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25252 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25253 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25254 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25255 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25256 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25257 .code
25258 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25259 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25260 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25261 .endd
25262 and the retry rules are
25263 .code
25264 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25265 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25266 .endd
25267 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25268 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25269 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25270 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25271 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25272 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25273
25274 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25275 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25276 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25277 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25278
25279 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25280 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25281 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25282 .code
25283 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25284 .endd
25285 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25286 textual form of the IP address.
25287
25288 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25289 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25290 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25291 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25292
25293 .vlist
25294 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25295 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25296 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25297
25298 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25299 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25300 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25301
25302 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25303 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25304
25305 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25306 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25307 .endlist
25308
25309 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25310 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25311 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25312 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25313 retry rule of this form:
25314 .code
25315 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25316 .endd
25317 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25318 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25319
25320 .vlist
25321 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25322 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25323 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25324 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25325
25326 .vitem &%lookup%&
25327 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25328 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25329 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25330 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25331 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25332
25333 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25334 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25335
25336 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25337 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25338
25339 .vitem &%refused%&
25340 A connection was refused.
25341
25342 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25343 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25344
25345 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25346 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25347
25348 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25349 A connection attempt timed out.
25350
25351 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25352 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25353 obtained from an MX record.
25354
25355 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25356 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25357 obtained from an MX record.
25358
25359 .vitem &%timeout%&
25360 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25361
25362 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25363 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25364 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25365 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25366
25367 .vitem &%quota%&
25368 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25369 transport.
25370
25371 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25372 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25373 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25374 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25375 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25376 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25377 for four days.
25378 .endlist
25379
25380 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25381 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25382 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25383 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25384 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25385 heuristic rules:
25386
25387 .ilist
25388 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25389 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25390 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25391 .next
25392 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25393 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25394 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25395 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25396 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25397 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25398 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25399 .next
25400 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25401 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25402 .endlist
25403
25404 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25405 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25406 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25407 error).
25408
25409
25410
25411 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25412 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25413 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25414 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25415 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25416 form:
25417 .display
25418 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25419 .endd
25420 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25421 .code
25422 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25423 .endd
25424 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25425 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25426 For example:
25427 .code
25428 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25429 .endd
25430 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25431 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25432 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25433 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25434 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25435
25436 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25437 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25438 .code
25439 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25440 .endd
25441 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25442 list is never matched.
25443
25444
25445
25446
25447
25448 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25449 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25450 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25451 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25452 .display
25453 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25454 .endd
25455 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25456 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25457 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25458 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25459 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25460
25461 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25462 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25463 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25464 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25465 The available algorithms are:
25466
25467 .ilist
25468 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25469 the interval.
25470 .next
25471 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25472 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25473 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25474 .next
25475 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25476 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25477 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25478 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25479 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25480 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25481 queue processing times.
25482 .endlist
25483
25484 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25485 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25486 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25487 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25488 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25489 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25490 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25491 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25492 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25493 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25494 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25495 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25496
25497 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25498 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25499 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25500 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25501 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25502 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25503 time.
25504
25505 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25506 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25507 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25508 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25509 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25510 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25511 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25512 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25513 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25514 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25515 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25516 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25517
25518 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25519 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25520 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25521 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25522 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25523 deliveries that have been deferred.
25524
25525
25526 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25527 Here are some example retry rules:
25528 .code
25529 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25530 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25531 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25532 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25533 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25534 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25535 .endd
25536 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25537 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25538 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25539 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25540 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25541 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25542 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25543 days.
25544
25545 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25546 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25547 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25548 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25549 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25550
25551 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25552 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25553 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25554 were not obtained from an MX record.
25555
25556 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25557 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25558 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25559 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25560 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25561
25562
25563
25564 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25565 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25566 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25567 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25568 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25569 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25570 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25571 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25572 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25573 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25574 failing for the first time.
25575
25576 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25577 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25578 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25579 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25580
25581 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25582 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25583 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25584
25585
25586
25587
25588 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25589 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25590 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25591 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25592 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25593 default retry rule:
25594 .code
25595 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25596 .endd
25597 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25598 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25599 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25600
25601 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25602 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25603 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25604 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25605 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25606
25607 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25608 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25609 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25610
25611 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25612 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25613 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25614 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25615 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25616 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25617 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25618 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25619
25620 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25621 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25622 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25623 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25624 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25625 notice.
25626
25627 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25628 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25629 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25630 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25631 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25632 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25633 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25634 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25635 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25636 true.
25637
25638 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25639 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25640 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25641 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25642 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25643 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25644 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25645 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25646 reached.
25647
25648 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25649 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25650 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25651 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25652 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25653 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25654 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25655 time out the address.
25656
25657 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25658 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25659 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25660 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25661 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25662 considered immediately.
25663 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25664 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25665
25666
25667
25668
25669
25670
25671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25673
25674 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25675 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25676 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25677 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25678 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25679 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25680 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25681 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25682 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25683 other.
25684
25685 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25686 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25687
25688 .ilist
25689 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25690 the client's EHLO command.
25691 .next
25692 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25693 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25694 .next
25695 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25696 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25697 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25698 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25699 with the AUTH command.
25700 .next
25701 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25702 .next
25703 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25704 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25705 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25706 connection.
25707 .next
25708 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25709 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25710 unauthenticated connection.
25711 .endlist
25712
25713 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25714 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25715 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25716 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25717 .display
25718 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25719 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25720 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25721 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25722 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25723 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25724 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25725 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25726 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25727 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25728 &`250 HELP`&
25729 .endd
25730 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25731 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25732 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25733 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25734 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25735 included by setting
25736 .code
25737 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25738 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25739 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25740 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25741 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25742 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25743 AUTH_SPA=yes
25744 AUTH_TLS=yes
25745 .endd
25746 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25747 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25748 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25749 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25750 work via a socket interface.
25751 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25752 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25753 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25754 supporting setting a server keytab.
25755 The sixth can be configured to support
25756 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25757 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25758 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25759 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25760 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25761
25762 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25763 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25764 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25765 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25766 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25767 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25768 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25769
25770 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25771 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25772 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25773 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25774 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25775 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25776 .code
25777 cram:
25778 driver = cram_md5
25779 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25780 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25781 client_name = ph10
25782 client_secret = secret2
25783 .endd
25784 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25785 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25786
25787 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25788 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25789 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25790 in Exim.
25791
25792 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25793 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25794 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25795 authenticating data.
25796
25797 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25798 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25799 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25800 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25801 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25802 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25803 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25804 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25805 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25806 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25807 choose to honour.
25808
25809 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25810 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25811 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25812 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25813
25814
25815
25816 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25817 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25818 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25819
25820 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25821 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25822 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25823 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25824 encrypted by a setting such as:
25825 .code
25826 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25827 .endd
25828
25829
25830 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25831 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25832 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25833 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25834
25835
25836 .option driver authenticators string unset
25837 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25838 authenticators is to be used.
25839
25840
25841 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25842 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25843 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25844 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25845 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25846 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25847
25848
25849 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25850 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25851 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25852 mechanism is not advertised.
25853 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25854 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25855 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25856
25857
25858 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25859 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25860 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25861 for details.
25862
25863 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25864 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25865
25866 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25867 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25868 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25869 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25870 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25871 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25872 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25873 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25874 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25875 the error text.
25876
25877
25878 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25879 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25880 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25881 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25882 out the values of variables.
25883 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25884 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25885
25886
25887 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25888 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25889 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25890 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25891 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25892 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25893 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25894 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25895 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25896
25897
25898 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25899 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25900 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25901 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25902 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25903 remembered for later use.
25904 How it is used is described in the following section.
25905
25906
25907
25908
25909
25910 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25911 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25912 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25913 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25914 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25915 message:
25916
25917 .ilist
25918 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25919 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25920 .next
25921 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25922 .next
25923 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25924 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25925 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25926 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25927 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25928 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25929 given for the MAIL command.
25930 .next
25931 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25932 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25933 authenticated.
25934 .next
25935 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25936 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25937 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25938 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25939 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25940 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25941 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25942 message.
25943 .endlist
25944
25945
25946 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25947 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25948 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25949 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25950
25951 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25952 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25953 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25954 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25955 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25956 ACL is run.
25957
25958
25959
25960 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25961 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25962 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25963 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25964 conditions:
25965
25966 .ilist
25967 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25968 .next
25969 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25970 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25971 .endlist
25972
25973 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25974 the mechanisms are advertised.
25975
25976 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25977 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25978 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25979 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25980 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25981 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25982 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25983 .code
25984 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25985 .endd
25986 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25987
25988 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25989 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25990 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25991 such as:
25992 .code
25993 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25994 .endd
25995 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25996 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25997 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25998
25999 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26000 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26001 command. This is the case if
26002
26003 .ilist
26004 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26005 .next
26006 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26007 .next
26008 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26009 server authenticators.
26010 .endlist
26011
26012
26013 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26014 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26015 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26016
26017 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26018 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26019 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26020 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26021 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26022 rejected with a 504 error.
26023
26024 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26025 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26026 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26027 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26028 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26029 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26030 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26031 no successful authentication.
26032
26033
26034
26035
26036 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26037 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26038 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26039 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26040 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26041 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26042 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26043 script:
26044 .code
26045 use MIME::Base64;
26046 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26047 .endd
26048 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26049 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26050 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26051 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26052 command line to run this script on such data might be
26053 .code
26054 encode '\0user\0password'
26055 .endd
26056 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26057 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26058 whose code value is zero.
26059
26060 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26061 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26062 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26063 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26064
26065 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26066 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26067 example, a command such as
26068 .code
26069 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26070 .endd
26071 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26072
26073 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26074 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26075 .code
26076 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26077 .endd
26078 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26079 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26080 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26081 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26082
26083
26084
26085 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26086 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26087 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26088 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26089 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26090 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26091
26092 .ilist
26093 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26094 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26095 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26096 of the authenticator.
26097 .next
26098 .vindex "&$host$&"
26099 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26100 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26101 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26102 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26103 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26104 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26105 delivery to be deferred.
26106 .next
26107 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26108 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26109 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26110 usual way.
26111 .next
26112 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26113 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26114 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26115 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26116 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26117 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26118 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26119 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26120 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26121 .endlist
26122
26123 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26124 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26125 on and the transport running. For example, with a manualroute
26126 router given a host name, and DNS "round-robin" use by that name: if
26127 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26128 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26129 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26130 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26131
26132 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26133
26134 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26135 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26136 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26137 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26138 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26139 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26140 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26141 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26142 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26143 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26144 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26145 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26146 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26147
26148
26149
26150
26151
26152
26153 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26155
26156 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26157 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26158 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26159 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26160 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26161 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26162 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26163 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26164 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26165 connections as you do for login accounts.
26166
26167 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26168 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26169 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26170
26171 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26172 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26173 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26174
26175 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26176 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26177 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26178 given.
26179
26180 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26181 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26182 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26183 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26184 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26185 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26186 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26187
26188 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26189 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26190 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26191 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26192 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26193 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26194 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26195
26196 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26197 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26198 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26199 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26200
26201 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26202 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26203 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26204
26205 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26206 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26207 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26208 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26209 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26210 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26211 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26212 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26213 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26214 string as the error text
26215
26216 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26217 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26218 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26219
26220
26221
26222 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26223 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26224 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26225 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26226 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26227 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26228 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26229 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26230
26231 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26232 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26233 configured as follows:
26234 .code
26235 fixed_plain:
26236 driver = plaintext
26237 public_name = PLAIN
26238 server_prompts = :
26239 server_condition = \
26240 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26241 server_set_id = $auth2
26242 .endd
26243 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26244 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26245 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26246 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26247
26248 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26249 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26250 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26251 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26252 .code
26253 250-AUTH PLAIN
26254 .endd
26255 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26256 .code
26257 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26258 .endd
26259 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26260 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26261 .code
26262 AUTH PLAIN
26263 .endd
26264 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26265 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26266
26267 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26268 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26269 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26270 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26271 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26272
26273 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26274 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26275 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26276
26277 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26278 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26279 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26280 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26281 This is an incorrect example:
26282 .code
26283 server_condition = \
26284 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26285 .endd
26286 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26287 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26288 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26289 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26290 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26291 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26292 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26293 .code
26294 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26295 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26296 .endd
26297 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26298 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26299 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26300 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26301 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26302
26303
26304 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26305 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26306 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26307 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26308 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26309 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26310 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26311 .code
26312 fixed_login:
26313 driver = plaintext
26314 public_name = LOGIN
26315 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26316 server_condition = \
26317 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26318 server_set_id = $auth1
26319 .endd
26320 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26321 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26322 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26323 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26324
26325 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26326 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26327 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26328 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26329 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26330 .code
26331 login:
26332 driver = plaintext
26333 public_name = LOGIN
26334 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26335 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26336 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
26337 ldapauth{\
26338 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26339 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26340 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26341 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26342 .endd
26343 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26344 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26345 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26346 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26347 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26348 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26349 uninterpreted string.
26350
26351
26352 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26353 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26354 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26355 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26356 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26357 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
26358
26359
26360
26361
26362 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26363 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26364 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26365
26366 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26367 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26368 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26369 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26370 usual.
26371
26372 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26373 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26374 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26375 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26376 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26377 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26378 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26379 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26380 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26381 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26382 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26383 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26384
26385 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26386 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26387
26388 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26389 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26390 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26391 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26392 the string.
26393
26394 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26395 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26396 .code
26397 fixed_plain:
26398 driver = plaintext
26399 public_name = PLAIN
26400 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26401 .endd
26402 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26403 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26404 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26405 .code
26406 fixed_login:
26407 driver = plaintext
26408 public_name = LOGIN
26409 client_send = : username : mysecret
26410 .endd
26411 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26412 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26413 prompts.
26414 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26415 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26416
26417
26418
26419
26420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26421 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26422
26423 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26424 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26425 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26426 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26427 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26428 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26429 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26430 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26431 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26432 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26433 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26434 available in plain text at either end.
26435
26436
26437 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26438 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26439 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26440 authenticator as a server:
26441
26442 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26443 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26444 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26445 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26446 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26447 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26448 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26449 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26450 returned to the client.
26451
26452 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26453 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26454 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26455 numeric variables for other things.
26456
26457 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26458 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26459 user name, authentication fails.
26460 .code
26461 fixed_cram:
26462 driver = cram_md5
26463 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26464 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26465 server_set_id = $auth1
26466 .endd
26467 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26468 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26469 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26470 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26471 .code
26472 lookup_cram:
26473 driver = cram_md5
26474 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26475 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26476 {$value}fail}
26477 server_set_id = $auth1
26478 .endd
26479 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26480 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26481
26482 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26483 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26484 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26485 realm, with:
26486 .code
26487 cyrusless_crammd5:
26488 driver = cram_md5
26489 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26490 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26491 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26492 server_set_id = $auth1
26493 .endd
26494
26495 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26496 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26497 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26498
26499
26500
26501 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26502 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26503 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26504
26505
26506 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26507 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26508 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26509
26510
26511 .vindex "&$host$&"
26512 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26513 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26514 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26515 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26516 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26517 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26518 send the message to the current server.
26519
26520 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26521 strings, is:
26522 .code
26523 fixed_cram:
26524 driver = cram_md5
26525 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26526 client_name = ph10
26527 client_secret = secret
26528 .endd
26529 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26530 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26531
26532
26533
26534 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26535 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26536
26537 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26538 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26539 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26540 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26541 .cindex "Kerberos"
26542 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26543 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26544
26545 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26546 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26547 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26548 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26549 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26550
26551 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26552 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26553 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26554 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26555
26556 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26557 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26558 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26559 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26560 depending on the driver you are using.
26561
26562 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26563 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26564 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26565 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26566 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26567 implementation.
26568
26569 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26570 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26571 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26572 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26573 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26574 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26575 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26576 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26577
26578
26579 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26580 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26581 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26582 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26583 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26584 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26585 things.
26586
26587
26588 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26589 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26590 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26591 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26592
26593
26594 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26595 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26596 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26597 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26598 example:
26599 .code
26600 sasl:
26601 driver = cyrus_sasl
26602 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26603 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26604 server_set_id = $auth1
26605 .endd
26606
26607 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26608 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26609
26610
26611 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26612 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26613
26614
26615 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26616 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26617 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26618 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26619 .code
26620 sasl_cram_md5:
26621 driver = cyrus_sasl
26622 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26623 server_set_id = $auth1
26624
26625 sasl_plain:
26626 driver = cyrus_sasl
26627 public_name = PLAIN
26628 server_set_id = $auth2
26629 .endd
26630 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26631 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26632 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26633 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26634 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26635
26636
26637
26638
26639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26640 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26641 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26642 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26643 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26644 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26645 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26646 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26647 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26648 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26649 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26650
26651 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26652
26653 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26654 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26655 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26656 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26657 .code
26658 dovecot_plain:
26659 driver = dovecot
26660 public_name = PLAIN
26661 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26662 server_set_id = $auth1
26663
26664 dovecot_ntlm:
26665 driver = dovecot
26666 public_name = NTLM
26667 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26668 server_set_id = $auth1
26669 .endd
26670 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26671 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26672 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26673 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26674 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26675 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26676 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26677 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26678
26679
26680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26682 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26683 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26684 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26685 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26686 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26687 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26688 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26689 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26690 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26691 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26692 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26693 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26694 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26695 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26696 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26697 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26698 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26699 without code changes in Exim.
26700
26701
26702 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26703 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26704 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26705 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26706 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26707 context.
26708
26709 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26710 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26711 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26712
26713 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26714 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26715 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26716
26717 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26718 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26719 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26720
26721
26722 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26723 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26724 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26725 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26726
26727
26728 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26729 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26730 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26731 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26732 example:
26733 .code
26734 sasl:
26735 driver = gsasl
26736 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26737 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26738 server_set_id = $auth1
26739 .endd
26740
26741
26742 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26743 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26744 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26745 the password itself.
26746
26747 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26748 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26749 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26750 if available, else the empty string.
26751 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26752 else the empty string.
26753
26754 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26755
26756 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26757 option to be simply "true".
26758
26759
26760 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26761 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26762 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26763
26764
26765 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26766 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26767 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26768 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26769
26770
26771 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26772 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26773 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26774 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26775
26776
26777 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26778 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26779 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26780
26781
26782 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26783 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26784 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26785 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26786
26787 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26788 meanings for these variables:
26789
26790 .ilist
26791 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26792 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26793 .next
26794 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26795 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26796 .next
26797 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26798 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26799 .endlist
26800
26801 On a per-mechanism basis:
26802
26803 .ilist
26804 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26805 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26806 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26807 .next
26808 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26809 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26810 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26811 .next
26812 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26813 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26814 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26815 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26816 .endlist
26817
26818 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26819 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26820 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26821
26822
26823 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26824 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26825 .code
26826 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26827 driver = gsasl
26828 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26829 server_realm = imap.example.org
26830 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26831 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26832 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26833 server_condition = yes
26834 .endd
26835
26836
26837 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26838 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26839
26840 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26841 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26842 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26843 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26844 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26845 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26846 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26847 reliably.
26848
26849 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26850 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26851 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26852 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26853
26854 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26855 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26856 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26857 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26858
26859 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26860 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26861 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26862 from the keytab.
26863
26864
26865 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26866 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26867 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26868 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26869
26870 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26871 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26872 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26873 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26874
26875 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26876 .ilist
26877 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26878 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26879 .next
26880 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26881 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26882 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26883 GSS Display Name.
26884 .endlist
26885
26886
26887 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26889
26890 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26891 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26892 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26893 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26894 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26895 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26896 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26897 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26898 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26899 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26900 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26901 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26902 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26903 follows:
26904
26905 .ilist
26906 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26907 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26908 .next
26909 The server sends back a challenge.
26910 .next
26911 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26912 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26913 .endlist
26914
26915 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26916
26917
26918
26919 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26920 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26921 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26922
26923 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26924 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26925 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26926 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26927 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26928 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26929 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26930 for other things. For example:
26931 .code
26932 spa:
26933 driver = spa
26934 public_name = NTLM
26935 server_password = \
26936 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26937 .endd
26938 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26939 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26940
26941
26942
26943
26944
26945 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26946 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26947 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26948
26949
26950
26951 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26952 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26953
26954
26955 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26956 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26957
26958
26959 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26960 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26961 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26962 &'msn.com'&:
26963 .code
26964 msn:
26965 driver = spa
26966 public_name = MSN
26967 client_username = msn/msn_username
26968 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26969 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26970 .endd
26971 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26972 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26973
26974
26975
26976
26977
26978 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26979 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26980
26981 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26982 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26983 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26984 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26985 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26986 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26987 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26988 authentication based on client certificates.
26989
26990 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26991 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26992 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26993 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26994 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26995 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26996
26997 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26998 for which it must have been requested via the
26999 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27000 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27001
27002 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27003 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27004 and can authenticate the connection.
27005 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27006
27007 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27008
27009
27010 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27011 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27012
27013 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27014 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27015 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27016 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27017 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27018 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27019
27020 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27021 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27022 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27023
27024 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27025
27026
27027 Example:
27028 .code
27029 tls:
27030 driver = tls
27031 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27032 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27033 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
27034 {!= {0} \
27035 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27036 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27037 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27038 } } } }
27039 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27040 .endd
27041 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27042 of your configured trust-anchors
27043 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27044 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27045 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27046 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27047
27048 . An alternative might use
27049 . .code
27050 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27051 . .endd
27052 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27053 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27054 . This would help for per-device use.
27055 .
27056 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27057 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27058
27059 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27060 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27061
27062
27063 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27064 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27065 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27066
27067
27068
27069 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27070 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27071
27072 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27073 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27074 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27075 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27076 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27077 .cindex "OpenSSL"
27078 .cindex "GnuTLS"
27079 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27080 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27081 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27082 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27083 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27084 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27085 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27086 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27087 certificates are used.
27088
27089 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27090 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27091 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27092 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27093 between them is encrypted.
27094
27095 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27096 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27097 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27098 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27099 encryption state.
27100
27101 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27102 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27103 in order to get TLS to work.
27104
27105
27106
27107 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27108 "SECID284"
27109 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27110 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27111 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27112 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27113 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27114 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27115 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27116 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27117 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27118 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27119 in preference to STARTTLS.
27120
27121 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27122 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27123 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27124
27125 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27126 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27127 reassigned for other use.
27128 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27129 this port.
27130 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only supported submissions, not
27131 submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27132 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27133
27134 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27135 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27136 the most common use is expected to be:
27137 .code
27138 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27139 .endd
27140 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27141 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27142 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27143 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27144 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27145 defined elsewhere.
27146
27147 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27148 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27149
27150
27151
27152
27153
27154
27155 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27156 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27157 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27158 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27159 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27160 .code
27161 USE_GNUTLS=yes
27162 .endd
27163 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27164 .code
27165 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
27166 .endd
27167 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27168 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27169
27170 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27171
27172 .ilist
27173 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27174 cannot be the path of a directory
27175 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27176 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27177 .next
27178 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27179 .next
27180 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27181 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27182 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27183 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27184 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27185 .next
27186 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27187 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27188 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27189 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27190 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27191 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27192 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27193 option).
27194 .next
27195 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27196 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27197 .next
27198 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27199 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27200 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27201 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27202 .next
27203 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27204 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27205 .next
27206 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27207 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27208 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27209 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27210 .endlist
27211
27212
27213 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27214 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27215 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27216 but not the chosen filename.
27217 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27218 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27219
27220 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27221 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27222 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27223 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27224 of bits requested.
27225 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27226 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27227 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27228 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27229 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27230 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27231 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27232
27233 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27234 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27235 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27236 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27237 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27238
27239 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27240 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27241 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27242 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27243 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27244 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27245
27246 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27247 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27248 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27249
27250 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27251 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27252 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27253 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27254 .code
27255 # ls
27256 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27257 # rm -f new-params
27258 # touch new-params
27259 # chown exim:exim new-params
27260 # chmod 0600 new-params
27261 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27262 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27263 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27264 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27265 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27266 # chmod 0400 new-params
27267 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27268 .endd
27269 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27270 stalling is removed.
27271
27272 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27273 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27274 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27275 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27276 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27277 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27278 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27279 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27280 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27281 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27282 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27283
27284 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27285 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27286 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27287 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27288
27289 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27290 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27291 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27292 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27293 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27294
27295
27296 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27297 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27298 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27299 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27300 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27301 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27302 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27303 directly to this function call.
27304 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27305 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27306 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27307 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27308
27309 .ilist
27310 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27311 .next
27312 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27313 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27314 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27315 SSL v3 algorithms.
27316 .next
27317 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27318 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27319 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27320 algorithms.
27321 .endlist
27322
27323 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27324 &`-`& or &`+`&.
27325 .ilist
27326 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27327 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27328 stated.
27329 .next
27330 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27331 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27332 .next
27333 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27334 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27335 .endlist
27336
27337 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27338 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27339 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27340 not be moved to the end of the list.
27341 .endlist
27342
27343 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27344 string:
27345 .code
27346 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27347 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27348 .endd
27349
27350 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27351 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27352 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27353 choice of clients used:
27354 .code
27355 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27356 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27357 {DEFAULT}\
27358 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
27359 .endd
27360
27361 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27362 .code
27363 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27364 .endd
27365
27366
27367 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27368 "SECTreqciphgnu"
27369 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27370 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27371 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27372 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27373 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27374 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27375 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27376 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27377 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27378 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27379
27380 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27381 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27382
27383 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27384 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27385 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27386 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27387 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27388 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27389
27390 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27391 "Priority strings". This is online as
27392 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27393 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27394 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27395 then the example code
27396 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27397 on that site can be used to test a given string.
27398
27399 For example:
27400 .code
27401 # Disable older versions of protocols
27402 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27403 .endd
27404
27405 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27406 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27407 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27408
27409 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27410 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27411 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27412 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27413 used:
27414 .code
27415 # GnuTLS variant
27416 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27417 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
27418 {SECURE128}}
27419 .endd
27420
27421
27422 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27423 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27424 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27425 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27426 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27427 that STARTTLS is alway advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27428 this is reasonble for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27429
27430 If STARTTLS is to be used you
27431 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27432
27433 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27434 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27435 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27436 with the error
27437 .code
27438 554 Security failure
27439 .endd
27440 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27441 rejected with a 554 error code.
27442
27443 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27444 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27445
27446 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27447 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27448 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27449 from someone able to intercept the communication.
27450
27451 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27452
27453 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
27454 .code
27455 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27456 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27457 .endd
27458 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27459 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27460 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27461 that goes with it. These files need to be
27462 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27463 always be given as full path names.
27464 The key must not be password-protected.
27465 They can be the same file if both the
27466 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27467 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27468 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27469 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27470 the server's certificate.
27471
27472 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
27473 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
27474 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
27475 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
27476 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
27477 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
27478
27479 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27480 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27481 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27482
27483 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27484 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27485 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27486 transport.
27487
27488 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27489 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27490 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27491 .code
27492 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27493 .endd
27494 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27495 with the parameters contained in the file.
27496 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27497 available:
27498 .code
27499 tls_dhparam = none
27500 .endd
27501 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27502 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27503 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27504 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27505
27506 See the command
27507 .code
27508 openssl dhparam
27509 .endd
27510 for a way of generating file data.
27511
27512 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27513 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27514 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27515 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27516 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27517
27518 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27519 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27520 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27521 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27522 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27523 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27524 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27525 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27526 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27527
27528 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27529 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27530 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27531 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27532 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27533 documentation for more details.
27534
27535 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27536 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27537
27538
27539 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27540 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27541 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27542 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27543 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27544 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27545 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27546 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27547 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27548 expected certificates.
27549 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27550 an explicit file or,
27551 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27552 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27553
27554 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27555 directory is used
27556 (OpenSSL only),
27557 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27558 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27559 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27560 .code
27561 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27562 .endd
27563 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27564
27565 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27566 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27567 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27568 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27569 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27570 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27571 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27572 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27573 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27574 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27575
27576 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27577 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27578 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27579 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27580
27581 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27582 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27583 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27584 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27585 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27586 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27587
27588
27589 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27590 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27591 .cindex "revocation list"
27592 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27593 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27594 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27595 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27596 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27597 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27598 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27599 CRL in PEM format.
27600 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27601 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27602
27603 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27604 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27605 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27606 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27607 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27608 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27609
27610 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27611 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27612 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27613 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27614
27615 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27616 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27617 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27618 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27619 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27620 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27621 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27622 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27623
27624 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27625 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27626 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27627
27628 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27629 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27630 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27631 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27632 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27633
27634 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27635 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27636 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27637 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27638 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27639 next connection.
27640
27641 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27642 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27643 ignored.
27644
27645 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27646 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27647 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27648 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27649 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27650 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27651
27652 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27653 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27654
27655 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27656
27657 .code
27658 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27659 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27660 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27661
27662 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27663 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27664 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27665 .endd
27666
27667
27668
27669
27670 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27671 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27672 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27673 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27674 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27675 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27676 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27677 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27678 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27679
27680 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27681 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27682 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27683 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27684 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27685
27686 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27687 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27688 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27689 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27690 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27691 usual way.
27692
27693 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27694 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27695 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27696 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27697 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27698 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27699 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27700 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27701 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27702 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27703 unencrypted.
27704
27705 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27706 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27707 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27708 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27709
27710 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27711 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27712 These may be
27713 the system default set (depending on library version),
27714 a file,
27715 or (depending on library version) a directory.
27716 The client verifies the server's certificate
27717 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27718 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27719 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27720 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27721
27722 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27723 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27724 or need not succeed respectively.
27725
27726 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27727 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27728 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27729 value is empty.
27730 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27731 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27732 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27733 otherwise.
27734
27735 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27736 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27737 for OCSP to be relevant.
27738
27739 If
27740 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27741 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27742 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27743 alternative hosts, if any.
27744
27745 &*Note*&:
27746 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27747 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27748 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27749 client.
27750
27751 .vindex "&$host$&"
27752 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27753 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27754 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27755 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27756 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27757
27758 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27759 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27760 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27761 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27762 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27763 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27764 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27765 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27766 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27767 outgoing connection.
27768
27769
27770
27771 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27772 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27773 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27774 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27775 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27776 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27777 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27778 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27779 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27780 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27781 for this session.
27782
27783 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27784 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27785 address.
27786
27787 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27788 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27789 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27790 be of limited use in that environment.
27791
27792 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27793 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27794 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27795 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27796 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27797
27798 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27799 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27800 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27801 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27802 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27803
27804 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27805 received from a client.
27806 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27807
27808 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27809 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27810 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27811
27812 .ilist
27813 &%tls_certificate%&
27814 .next
27815 &%tls_crl%&
27816 .next
27817 &%tls_privatekey%&
27818 .next
27819 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27820 .next
27821 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27822 .endlist
27823
27824 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27825 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27826 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27827 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27828 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27829 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27830 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27831
27832 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27833 are re-expanded.
27834
27835 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27836 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27837 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27838 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27839
27840 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27841 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27842 built, then you have SNI support).
27843
27844
27845
27846 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27847 "SECTmulmessam"
27848 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27849 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27850 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27851 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27852 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27853 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27854 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27855 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
27856 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
27857 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
27858
27859 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
27860 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
27861 this list the proxy process descibed above is not used; instead Exim
27862 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
27863 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27864 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27865 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27866
27867 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27868 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27869 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27870 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27871 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27872 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27873 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27874 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27875 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27876
27877 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27878 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27879 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27880 information is recorded.
27881
27882 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27883 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27884 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27885
27886
27887
27888
27889 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27890 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27891 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27892 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27893 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27894 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27895 to Apache, currently at
27896 .display
27897 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27898 .endd
27899 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27900 links to further files.
27901 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27902 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27903 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27904 .display
27905 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27906 .endd
27907
27908
27909 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27910 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27911 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27912 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27913 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27914 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27915 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27916 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27917 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27918 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27919 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27920 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27921 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27922
27923 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27924 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27925 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27926 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27927
27928
27929
27930 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27931 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27932 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27933 with OpenSSL, like this:
27934 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27935 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27936 .code
27937 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27938 -days 9999 -nodes
27939 .endd
27940 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27941 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27942 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27943 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27944 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27945 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27946 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27947
27948 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27949 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27950 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27951 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27952 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27953 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27954 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27955 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27956 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27957 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27958 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27959 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27960 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27961 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27962 be a sensible resolution).
27963
27964 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27965 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27966 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27967
27968 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27969 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27970 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27971 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27972 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27973 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27974
27975 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27976 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27977 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27978 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27979 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27980 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27981
27982
27983
27984 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27985 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27986
27987 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27988 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27989 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27990 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27991 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27992 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27993 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27994 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27995 one very small ACL:
27996 .code
27997 begin acl
27998 small_acl:
27999 accept hosts = one.host.only
28000 .endd
28001 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28002 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28003
28004 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28005 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28006 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28007 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28008 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28009 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28010 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28011 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28012
28013
28014 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28015 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28016 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28017
28018
28019 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28020 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28021 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28022 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28023 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28024 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28025 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28026 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28027 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28028 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28029 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28030 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28031 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28032 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28033 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28034 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28035 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28036 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28037 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28038 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28039
28040 .table2 140pt
28041 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28042 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28043 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28044 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28045 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28046 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28047 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28048 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28049 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28050 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28051 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28052 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28053 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28054 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28055 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28056 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28057 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28058 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28059 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28060 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28061 .endtable
28062
28063 For example, if you set
28064 .code
28065 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28066 .endd
28067 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28068 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28069 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28070 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28071 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28072 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28073 testing as possible at RCPT time.
28074
28075
28076 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28077 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28078 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28079 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28080 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28081 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28082 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28083 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28084 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28085 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28086 in any of these ACLs.
28087
28088 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28089 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28090 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28091 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28092 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28093 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28094 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28095 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28096 .code
28097 control = suppress_local_fixups
28098 .endd
28099 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28100 run, it is too late.
28101
28102 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28103 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28104
28105 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28106 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28107 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28108
28109
28110 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28111 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28112 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28113 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28114 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28115 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28116 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28117 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28118 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28119
28120
28121 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28122 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28123 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28124 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28125 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28126 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28127 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28128 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28129 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28130
28131 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28132 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28133 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28134
28135 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28136 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28137 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28138 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28139 an EHLO response.
28140
28141
28142 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28143 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28144 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28145 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28146 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28147 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28148 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28149 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28150 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28151 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28152
28153 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28154 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28155 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28156 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28157 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28158 associated with the DATA command.
28159
28160 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28161 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28162 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28163 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28164 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28165 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28166 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28167 the data specified is received.
28168
28169 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28170 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28171 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28172 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28173 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28174 your resources.
28175
28176 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28177 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28178 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28179 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28180
28181 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28182 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28183 enabled (which is the default).
28184
28185 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28186 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28187 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28188
28189 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28190
28191 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
28192
28193
28194 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28195 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28196 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28197
28198 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28199
28200
28201 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28202 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28203 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28204 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28205 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28206 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28207 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28208 has been accepted.
28209
28210 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28211 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28212 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28213 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28214 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28215 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28216 for some or all recipients.
28217
28218 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28219 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28220 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28221 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28222 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28223 is &"yes"&.
28224 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28225 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28226 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28227
28228 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28229 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28230
28231 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28232 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28233 the feature was not requested by the client.
28234
28235 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28236 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28237 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28238 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28239 does not in fact control any access.
28240 For this reason, it may only accept
28241 or warn as its final result.
28242
28243 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28244 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28245 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28246 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28247
28248 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28249 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28250
28251 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28252 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28253 response to QUIT.
28254
28255 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28256 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28257 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28258 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28259 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28260
28261
28262 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28263 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28264 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28265 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28266 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28267 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28268 situation even worse.
28269
28270 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28271 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28272 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28273 and &%warn%&.
28274
28275 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28276 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28277 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28278 connection. The possible values are:
28279 .table2
28280 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28281 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28282 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28283 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28284 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28285 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28286 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28287 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28288 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28289 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28290 .endtable
28291 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28292 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28293 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28294 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28295 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28296 used.
28297
28298
28299 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28300 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28301 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28302 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28303 .code
28304 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28305 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28306 .endd
28307 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28308 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
28309 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28310 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28311 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28312
28313 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28314 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28315 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28316
28317 .ilist
28318 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28319 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28320 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28321 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28322 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28323 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28324 .code
28325 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28326 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28327 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28328 .endd
28329 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28330 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28331 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28332 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28333 .next
28334 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28335 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28336 matches the string.
28337 .next
28338 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28339 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28340 want to have something like
28341 .code
28342 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28343 .endd
28344 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28345 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28346 .endlist
28347
28348
28349
28350
28351 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28352 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28353 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28354 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28355 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28356 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28357 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28358 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28359 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28360
28361 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28362 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28363 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28364
28365
28366 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28367 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28368 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28369 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28370
28371 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28372 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28373 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28374 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28375 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28376 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28377 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28378
28379 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28380 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28381
28382
28383 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28384 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28385 recipients; it may create new recipients.
28386
28387
28388
28389 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28390 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28391 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28392 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28393 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28394 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28395
28396 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28397 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28398 used to accept or reject anything.
28399
28400 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28401 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28402 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28403 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28404
28405 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28406 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28407 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28408 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28409 configuration file.
28410
28411
28412
28413
28414 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28415 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28416 .vindex &$domain$&
28417 .vindex &$local_part$&
28418 .vindex &$sender_address$&
28419 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28420 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28421 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28422 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28423 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28424 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28425 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28426 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28427
28428 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28429 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28430 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28431 how it is used.
28432
28433 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
28434 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28435 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28436 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28437 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28438 received).
28439
28440 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28441 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28442 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28443 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28444 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28445 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28446 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28447 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28448
28449
28450
28451
28452
28453 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28454 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28455 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28456 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28457 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28458 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28459 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28460 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28461 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28462 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28463 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28464 unencrypted connections.
28465 .code
28466 acl_check_auth:
28467 accept encrypted = *
28468 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28469 {CRAM-MD5}}
28470 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28471 .endd
28472 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28473 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28474 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28475 option to do this.)
28476
28477
28478
28479 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28480 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28481 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28482 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28483 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28484 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28485 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28486
28487 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28488 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28489 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28490 example:
28491 .code
28492 deny dnslists = list1.example
28493 dnslists = list2.example
28494 .endd
28495 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28496 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28497 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28498 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28499 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28500
28501
28502 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28503 The ACL verbs are as follows:
28504
28505 .ilist
28506 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28507 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28508 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28509 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28510 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28511 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28512 check a RCPT command:
28513 .code
28514 accept domains = +local_domains
28515 endpass
28516 verify = recipient
28517 .endd
28518 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28519 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28520 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28521 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28522 &%endpass%&.
28523
28524 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28525 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28526 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28527 configuration.
28528
28529 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28530 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28531 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28532 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28533 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28534 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28535 .display
28536 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28537 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28538 .endd
28539 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28540 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28541 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28542
28543 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28544 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28545 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28546 of &%endpass%&.
28547
28548
28549 .next
28550 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28551 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28552 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28553 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28554 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28555 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28556 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28557
28558
28559 .next
28560 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28561 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28562 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28563 example,
28564 .code
28565 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28566 .endd
28567 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28568
28569
28570 .next
28571 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28572 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28573 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28574 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28575 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28576 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28577 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28578 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28579 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28580
28581 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28582 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28583 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28584
28585
28586 .next
28587 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28588 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28589 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28590 .code
28591 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28592 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28593 .endd
28594 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28595 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28596
28597 .next
28598 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28599 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28600 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28601 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28602 .code
28603 require message = Sender did not verify
28604 verify = sender
28605 .endd
28606 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28607 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28608 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28609 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28610
28611 .next
28612 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28613 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28614 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28615 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28616 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28617 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28618 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28619
28620 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28621 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28622 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28623 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28624 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28625
28626 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28627 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28628 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28629 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28630 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28631 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28632 onwards.
28633
28634
28635 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28636 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28637 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28638 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28639 .code
28640 warn !verify = sender
28641 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28642 .endd
28643 .endlist
28644
28645 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28646
28647 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28648 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28649 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28650 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28651 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28652
28653
28654
28655 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28656 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28657 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28658 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28659 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28660 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28661 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28662 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28663 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28664 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28665 .ilist
28666 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28667 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28668 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28669 on the same SMTP connection.
28670 .next
28671 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28672 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28673 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28674 .endlist
28675
28676 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28677 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28678 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28679 .code
28680 accept hosts = whatever
28681 set acl_m4 = some value
28682 accept authenticated = *
28683 set acl_c_auth = yes
28684 .endd
28685 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28686 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28687 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28688
28689 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28690 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28691 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28692 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28693 error is generated.
28694
28695 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28696 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28697
28698
28699 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28700 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28701 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28702 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28703 .code
28704 deny domains = *.dom.example
28705 !verify = recipient
28706 .endd
28707 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28708 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28709 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28710 two statements are equivalent:
28711 .code
28712 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28713 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28714 .endd
28715 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28716 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28717
28718 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28719 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28720 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28721 .code
28722 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28723 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28724 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28725 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28726 .endd
28727 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28728 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28729 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28730 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28731 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28732 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28733 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28734
28735 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28736 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28737 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28738 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28739 message is handled.
28740
28741 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28742 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28743 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28744 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28745 .code
28746 require message = Can't verify sender
28747 verify = sender
28748 message = Can't verify recipient
28749 verify = recipient
28750 message = This message cannot be used
28751 .endd
28752 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28753 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28754 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28755 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28756 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28757 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28758
28759 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28760 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28761 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28762 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28763 .code
28764 deny hosts = ...
28765 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28766 message = Invalid sender from client host
28767 .endd
28768 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28769 by which time Exim has set up the message.
28770
28771
28772
28773 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28774 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28775 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28776
28777 .vlist
28778 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28779 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28780 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28781 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28782
28783 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28784 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28785 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28786 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28787 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28788 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28789 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28790 write rather ugly lines like this:
28791 .display
28792 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28793 .endd
28794 Instead, all you need is
28795 .display
28796 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28797 .endd
28798
28799 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28800 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28801 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28802 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28803 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28804 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28805 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28806 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28807
28808 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28809 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28810 in several different ways. For example:
28811
28812 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28813 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28814 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28815 . ==== way.
28816
28817 .ilist
28818 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28819 .code
28820 accept ...some conditions
28821 control = queue_only
28822 .endd
28823 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28824 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28825
28826 .next
28827 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28828 .code
28829 accept ...some conditions...
28830 control = queue_only
28831 ...some more conditions...
28832 .endd
28833 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28834 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28835 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28836 to be relevant.
28837
28838 .next
28839 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28840 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28841 example:
28842 .code
28843 warn ...some conditions...
28844 control = freeze
28845 accept ...
28846 .endd
28847 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28848 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28849 log entry.
28850
28851 .next
28852 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28853 &%require%& verb. For example:
28854 .code
28855 require control = no_multiline_responses
28856 .endd
28857 .endlist
28858
28859 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28860 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28861 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
28862 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28863 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28864 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28865 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28866 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28867 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28868
28869 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28870 example:
28871 .code
28872 deny ...some conditions...
28873 delay = 30s
28874 .endd
28875 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28876 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28877 .code
28878 deny delay = 30s
28879 ...some conditions...
28880 .endd
28881 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28882 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28883 .code
28884 warn ...some conditions...
28885 delay = 2m
28886 control = freeze
28887 accept ...
28888 .endd
28889
28890 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28891 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28892 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28893 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28894 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28895 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28896 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28897
28898
28899 .vitem &*endpass*&
28900 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28901 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28902 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28903 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28904 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28905 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28906 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28907
28908
28909 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28910 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28911 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28912 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28913 .code
28914 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28915 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28916 .endd
28917 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28918 example:
28919 .display
28920 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28921 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28922 .endd
28923 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28924 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28925 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28926 message.
28927
28928 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28929 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28930 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28931 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28932 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28933 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28934 ignored.
28935
28936 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28937 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28938 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28939 error message.
28940
28941 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28942 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28943 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28944 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28945 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28946 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28947
28948 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28949 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28950 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28951 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28952 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28953 logging rejections.
28954
28955
28956 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28957 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28958 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28959 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28960 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28961 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28962 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28963 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28964 .display
28965 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28966 &` log_reject_target =`&
28967 .endd
28968 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28969 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28970 current ACL.
28971
28972
28973 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28974 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28975 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28976 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28977 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28978 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28979 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28980 ACLs. For example:
28981 .display
28982 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28983 &` control = freeze`&
28984 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28985 .endd
28986 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28987 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28988 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28989 example:
28990 .code
28991 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28992 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28993 .endd
28994
28995
28996 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28997 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28998 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28999 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29000 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29001 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29002 &%accept%& for details.)
29003
29004 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29005 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29006 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29007 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29008 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29009 .code
29010 require message = Host not recognized
29011 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
29012 .endd
29013 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29014 processed.)
29015
29016 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29017 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29018 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29019 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29020 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29021 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29022 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29023 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29024 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29025 EHLO options.
29026
29027 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29028 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29029 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29030 .code
29031 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29032 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29033 .endd
29034 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29035 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29036 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
29037 2&'xx'&.
29038
29039 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29040 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29041
29042 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29043 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29044 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29045 response.
29046
29047 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29048 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29049 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29050
29051 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29052 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29053 However, the original message is available in the variable
29054 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29055 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29056 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29057 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29058
29059 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29060 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29061 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29062 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29063 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29064 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29065 effect.
29066
29067
29068 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29069 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29070 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29071 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29072 for the message.
29073 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29074 the DATA ACL).
29075 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29076 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29077 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29078 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29079
29080
29081 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29082 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29083 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29084 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29085
29086
29087 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29088 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29089 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29090 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29091
29092
29093 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29094 .cindex "UDP communications"
29095 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29096 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29097 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29098 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29099 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29100 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29101 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29102 when:
29103 .code
29104 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29105 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29106 .endd
29107 .endlist
29108
29109
29110
29111
29112 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29113 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29114 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29115
29116 .vlist
29117 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29118 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29119 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29120 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29121 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29122 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29123 not work without it. For example:
29124 .code
29125 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29126 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29127 .endd
29128 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29129 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29130 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29131 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29132 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29133
29134
29135 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29136 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29137 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29138 .cindex "case of local parts"
29139 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29140 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29141 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29142 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29143 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29144 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29145 is encountered.
29146
29147 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29148 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29149 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29150 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29151 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29152
29153 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29154 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29155 spam score:
29156 .code
29157 warn control = caseful_local_part
29158 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29159 $acl_m4 + \
29160 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29161 }
29162 control = caselower_local_part
29163 .endd
29164 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29165 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29166
29167
29168 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29169 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29170 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29171 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29172
29173 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29174 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29175 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29176 is used for all recipients of the message,
29177 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29178 and data is copied from one to the other.
29179
29180 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29181 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29182 If a recipient-verify callout
29183 (with use_sender)
29184 connection is subsequently
29185 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29186 any subsequent recipients and the data,
29187 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29188
29189 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29190 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29191 Note also that headers cannot be
29192 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29193 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29194 The Received-By: header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29195 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29196 this will affect the timestamp.
29197
29198 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29199 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29200 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29201 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29202 message body.
29203
29204 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29205 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29206 before the entire message has been received from the source.
29207 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29208 or CHUNKING
29209 options in use.
29210
29211 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29212 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29213 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29214 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29215 before the acceptance "<=" line.
29216
29217 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29218 usual fashion.
29219 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29220 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29221 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29222 and does not queue the message.
29223 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29224
29225 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29226 (possibly faked)
29227 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29228
29229
29230 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29231 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29232 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29233 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29234 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29235 by default called &'debuglog'&.
29236 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29237 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29238 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29239 option.
29240 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29241 with the &'kill'& option.
29242 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29243 contexts):
29244 .code
29245 control = debug
29246 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29247 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29248 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29249 control = debug/kill
29250 .endd
29251
29252
29253 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29254 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29255 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29256 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29257 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29258
29259
29260 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29261 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29262 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29263 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29264 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29265 strings or to numeric value.
29266 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29267 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29268 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29269
29270 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29271 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29272 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29273 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29274 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29275
29276
29277 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29278 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29279 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29280 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29281 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29282 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29283 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29284 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29285
29286 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29287 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29288 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29289 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29290 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29291 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29292 work with.
29293
29294
29295 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29296 .cindex "fake defer"
29297 .cindex "defer, fake"
29298 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29299 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29300 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29301 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29302 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29303
29304 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29305 .cindex "fake rejection"
29306 .cindex "rejection, fake"
29307 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29308 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29309 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29310 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29311 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29312 the same SMTP connection.
29313
29314 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29315 message is supplied, the following is used:
29316 .code
29317 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29318 550-kept for evaluation.
29319 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29320 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29321 .endd
29322 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29323
29324 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29325 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29326 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29327 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29328 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29329 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29330 SMTP connection.
29331
29332 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29333 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29334 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29335 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29336
29337 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29338 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29339 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29340 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29341 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29342 disables such output flushing.
29343
29344 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29345 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29346 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29347 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29348 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29349 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29350
29351 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29352 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29353 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29354 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29355 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29356 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29357 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29358 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29359 to be useful in production.
29360
29361 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29362 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29363 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29364 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29365 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29366
29367 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29368 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29369 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29370 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29371 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29372 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29373
29374 .ilist
29375 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29376 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29377 verification failed"&) is sent.
29378 .next
29379 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29380 line is output.
29381 .endlist
29382
29383 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29384 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29385
29386 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29387 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29388 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29389 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29390 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29391 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29392 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29393
29394 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29395 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29396 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29397 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29398 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29399 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29400 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29401 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29402 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29403 same SMTP connection.
29404
29405 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29406 .cindex "message" "submission"
29407 .cindex "submission mode"
29408 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29409 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29410 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29411 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29412 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29413 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29414 late (the message has already been created).
29415
29416 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29417 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29418 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29419 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29420 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29421
29422 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29423 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29424 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29425 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29426 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29427
29428 .ilist
29429 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29430 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29431 .next
29432 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29433 .next
29434 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29435 .endlist ilist
29436
29437 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29438 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29439 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29440 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29441 data is read.
29442
29443 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29444 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29445
29446 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29447 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29448 to a-label form.
29449 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29450 .endlist vlist
29451
29452
29453 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29454 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29455
29456 .ilist
29457 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29458 .next
29459 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29460 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29461 .next
29462 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29463 .next
29464 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29465 .endlist
29466
29467
29468
29469 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29470 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29471 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29472 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29473 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29474 to an incoming message, as in this example:
29475 .code
29476 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29477 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29478 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29479 .endd
29480 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29481 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29482 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29483 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29484 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29485 RCPT ACL).
29486
29487 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29488 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29489
29490 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29491 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29492 contains one or more newlines that
29493 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29494 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29495 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29496
29497 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29498 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29499 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29500 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29501 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29502 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29503 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29504 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29505 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29506 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29507 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29508
29509 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29510 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29511 of message headers
29512 until they are added to the
29513 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29514 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29515 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29516 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29517 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29518 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29519 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29520
29521 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29522
29523 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29524 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29525 .display
29526 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29527 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29528
29529 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29530 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29531 .endd
29532 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29533 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29534 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29535 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29536 honoured.
29537
29538 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29539 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29540 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29541 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29542 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29543 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29544 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29545 specifications.
29546
29547 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29548 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29549 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29550 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29551 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29552
29553 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29554 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29555 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29556 to be a header name first.) For example:
29557 .code
29558 warn add_header = \
29559 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29560 .endd
29561 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29562 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29563 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29564 up in reverse order.
29565
29566 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29567 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29568 system filter or in a router or transport.
29569
29570
29571
29572 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29573 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29574 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29575 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29576 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29577 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29578 .code
29579 warn message = Remove internal headers
29580 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29581 .endd
29582 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29583 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29584 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29585 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29586 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29587 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29588
29589 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29590 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29591
29592 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29593 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29594 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29595 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29596 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29597 .code
29598 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29599 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29600 warn message = Remove internal headers
29601 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29602 .endd
29603 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29604 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29605 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29606 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29607 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29608 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29609 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29610 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29611 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29612 would have been removed.
29613
29614 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29615 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29616 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29617 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29618 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29619 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29620 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29621 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29622 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29623
29624 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29625 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29626 .display
29627 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29628 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29629
29630 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29631 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29632 .endd
29633 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29634 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29635 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29636 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29637 are honoured.
29638
29639 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29640 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29641 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29642
29643
29644
29645
29646 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29647 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29648 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29649 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29650 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29651 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29652
29653 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29654 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29655 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29656 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29657 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29658 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29659 The conditions are as follows:
29660
29661
29662 .vlist
29663 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29664 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29665 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29666 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29667 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29668 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29669 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29670 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29671 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29672 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29673 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29674 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29675
29676 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29677 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29678 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29679 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29680 The name and values are expanded separately.
29681 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29682 will act as argument separators.
29683
29684 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29685 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29686 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29687 conditions are tested.
29688
29689 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29690 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29691 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29692 for different local users or different local domains.
29693
29694 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29695 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29696 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29697 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29698 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29699 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29700 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29701 .code
29702 authenticated = *
29703 .endd
29704
29705 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29706 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29707 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29708 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29709 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29710 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29711 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29712 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29713 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29714 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29715 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29716 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29717 negative.
29718
29719 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29720 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29721 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29722 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29723 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29724 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29725 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29726 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29727
29728 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29729 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29730 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29731 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29732 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29733 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29734 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29735 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29736 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29737 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29738
29739 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29740 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29741 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29742 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29743 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29744 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29745 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29746 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29747 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29748 &%domains%& test.
29749
29750 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29751 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29752
29753
29754 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29755 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29756 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29757 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29758 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29759 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29760 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29761 .code
29762 encrypted = *
29763 .endd
29764
29765
29766 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29767 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29768 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29769 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29770 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29771 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29772 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29773 .code
29774 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29775 .endd
29776 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29777 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29778 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29779
29780 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29781 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29782 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
29783 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
29784 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
29785 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
29786
29787 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
29788 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
29789 .code
29790 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29791 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
29792 .endd
29793 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
29794 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
29795 statement can then check the IP address.
29796
29797 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
29798 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
29799 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
29800 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
29801 .code
29802 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
29803 message = $host_data
29804 .endd
29805 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
29806
29807 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
29808 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
29809 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
29810 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
29811 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
29812 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
29813 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
29814 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
29815 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29816 the next &%local_parts%& test.
29817
29818 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29819 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29820 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29821 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29822 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29823 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29824 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29825
29826 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29827 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29828 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29829 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29830 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29831 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29832 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29833 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29834
29835 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29836 .cindex "rate limiting"
29837 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29838 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29839
29840 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29841 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29842 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29843 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29844 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29845 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29846
29847 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29848 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29849 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29850 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29851 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29852 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29853 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29854
29855 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29856 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29857 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29858 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29859 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29860 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29861 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29862 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29863 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29864 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29865 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29866 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29867 influence the sender checking.
29868
29869 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29870 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29871
29872 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29873 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29874 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29875 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29876 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29877 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29878 .code
29879 senders = :
29880 .endd
29881 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29882 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29883
29884 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29885 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29886 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29887 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29888 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29889 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29890
29891 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29892 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29893 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29894 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29895 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29896 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29897 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29898 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29899 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29900 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29901
29902 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29903 .cindex "CSA verification"
29904 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29905 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29906 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29907
29908 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29909 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29910 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29911 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29912 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29913 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29914 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29915 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29916 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29917 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29918
29919 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29920 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29921 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29922
29923 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29924 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29925 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29926 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29927 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29928 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29929 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29930 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29931 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29932 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29933 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29934 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29935 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29936 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29937 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29938
29939 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29940 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29941 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29942 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29943 .code
29944 deny senders = :
29945 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29946 !verify = header_sender
29947 .endd
29948
29949 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29950 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29951 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29952 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29953 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29954 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29955 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29956 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29957 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29958 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29959 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29960 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29961 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29962 appropriate.
29963
29964 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29965 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29966 .code
29967 To: @
29968 .endd
29969 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29970 common as they used to be.
29971
29972 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29973 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29974 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29975 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29976 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29977 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29978 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29979 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29980 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29981 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29982 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29983 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29984 independently of this condition.
29985
29986 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29987 option), this condition is always true.
29988
29989
29990 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29991 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29992 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29993 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29994 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29995 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29996 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29997 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29998 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29999
30000 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30001 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30002
30003
30004 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30005 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30006 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30007 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30008 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30009 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30010 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30011 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30012 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30013 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30014 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30015 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30016 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30017 value for the child address.
30018
30019 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30020 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30021 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30022 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30023 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30024 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30025 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30026 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30027 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30028 original IP address.
30029
30030 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30031 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30032
30033 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30034 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30035
30036 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30037 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30038 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30039 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
30040 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
30041 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30042 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30043 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30044 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30045
30046 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30047 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30048 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30049 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30050 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30051 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30052 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30053
30054 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30055 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30056 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30057
30058 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30059 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30060 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30061 verified as a sender.
30062
30063 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30064 (eg. is generated from the received message)
30065 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30066 .code
30067 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30068 .endd
30069 .endlist
30070
30071
30072
30073 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30074 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30075 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30076 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30077 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30078 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30079 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30080 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30081 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30082 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30083 .code
30084 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30085 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30086 .endd
30087 the following records are looked up:
30088 .code
30089 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30090 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30091 .endd
30092 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30093 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30094 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30095 use two separate conditions:
30096 .code
30097 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30098 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30099 .endd
30100 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30101 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30102 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30103 processed.
30104
30105 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30106 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30107 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30108 following special items in the list:
30109 .display
30110 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30111 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30112 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30113 .endd
30114 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30115 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30116 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30117 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30118 .code
30119 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30120 .endd
30121 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30122 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30123 .code
30124 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30125 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30126 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30127 .endd
30128 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30129 .cindex DNS TTL
30130 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30131 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30132 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30133 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30134 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30135 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30136
30137
30138
30139 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30140 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30141 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30142 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30143 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30144 .code
30145 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30146 .endd
30147 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30148 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30149 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30150 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30151
30152
30153
30154
30155 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30156 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30157 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30158 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
30159 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
30160 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30161 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30162 .code
30163 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30164 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30165 .endd
30166 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30167 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30168 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30169 up by this example is
30170 .code
30171 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30172 .endd
30173 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30174 addresses. For example:
30175 .code
30176 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30177 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30178 .endd
30179 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30180 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30181
30182
30183
30184
30185 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30186 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30187 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30188 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30189 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30190 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30191 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30192 either to double the separators like this:
30193 .code
30194 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30195 .endd
30196 or to change the separator character, like this:
30197 .code
30198 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30199 .endd
30200 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30201 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30202 occurs. Consider this condition:
30203 .code
30204 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30205 .endd
30206 The DNS lookups that occur are:
30207 .code
30208 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30209 a.domain.black.list.tld
30210 .endd
30211 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30212 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30213 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30214 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30215 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30216 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30217 error for a previous item.
30218
30219 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30220 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30221 .code
30222 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30223 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30224 .endd
30225 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30226 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30227 .code
30228 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30229 $sender_address_domain \
30230 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30231 see $dnslist_text.
30232 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30233 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30234 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30235 .endd
30236 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30237 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30238 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30239 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30240 .code
30241 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30242 .endd
30243 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30244 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30245
30246 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30247 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30248
30249
30250
30251
30252 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30253 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30254 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30255 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30256 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30257 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30258 .display
30259 127.1.0.1 RBL
30260 127.1.0.2 DUL
30261 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30262 127.1.0.4 RSS
30263 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30264 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30265 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30266 .endd
30267 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30268 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30269 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30270
30271
30272 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30273 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30274 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30275 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30276 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30277 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30278 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30279 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30280 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30281 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30282 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30283 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30284 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30285 cases, for example:
30286 .code
30287 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30288 .endd
30289 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30290 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30291 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30292 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30293 .code
30294 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30295 .endd
30296 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30297 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30298
30299 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30300 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30301 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30302 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30303 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30304 information.
30305
30306 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30307 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30308 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30309 .code
30310 deny hosts = !+local_networks
30311 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30312 at $dnslist_domain
30313 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30314 .endd
30315
30316
30317
30318 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30319 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30320 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30321 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30322 For example,
30323 .code
30324 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30325 .endd
30326 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30327 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30328 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30329 describes how multiple records are handled.
30330
30331 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30332 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30333 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30334 .code
30335 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30336 .endd
30337 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30338 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30339 first. For example:
30340 .code
30341 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30342 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30343 .endd
30344
30345 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30346 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30347 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30348 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30349 tested. For example:
30350 .code
30351 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30352 .endd
30353 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30354 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30355 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30356 .code
30357 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30358 .endd
30359 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30360 an odd number.
30361
30362
30363
30364 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30365 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30366 condition. Whereas
30367 .code
30368 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30369 .endd
30370 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30371 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30372 .code
30373 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30374 .endd
30375 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30376 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30377 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30378 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30379
30380 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30381 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30382
30383 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30384 previous example is precisely equivalent to
30385 .code
30386 deny dnslists = a.b.c
30387 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30388 .endd
30389 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30390 Consider this example:
30391 .code
30392 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30393 list.dsbl.org : \
30394 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30395 relays.ordb.org
30396 .endd
30397 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30398 .code
30399 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30400 list.dsbl.org
30401 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30402 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30403 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30404 .endd
30405 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30406
30407
30408
30409
30410 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30411 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30412 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30413 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30414 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30415 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30416 .code
30417 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30418 .endd
30419 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30420 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30421 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30422 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30423 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30424 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30425
30426 .ilist
30427 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30428 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30429 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30430 .next
30431 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30432 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30433 changed to:
30434 .code
30435 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30436 .endd
30437 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30438 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30439 .code
30440 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30441 .endd
30442 for the condition to be true.
30443 .endlist
30444
30445 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30446 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30447 .ilist
30448 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30449 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30450 .code
30451 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30452 .endd
30453 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30454 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30455 .next
30456 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30457 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30458 .code
30459 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30460 .endd
30461 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30462 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30463 .code
30464 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30465 .endd
30466 for the condition to be false.
30467 .endlist
30468 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30469 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30470
30471
30472
30473
30474 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30475 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30476 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30477 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30478 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30479 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30480 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30481 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30482 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30483 lists.
30484
30485 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30486 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30487 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30488 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30489 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30490 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30491 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30492 .code
30493 reject message = \
30494 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30495 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30496 dnslists = \
30497 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30498 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30499 .endd
30500 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30501 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30502 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30503 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30504 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30505 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30506
30507 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30508 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30509 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30510 .code
30511 reject dnslists = \
30512 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30513 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30514 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30515 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30516 .endd
30517 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30518 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30519 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30520
30521
30522
30523 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30524 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30525 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30526 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30527 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
30528 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30529 .code
30530 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30531 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30532 .endd
30533 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30534 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30535 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30536 .code
30537 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30538 .endd
30539 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30540 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30541
30542 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30543 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30544 .code
30545 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30546 dnslists = some.list.example
30547 .endd
30548
30549 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30550 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30551 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30552 .code
30553 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30554 .endd
30555
30556 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30557 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30558 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30559 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30560 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30561 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30562 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30563 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30564 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30565 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30566 .display
30567 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30568 .endd
30569 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30570 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30571
30572 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30573 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30574 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30575 of &'p'&.
30576
30577 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30578 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30579 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30580 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30581 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30582 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30583 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30584 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30585 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30586
30587 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30588 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30589 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30590 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30591
30592 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30593 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30594 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30595 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30596 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30597 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30598 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30599 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30600 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30601 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30602
30603 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30604 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30605 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30606 ACL.
30607
30608 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30609 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30610 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30611 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30612 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30613 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30614
30615 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30616 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30617 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30618 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30619 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30620 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30621 the &%count=%& option.
30622
30623
30624 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30625 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30626 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30627 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30628 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30629
30630 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30631 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30632 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30633 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30634
30635 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30636 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30637 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30638 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30639 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30640 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30641 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30642
30643 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30644 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30645 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30646 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30647 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30648 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30649 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30650
30651 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30652 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30653 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30654 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30655 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
30656
30657 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30658 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30659 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30660 multiple different commands.
30661
30662 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30663 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30664 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30665 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30666 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30667
30668 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30669
30670
30671 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30672 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30673 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30674 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30675 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30676
30677 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30678 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30679
30680 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30681 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30682 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30683 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30684 new rate.
30685 .code
30686 acl_check_connect:
30687 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30688 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30689 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30690 # ...
30691 acl_check_mail:
30692 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30693 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30694 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30695 .endd
30696
30697 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30698 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30699 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30700 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30701 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30702 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30703 checks.
30704
30705 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30706 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30707 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30708 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30709 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30710
30711
30712 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30713 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30714 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30715 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30716 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30717 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30718 rest of the ACL.
30719
30720 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30721 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30722 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30723 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30724 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30725 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30726 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30727 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30728 from getting any email through.
30729
30730 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30731 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30732 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30733 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30734 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30735 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30736 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30737 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30738 .code
30739 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30740 .endd
30741
30742
30743 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30744 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30745 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30746 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30747 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30748 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30749 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30750 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30751 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30752
30753 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30754 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30755 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30756 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30757 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30758 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30759
30760 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30761 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30762 rate.
30763
30764 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30765 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30766 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30767 required increases with larger limits.
30768
30769 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30770 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30771 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30772 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30773 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30774 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30775 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30776 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30777 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
30778 as intended.
30779
30780
30781 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30782 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
30783 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
30784 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
30785 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
30786 message. For example:
30787 .code
30788 # Log all senders' rates
30789 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
30790 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
30791
30792 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
30793 # at the decimal point.
30794 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
30795 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
30796 $sender_rate_limit }s
30797
30798 # Keep authenticated users under control
30799 deny authenticated = *
30800 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
30801
30802 # System-wide rate limit
30803 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
30804 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
30805
30806 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
30807 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
30808 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
30809 messages per $sender_rate_period
30810 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
30811 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
30812 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
30813 .endd
30814 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
30815 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
30816 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
30817 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
30818 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
30819 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
30820 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
30821
30822
30823
30824 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
30825 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30826 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30827 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30828 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30829 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30830 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30831 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30832 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30833 .code
30834 verify = sender/callout
30835 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30836 .endd
30837 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30838 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30839 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30840 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30841 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30842 The available options are as follows:
30843
30844 .ilist
30845 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30846 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30847 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30848 .next
30849 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30850 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30851 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30852 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30853 .next
30854 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30855 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30856 .next
30857 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30858 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30859 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30860 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30861 .endlist
30862
30863 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30864 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30865 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30866 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30867 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30868 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30869 coding like this:
30870 .code
30871 warn !verify = sender
30872 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30873 .endd
30874 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30875 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30876 verification failure.
30877
30878 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30879 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30880
30881 .ilist
30882 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30883 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30884 .next
30885 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30886 .next
30887 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30888 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30889 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30890 .next
30891 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30892 .next
30893 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30894 .endlist
30895
30896 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30897 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30898
30899
30900
30901
30902 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30903 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30904 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30905 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30906 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30907 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30908 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30909 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30910 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30911 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30912 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30913 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30914 sender's domain.
30915
30916 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30917 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30918 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30919 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30920 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30921 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30922
30923 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30924 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30925 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30926 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30927 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30928
30929 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30930 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30931 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30932 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30933 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30934 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30935 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30936 supplies a host list.
30937 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30938
30939 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30940 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30941 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30942 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30943 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30944 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30945 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30946
30947 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30948 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30949 following SMTP commands are sent:
30950 .display
30951 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30952 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30953 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30954 &`QUIT`&
30955 .endd
30956 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30957 set to &"lmtp"&.
30958
30959 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30960 settings.
30961
30962 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30963 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30964 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30965 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30966 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30967 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30968
30969 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30970 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30971 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30972 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30973 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30974
30975 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30976 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30977 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30978 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30979 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30980
30981
30982
30983
30984 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30985 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30986 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30987 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30988 .code
30989 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30990 .endd
30991 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30992 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30993 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30994
30995
30996 .vlist
30997 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30998 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30999 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31000 For example:
31001 .code
31002 verify = sender/callout=5s
31003 .endd
31004 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31005 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31006 the &%connect%& parameter.
31007
31008
31009 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31010 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31011 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31012 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31013 .code
31014 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31015 .endd
31016 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31017
31018 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
31019 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31020 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31021 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31022 updated in this circumstance.
31023
31024 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31025 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31026 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31027 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31028 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31029 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31030
31031
31032 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31033 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31034 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31035 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31036 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31037 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31038 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31039 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31040 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31041 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31042 .code
31043 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31044 .endd
31045 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31046
31047
31048 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31049 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31050 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31051 For example:
31052 .code
31053 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31054 .endd
31055 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31056 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31057 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31058 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31059 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
31060
31061
31062 .vitem &*no_cache*&
31063 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31064 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31065 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31066
31067 .vitem &*postmaster*&
31068 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31069 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31070 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31071 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31072 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31073 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31074 made, until the cache record expires.
31075
31076 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31077 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31078 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31079 For example:
31080 .code
31081 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31082 .endd
31083 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31084 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31085 .code
31086 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31087 .endd
31088 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31089 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31090 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31091 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31092
31093
31094 .vitem &*random*&
31095 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31096 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31097 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31098 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31099 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31100 .code
31101 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31102 .endd
31103 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31104 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31105 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31106 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31107 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31108
31109 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31110 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31111 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31112 .code
31113 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31114 .endd
31115 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31116 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31117 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31118 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31119 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31120
31121 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31122 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31123 .code
31124 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31125 .endd
31126 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31127 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31128 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31129 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31130 usefulness of callout caching.
31131
31132 .vitem &*hold*&
31133 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31134 .code
31135 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31136 .endd
31137 It causes the connection to be helod open and used for any further recipients
31138 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31139 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31140 when that is used for the connections.
31141 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31142 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31143 if the use_sender option is used,
31144 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31145 and if no other callouts intervene.
31146 .endlist
31147
31148 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31149 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31150 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31151 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31152 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31153 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31154 these circumstances.
31155
31156 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31157 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31158 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31159 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31160 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31161 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31162 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31163
31164 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31165 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31166 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31167 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31168
31169
31170
31171
31172 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31173 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31174 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31175 .cindex "caching" "callout"
31176 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31177 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31178 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31179 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31180 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31181 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31182
31183 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31184 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31185 is not available.
31186
31187 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31188 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31189 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31190
31191 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31192 commands up to and including
31193 .code
31194 MAIL FROM:<>
31195 .endd
31196 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31197 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31198 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31199 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31200 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31201 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31202 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31203
31204 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31205 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31206 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31207 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31208 will eventually be noticed.
31209
31210 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31211 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31212 behaviour will be the same.
31213
31214
31215
31216 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31217 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31218 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31219 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31220 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31221 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31222 you might see:
31223 .code
31224 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31225 250 OK
31226 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31227 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31228 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31229 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31230 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31231 550 Sender verification failed
31232 .endd
31233 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31234 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31235 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31236 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31237 example:
31238 .code
31239 verify = sender/no_details
31240 .endd
31241
31242 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31243 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31244 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31245 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31246 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31247 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31248 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31249
31250 .ilist
31251 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31252 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31253 verification also fails.
31254 .next
31255 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31256 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31257 .endlist
31258
31259 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31260 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31261 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31262 .code
31263 A.Wol: aw123
31264 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31265 .endd
31266 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31267 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31268 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31269 verification to succeed.
31270
31271 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31272 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31273 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31274 option. For example:
31275 .code
31276 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31277 .endd
31278 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31279 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31280
31281 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31282 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31283 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31284 address and a report is output for each of them.
31285
31286
31287
31288 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31289 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31290 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31291 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31292 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31293 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31294 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31295 .code
31296 verify = csa
31297 .endd
31298 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31299 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31300 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31301 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31302 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31303 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31304
31305 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31306 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31307 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31308 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31309
31310 .ilist
31311 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31312 .next
31313 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31314 .next
31315 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31316 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31317 .next
31318 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31319 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31320 .endlist
31321
31322 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31323 use for the DNS query. The default is:
31324 .code
31325 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31326 .endd
31327 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31328 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31329 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31330 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31331 meaningful to say:
31332 .code
31333 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31334 .endd
31335 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31336 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31337 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31338
31339 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31340 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31341 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31342 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31343 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31344 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31345 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31346 of legitimate HELO domains.
31347
31348 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31349 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31350 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31351 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31352 lookup such as:
31353 .code
31354 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31355 .endd
31356 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31357 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31358 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31359
31360
31361
31362
31363 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31364 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
31365 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31366 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31367 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31368 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31369 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31370 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31371
31372 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31373 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31374 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31375 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31376 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31377 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31378 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31379 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
31380
31381 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31382 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31383 like this:
31384 .code
31385 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31386 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31387 }{$value}}
31388 .endd
31389 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31390 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31391 use this:
31392 .code
31393 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31394 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31395 senders = :
31396 recipients = +batv_senders
31397
31398 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31399 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31400 senders = :
31401 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31402 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31403 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31404 .endd
31405 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31406 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31407 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31408 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31409 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31410
31411 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31412 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31413 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31414 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31415 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31416 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31417 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31418
31419 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31420 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31421 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31422 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31423 .code
31424 batv_redirect:
31425 driver = redirect
31426 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31427 .endd
31428 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31429 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31430 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31431 local addresses.
31432
31433 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31434 can be used:
31435 .code
31436 external_smtp_batv:
31437 driver = smtp
31438 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31439 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31440 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31441 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31442 {$value}fail}}}
31443 .endd
31444 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31445
31446
31447
31448 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31449 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31450 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31451 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31452 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31453 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31454 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31455 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31456 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31457 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31458
31459 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31460 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31461 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31462 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31463 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31464 same host is fulfilling both functions,
31465 . ///
31466 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
31467 . ///
31468 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31469 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31470 system to arbitrary domains.
31471
31472
31473 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31474 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31475 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31476 example, suppose you want to do the following:
31477
31478 .ilist
31479 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31480 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31481 &'my.dom2.example'&.
31482 .next
31483 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31484 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31485 .next
31486 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31487 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31488 .endlist
31489
31490
31491 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31492 .code
31493 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31494 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31495 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31496 .endd
31497 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31498 command:
31499 .code
31500 acl_check_rcpt:
31501 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31502 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31503 .endd
31504 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31505 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31506 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31507 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31508 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31509 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31510 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31511
31512
31513
31514 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31515 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31516 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31517 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31518 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31519 .ecindex IIDacl
31520
31521
31522
31523 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31524 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31525
31526 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31527 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31528 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31529 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31530 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31531 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31532 specification.
31533
31534 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31535 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31536 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31537 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31538 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31539
31540 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31541 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31542 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31543
31544 .ilist
31545 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31546 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31547 .next
31548 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31549 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31550 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31551 .next
31552 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31553 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31554 .next
31555 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31556 conditions.
31557 .next
31558 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31559 .endlist
31560
31561 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31562 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31563 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31564 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31565 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31566 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31567
31568 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31569 temporarily created in a file called:
31570 .display
31571 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31572 .endd
31573 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31574 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31575 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31576 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31577 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31578 .code
31579 control = no_mbox_unspool
31580 .endd
31581 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31582 same directory by default.
31583
31584
31585
31586 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31587 .cindex "virus scanning"
31588 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31589 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31590 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31591 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31592 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31593 in memory and thus are much faster.
31594
31595 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31596 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31597
31598 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31599 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31600 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31601 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31602 .display
31603 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31604 .endd
31605 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31606 .code
31607 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31608 .endd
31609 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31610 before use.
31611 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31612 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
31613 .new
31614 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
31615 .wen
31616
31617 .vlist
31618 .vitem &%avast%&
31619 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31620 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31621 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
31622 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31623 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31624 This scanner type takes one option,
31625 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31626 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31627 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31628 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31629 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
31630 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31631 For example:
31632 .code
31633 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31634 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31635 .endd
31636 If you omit the argument, the default path
31637 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31638 is used.
31639 If you use a remote host,
31640 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31641 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31642 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31643 .code
31644 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31645 FLAGS
31646 SENSITIVITY
31647 PACK
31648 .endd
31649
31650
31651 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31652 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31653 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31654 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31655 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31656 example:
31657 .code
31658 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31659 .endd
31660
31661
31662 .vitem &%clamd%&
31663 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31664 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31665 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31666 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31667 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31668
31669 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31670 a UNIX socket specification,
31671 a TCP socket specification,
31672 or a (global) option.
31673
31674 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31675 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31676 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31677 and the second a port number,
31678 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31679 These per-server options are supported:
31680 .code
31681 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31682 .endd
31683
31684 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31685 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31686
31687 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31688
31689 Examples:
31690 .code
31691 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31692 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31693 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31694 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31695 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31696 .endd
31697 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31698 &`local`&
31699 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31700 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31701 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31702 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31703
31704 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31705 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31706 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31707 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31708 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31709 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31710 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31711 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31712 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31713 .code
31714 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31715 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31716 (Connection refused)
31717 .endd
31718
31719 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31720 contributing the code for this scanner.
31721
31722 .vitem &%cmdline%&
31723 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31724 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31725 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31726 type takes 3 mandatory options:
31727
31728 .olist
31729 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31730 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31731
31732 .next
31733 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31734 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31735 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31736 the &"trigger"& expression.
31737
31738 .next
31739 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31740 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31741 &"name"& expression.
31742 .endlist olist
31743
31744 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31745 .code
31746 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31747 .endd
31748 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31749 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31750 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31751 configuration setting:
31752 .code
31753 av_scanner = cmdline:\
31754 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31755 found in file:'(.+)'
31756 .endd
31757 .vitem &%drweb%&
31758 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31759 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31760 takes one option,
31761 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31762 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31763 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31764 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31765 For example:
31766 .code
31767 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31768 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31769 .endd
31770 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31771 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31772
31773 .vitem &%f-protd%&
31774 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31775 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
31776 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
31777 (or port-range).
31778 For example:
31779 .code
31780 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
31781 .endd
31782 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31783
31784 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
31785 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
31786 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
31787 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
31788 For example:
31789 .code
31790 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
31791 .endd
31792 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31793
31794 .vitem &%fsecure%&
31795 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
31796 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
31797 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
31798 .code
31799 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
31800 .endd
31801 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
31802 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
31803
31804 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
31805 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31806 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
31807 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
31808 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
31809 For example:
31810 .code
31811 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
31812 .endd
31813 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
31814
31815 .vitem &%mksd%&
31816 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
31817 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
31818 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
31819 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
31820 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
31821 provided that mksd has
31822 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
31823 .code
31824 av_scanner = mksd:2
31825 .endd
31826 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
31827
31828 .vitem &%sock%&
31829 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
31830 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
31831 running on the local machine.
31832 There are four options:
31833 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
31834 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
31835 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
31836 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31837 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31838 For example:
31839 .code
31840 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
31841 .endd
31842 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
31843 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
31844 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
31845 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
31846 specify an empty element to get this.
31847
31848 .vitem &%sophie%&
31849 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31850 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31851 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31852 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31853 client communication. For example:
31854 .code
31855 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31856 .endd
31857 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31858 the option.
31859 .endlist
31860
31861 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31862 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31863 ACL.
31864
31865 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31866 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31867 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31868 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31869 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31870 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31871 message.
31872
31873 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31874 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31875 The first element can then be one of
31876
31877 .ilist
31878 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31879 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31880 recommended usage.
31881 .next
31882 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31883 the condition fails immediately.
31884 .next
31885 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31886 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31887 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31888 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31889 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31890 .endlist
31891
31892 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31893 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31894 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31895
31896 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31897 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31898 For example:
31899 .code
31900 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31901 .endd
31902 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31903
31904 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31905 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31906 is set to record the actual address used.
31907
31908 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31909 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31910 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31911 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31912 logging data.
31913
31914 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31915 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31916
31917 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31918 .code
31919 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31920 malware = *
31921 .endd
31922 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31923 .code
31924 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31925 malware = */defer_ok
31926 .endd
31927 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31928 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31929 .code
31930 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31931 .endd
31932 in the main Exim configuration.
31933 .code
31934 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31935 set acl_m0 = sophie
31936 malware = *
31937
31938 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31939 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31940 malware = *
31941 .endd
31942
31943
31944 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31945 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31946 .cindex "spam scanning"
31947 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31948 .cindex "Rspamd"
31949 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31950 score and a report for the message.
31951 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31952
31953 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31954 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31955 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31956
31957 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31958 .code
31959 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31960 .endd
31961 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31962 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31963 nicely, however.
31964
31965 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31966 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31967 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31968 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31969 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31970 configuration as follows (example):
31971 .code
31972 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31973 .endd
31974 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
31975 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
31976 iptables firewall, consider setting
31977 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
31978 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
31979 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
31980 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
31981 soon.
31982
31983
31984 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31985 on TCP port 11333)
31986 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31987 .code
31988 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31989 .endd
31990
31991 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31992 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31993 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31994 .code
31995 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31996 .endd
31997 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31998 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31999 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32000 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
32001 .code
32002 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32003 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32004 192.168.2.12 783
32005 .endd
32006 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32007 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32008 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32009 condition defers.
32010
32011 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32012 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32013 and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
32014
32015 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32016 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32017 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32018 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32019
32020 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32021 are options.
32022 The supported options are:
32023 .code
32024 pri=<priority> Selection priority
32025 weight=<value> Selection bias
32026 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32027 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32028 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32029 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32030 .endd
32031
32032 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32033 higher values being tried first.
32034 The default priority is 1.
32035
32036 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32037 Within a priority set
32038 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32039 The default value for selection bias is 1.
32040
32041 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32042 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32043 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32044 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32045
32046 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32047 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32048
32049 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32050 The default value is two minutes.
32051
32052 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32053 a failed connect is made.
32054 The default is to not retry.
32055
32056 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32057 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32058 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32059 expansion.
32060
32061 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32062 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32063 is set to record the actual address used.
32064
32065 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32066 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32067 .code
32068 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32069 spam = joe
32070 .endd
32071 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32072 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32073 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32074 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32075 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32076 right-hand side.
32077
32078 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32079 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32080 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32081 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32082 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32083 are not set.
32084 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32085 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32086 after the first),
32087 or the use of PRDR,
32088 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32089 are needed to use this feature.
32090
32091 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32092 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32093 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32094
32095
32096 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32097 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32098 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32099 example:
32100 .code
32101 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32102 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32103 spam = nobody
32104 .endd
32105
32106 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32107 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32108 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32109 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32110
32111 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32112 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32113 variables.
32114 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32115 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32116 available for use at delivery time.
32117
32118 .vlist
32119 .vitem &$spam_score$&
32120 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32121 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32122
32123 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32124 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32125 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32126 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32127 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32128
32129 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
32130 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32131 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32132 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32133 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32134 spam bar is 50 characters.
32135
32136 .vitem &$spam_report$&
32137 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32138 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32139 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32140 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32141 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32142 unencoded in headers.
32143
32144 .vitem &$spam_action$&
32145 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32146 spam score versus threshold.
32147 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32148
32149 .endlist
32150
32151 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32152 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32153 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32154
32155 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32156 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32157 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32158 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32159 spam condition, like this:
32160 .code
32161 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32162 spam = joe/defer_ok
32163 .endd
32164 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32165
32166 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32167 condition:
32168 .code
32169 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32170 warn spam = nobody:true
32171 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32172 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32173
32174 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32175 # is over threshold
32176 warn spam = nobody
32177 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32178
32179 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32180 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32181 spam = nobody:true
32182 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32183 .endd
32184
32185
32186
32187 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32188 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32189 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
32190 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32191 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32192 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32193 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32194 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32195 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32196 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32197 cases.
32198
32199 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32200 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32201 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32202 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32203 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32204 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32205 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32206
32207 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32208 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32209 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32210 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32211 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32212
32213 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32214 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32215 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32216 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32217 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32218 syntax is:
32219 .display
32220 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32221 .endd
32222 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32223 the value can be:
32224
32225 .olist
32226 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32227 .next
32228 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32229 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32230 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32231 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32232 .next
32233 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32234 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32235 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32236 the full path and file name.
32237 .next
32238 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32239 filename, and the default path is then used.
32240 .endlist
32241 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32242 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32243 a file with its original, proposed filename using
32244 .code
32245 decode = $mime_filename
32246 .endd
32247 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32248 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32249 automatically unlinked.
32250
32251 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32252 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32253 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32254 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32255 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32256
32257 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32258 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32259 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32260
32261 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32262 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32263 available in the MIME ACL:
32264
32265 .vlist
32266 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32267 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32268 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32269 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32270 contains the empty string.
32271
32272 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
32273 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32274 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32275 .code
32276 us-ascii
32277 gb2312 (Chinese)
32278 iso-8859-1
32279 .endd
32280 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32281 case-insensitively.
32282
32283 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32284 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32285 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32286 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32287 only used for display purposes.
32288
32289 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32290 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32291 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32292
32293 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32294 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32295 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32296
32297 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32298 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32299 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32300 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32301 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32302
32303 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32304 This variable contains the normalized content of the
32305 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32306 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32307
32308 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32309 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32310 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32311 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32312 .code
32313 text/plain
32314 text/html
32315 application/octet-stream
32316 image/jpeg
32317 audio/midi
32318 .endd
32319 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32320 empty string.
32321
32322 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32323 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32324 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32325 containing the decoded data.
32326 .endlist
32327
32328 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32329 .vlist
32330 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
32331 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32332 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32333 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32334 RFC2047
32335 or RFC2231
32336 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32337 If no filename was
32338 found, this variable contains the empty string.
32339
32340 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32341 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32342 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32343 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32344
32345 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32346 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32347 follows:
32348
32349 .olist
32350 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32351
32352 .next
32353 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32354 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32355
32356 .next
32357 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32358 and the rest are attachments.
32359
32360 .next
32361 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32362 .endlist olist
32363
32364 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32365 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32366 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32367 .code
32368 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32369 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32370 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32371 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32372 .endd
32373 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32374 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32375 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32376 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32377 want to carry out specific actions on them.
32378
32379 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32380 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32381 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32382 decoding is fully recursive.
32383
32384 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32385 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32386 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32387 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32388 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32389 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32390 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32391 .endlist
32392
32393
32394
32395 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32396 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32397 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32398 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32399 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32400
32401 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32402 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32403 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32404 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32405 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32406
32407 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32408 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32409 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32410 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32411 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
32412 32K characters are checked.
32413
32414 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32415 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32416 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32417 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32418 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32419 .code
32420 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32421 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32422 .endd
32423 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32424 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32425 matching regular expression.
32426 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32427 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32428
32429 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32430 CPU-intensive.
32431
32432 .ecindex IIDcosca
32433
32434
32435
32436
32437 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32438 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32439
32440 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32441 "Local scan function"
32442 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32443 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32444 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32445 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32446 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32447
32448 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32449 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32450 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32451 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32452 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32453
32454 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32455 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32456 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32457 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32458
32459 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32460 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32461 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32462 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32463
32464 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32465 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32466 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32467 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32468 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32469 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32470 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32471 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32472 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32473
32474
32475
32476 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32477 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32478 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32479 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32480 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32481 directory, so you might set
32482 .code
32483 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32484 .endd
32485 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32486 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32487 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32488 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32489 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32490 _src/local_scan.c_.
32491
32492 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32493 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32494 .code
32495 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32496 .endd
32497 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32498
32499
32500
32501
32502 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32503 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32504 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32505 .code
32506 #include "local_scan.h"
32507 .endd
32508 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32509 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32510 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32511 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32512 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32513 strings and pointers to character strings:
32514 .code
32515 #define CS (char *)
32516 #define CCS (const char *)
32517 #define CSS (char **)
32518 #define US (unsigned char *)
32519 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32520 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32521 .endd
32522 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32523 .code
32524 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32525 .endd
32526 The arguments are as follows:
32527
32528 .ilist
32529 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32530 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32531 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32532
32533 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32534 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32535 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32536 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32537 case this changes in some future version.
32538 .next
32539 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32540 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32541 .endlist
32542
32543 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32544
32545 .vlist
32546 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32547 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32548 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32549 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32550 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32551 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32552
32553 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32554 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32555 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32556
32557 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32558 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32559 queued without immediate delivery.
32560
32561 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32562 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32563 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32564 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32565 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32566 used.
32567
32568 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32569 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32570 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32571 problem"& is used.
32572
32573 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32574 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32575 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32576 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32577 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32578 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32579 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32580
32581 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32582 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32583 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32584 .endlist
32585
32586 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32587 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32588 &%-oe%& command line options.
32589
32590
32591
32592 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32593 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32594 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32595 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32596 want to do this, you must have the line
32597 .code
32598 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32599 .endd
32600 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32601 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32602 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32603 to define them.
32604
32605 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32606 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32607 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32608 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32609 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32610 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32611 .code
32612 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32613 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32614
32615 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32616 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32617 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32618 };
32619
32620 int local_scan_options_count =
32621 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32622 .endd
32623 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32624 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32625 .code
32626 begin local_scan
32627 my_integer = 99
32628 my_string = some string of text...
32629 .endd
32630 The available types of option data are as follows:
32631
32632 .vlist
32633 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32634 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32635 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32636 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32637 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32638 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32639 values.)
32640
32641 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32642 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32643 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32644 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32645
32646 .vitem &*opt_int*&
32647 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32648 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32649 Exim.
32650
32651 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32652 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32653 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32654 printed with the suffix K or M.
32655
32656 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32657 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32658 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32659 always output in octal.
32660
32661 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32662 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32663 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32664
32665 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32666 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32667 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32668 .endlist
32669
32670 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32671 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32672
32673
32674
32675 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32676 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32677 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32678 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32679 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32680 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32681 C variables are as follows:
32682
32683 .vlist
32684 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32685 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32686 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32687
32688 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32689 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32690 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
32691
32692 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32693 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32694 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32695 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32696
32697 .ilist
32698 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32699 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32700 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32701
32702 .next
32703 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32704 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32705 of debugging bits.
32706 .endlist ilist
32707
32708 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32709 selected, you should use code like this:
32710 .code
32711 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32712 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32713 .endd
32714 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32715 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32716 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32717
32718 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32719 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32720 discussed below.
32721
32722 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32723 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32724
32725 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32726 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32727
32728 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32729 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32730 &%-bh%& command line option.
32731
32732 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32733 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32734 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32735
32736 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32737 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32738 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32739 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32740
32741 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32742 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32743 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32744
32745 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32746 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32747
32748 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32749 The number of accepted recipients.
32750
32751 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32752 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32753 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32754 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32755 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32756 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32757 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32758 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32759 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32760 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32761 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32762 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32763
32764 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32765 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32766
32767 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32768 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32769 locally-submitted messages.
32770
32771 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32772 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32773 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32774
32775 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32776 The name of the sending host, if known.
32777
32778 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32779 The port on the sending host.
32780
32781 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32782 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32783
32784 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32785 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32786
32787 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32788 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32789 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32790 .endlist
32791
32792
32793 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32794 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32795 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32796 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32797 their type to *.
32798
32799
32800 .vlist
32801 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32802 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32803
32804 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32805 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32806 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32807 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32808 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32809 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32810 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32811
32812 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32813 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32814 internal newlines.
32815
32816 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32817 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32818 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32819 .endlist
32820
32821
32822
32823 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32824 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32825
32826 .vlist
32827 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32828 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32829
32830 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32831 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32832 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32833 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32834
32835 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32836 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32837 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32838 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32839 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32840 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32841 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32842 is NULL for all recipients.
32843 .endlist
32844
32845
32846
32847 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32848 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32849 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32850 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32851 release:
32852
32853 .vlist
32854 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32855 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32856
32857 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32858 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32859 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32860 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32861
32862 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32863 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32864 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32865 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32866 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32867
32868 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32869
32870 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32871 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32872 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32873 return value is as follows:
32874
32875 .ilist
32876 >= 0
32877
32878 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32879 ending status.
32880
32881 .next
32882 < 0 and > &--256
32883
32884 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32885 signal number.
32886
32887 .next
32888 &--256
32889
32890 The process timed out.
32891 .next
32892 &--257
32893
32894 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32895 .endlist
32896
32897 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32898 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32899 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32900 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32901 forks a subprocess that is running
32902 .code
32903 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32904 .endd
32905 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32906 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32907 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32908 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32909
32910 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32911 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32912 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32913 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32914
32915
32916 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32917 *sender_authentication)*&
32918 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32919 that it runs is:
32920 .display
32921 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32922 .endd
32923 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32924
32925
32926 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32927 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32928 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32929 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32930 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32931 .code
32932 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32933 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32934 .endd
32935
32936 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32937 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32938 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32939 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32940 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32941 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32942 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32943 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32944
32945 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32946 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32947 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32948 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32949 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32950 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32951
32952 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32953 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32954 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32955 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32956
32957 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32958 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32959 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32960 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32961 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32962 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32963 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32964 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32965 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32966 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32967 .code
32968 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32969 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32970 .endd
32971 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32972 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32973
32974
32975 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32976 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32977 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32978 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32979 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32980
32981
32982 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32983 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32984 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32985 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32986 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32987 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32988 .code
32989 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32990 .endd
32991 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32992 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32993 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32994 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32995 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32996 zero-terminated.
32997
32998 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32999 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33000 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33001 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33002 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33003 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33004 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33005 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33006
33007 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33008 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33009 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33010 .display
33011 &`OK `& match succeeded
33012 &`FAIL `& match failed
33013 &`DEFER `& match deferred
33014 .endd
33015 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33016 inability to contact a database.
33017
33018 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33019 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33020 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33021 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33022 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33023
33024 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33025 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33026 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33027 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33028 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33029
33030 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33031 uschar&~*list)*&"
33032 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33033 expected to be
33034 .code
33035 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33036 .endd
33037 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33038 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33039 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33040 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33041 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33042 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33043 failed.
33044
33045 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33046 *format,&~...)*&"
33047 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33048 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33049 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33050 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33051 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33052 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33053
33054
33055 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33056 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33057 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33058 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33059
33060 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33061 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33062 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33063 value afterwards. For example:
33064 .code
33065 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33066 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33067 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33068 .endd
33069
33070 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33071 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33072 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33073 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33074 address.
33075 .endlist
33076
33077
33078 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33079 .vlist
33080 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33081 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33082 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33083 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33084 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33085 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33086 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33087 binary string is returned with an error message.
33088
33089 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33090 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33091 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33092
33093 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33094 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33095 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33096 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33097 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33098
33099 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33100 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33101 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33102
33103 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33104 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33105 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33106 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33107 with translation.
33108
33109
33110 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33111 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33112 below.
33113
33114 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33115 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33116 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33117 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33118 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33119 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33120 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33121 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33122 is involved.
33123
33124 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33125 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33126
33127 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33128 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33129 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33130 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33131 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33132 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33133 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33134 .code
33135 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33136 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33137 .endd
33138 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33139 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33140 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33141 multiple output lines.
33142
33143 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33144 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33145 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33146 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33147 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33148 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33149 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33150 is an error.
33151
33152 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33153 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33154 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33155 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33156
33157 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33158 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33159 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33160
33161 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33162 See below.
33163
33164 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33165 See below.
33166
33167 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33168 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33169 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33170 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33171 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33172 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33173 more discussion.
33174 .endlist
33175
33176
33177
33178 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33179 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33180 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33181 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33182 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33183 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33184 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33185 terminates.
33186
33187 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33188 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33189 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33190 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33191
33192 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33193 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33194 .code
33195 store_pool = POOL_PERM
33196 .endd
33197 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33198 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33199 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33200 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33201
33202 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33203 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33204 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33205 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33206 &%store_pool%&.
33207 .ecindex IIDlosca
33208
33209
33210
33211
33212 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33214
33215 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33216 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33217 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33218 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33219 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33220 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33221 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33222 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33223
33224 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33225 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33226 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33227 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33228 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33229
33230 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33231 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33232 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33233 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33234 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33235 prevent it happening on retries.
33236
33237 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33238 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33239 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33240 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33241 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33242 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33243 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33244 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33245
33246
33247 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33248 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33249 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33250 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33251 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33252 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33253 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33254 .code
33255 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33256 system_filter_user = exim
33257 .endd
33258 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33259 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33260 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33261 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33262 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33263 by the &%reply%& command.
33264
33265
33266 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33267 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33268 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33269 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33270
33271 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33272 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33273
33274
33275
33276 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33277 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33278 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33279 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33280 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33281 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33282 they cause errors.
33283
33284 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33285 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33286 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33287 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33288 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33289 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33290 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33291
33292 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33293 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33294 succeed, it will not be tried again.
33295 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33296 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33297
33298 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33299 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33300 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33301 to which users' filter files can refer.
33302
33303
33304
33305 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33306 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
33307 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33308 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33309 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33310
33311
33312
33313 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33314 .cindex "freezing messages"
33315 .cindex "message" "freezing"
33316 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
33317 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33318 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33319 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33320 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33321 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33322 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33323 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33324 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33325 .code
33326 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33327 .endd
33328 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33329
33330 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33331 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33332 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33333 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33334 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33335 run.
33336
33337 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33338 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33339 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33340 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33341
33342 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33343 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33344 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33345 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33346 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33347 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33348 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33349 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33350 message. For example:
33351 .code
33352 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33353 because it contains attachments that we are \
33354 not prepared to receive."
33355 .endd
33356
33357 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33358 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33359 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33360 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33361 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33362 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33363 use, for example
33364 .code
33365 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33366 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33367 .endd
33368 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33369 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33370 generated by the filter.
33371
33372 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33373 &%defer%&,
33374 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33375 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33376 as
33377 .code
33378 mail ...
33379 freeze
33380 .endd
33381 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33382 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33383 take place.
33384
33385
33386
33387 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33388 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33389 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33390 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33391 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33392 .code
33393 headers add <string>
33394 headers remove <string>
33395 .endd
33396 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33397 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33398 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33399 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33400 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33401
33402 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33403 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33404 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33405 example:
33406 .code
33407 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33408 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33409 X-header-2: ...."
33410 .endd
33411 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33412 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33413 space after input continuations is ignored.
33414
33415 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33416 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33417 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33418 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33419 header with the same name, they are all removed.
33420
33421 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33422 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33423 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33424 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33425 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33426 used for all recipients of the message.
33427
33428 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33429 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33430 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33431 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33432 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33433 until the message is actually being written (see section
33434 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33435
33436 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33437 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33438 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33439 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33440 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33441 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33442 modified more than once.
33443
33444 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33445 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33446 For example:
33447 .code
33448 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33449 headers remove "Subject"
33450 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33451 headers remove "Old-Subject"
33452 .endd
33453
33454
33455
33456 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33457 .cindex "envelope sender"
33458 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33459 .code
33460 errors_to <some address>
33461 .endd
33462 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33463 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33464 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33465 might use
33466 .code
33467 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33468 .endd
33469 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33470 address if its delivery failed.
33471
33472
33473
33474 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33475 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33476 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33477 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33478 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33479 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33480 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33481 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33482 which implements such a filter:
33483 .code
33484 central_filter:
33485 check_local_user
33486 driver = redirect
33487 domains = +local_domains
33488 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33489 no_verify
33490 allow_filter
33491 allow_freeze
33492 .endd
33493 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33494 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33495 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33496 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33497
33498 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33499 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33500 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33501 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33502 normal way.
33503 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33504 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33505 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33506
33507
33508
33509
33510
33511
33512 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33513 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33514
33515 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33516 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33517 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33518 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33519 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33520 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33521 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33522 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33523
33524 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33525 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33526 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33527 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33528 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33529
33530 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33531 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33532 loopback interface specially in any way.
33533
33534 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33535 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33536
33537
33538
33539
33540 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33541 .cindex "message" "submission"
33542 .cindex "submission mode"
33543 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33544 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33545 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33546 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33547 .code
33548 control = submission
33549 .endd
33550 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33551 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33552 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33553 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33554 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33555 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33556 .code
33557 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33558 control = submission
33559 .endd
33560 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33561 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33562 is used to separate options. For example:
33563 .code
33564 control = submission/sender_retain
33565 .endd
33566 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33567 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33568 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33569 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33570 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33571 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33572 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33573
33574 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33575 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33576 example:
33577 .code
33578 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33579 .endd
33580 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33581 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33582 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33583 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33584 .code
33585 accept authenticated = *
33586 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33587 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33588 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33589 .endd
33590 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33591 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33592 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33593 .code
33594 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33595 .endd
33596 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33597 line would be:
33598 .code
33599 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33600 .endd
33601 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33602 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33603 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33604 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33605
33606 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33607 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33608 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33609 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33610 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33611 spoof another's address.
33612
33613 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33614 .cindex "line endings"
33615 .cindex "carriage return"
33616 .cindex "linefeed"
33617 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33618 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33619 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33620 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33621 use CRLF or just CR.
33622
33623 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33624 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33625 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33626 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33627 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33628 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33629 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33630 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33631 follows:
33632
33633 .ilist
33634 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33635 .next
33636 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33637 is ignored.
33638 .next
33639 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33640 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33641 terminator.
33642 .next
33643 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33644 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33645 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33646 people trying to play silly games.
33647 .next
33648 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33649 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33650 line.
33651 .endlist
33652
33653
33654
33655
33656
33657 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33658 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33659 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33660 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33661 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33662 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33663 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33664 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33665
33666 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33667 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33668 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33669 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33670 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33671
33672 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33673 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33674 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33675 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33676 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33677 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33678 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33679 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33680
33681
33682
33683
33684 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33685 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33686 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33687 .cindex "sender" "address"
33688 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33689 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33690 .cindex "envelope sender"
33691 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33692 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33693 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33694 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33695 .code
33696 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33697 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33698 .endd
33699 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33700 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33701 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33702 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33703 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33704 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33705 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33706 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33707 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33708
33709 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33710 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33711 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33712 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33713 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33714 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33715 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33716
33717 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33718 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33719 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33720
33721 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33722 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33723 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33724 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33725
33726
33727
33728 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33729 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33730 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
33731 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33732 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33733 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33734 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33735 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33736
33737 .blockquote
33738 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33739 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33740 .endblockquote
33741
33742 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33743 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33744 follows:
33745
33746 .ilist
33747 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33748 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33749 .next
33750 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33751 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33752 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33753 .next
33754 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33755 also removed.
33756 .next
33757 For a locally-submitted message,
33758 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33759 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33760 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33761 included in log lines in this case.
33762 .next
33763 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33764 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33765 .endlist
33766
33767
33768
33769
33770 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33771 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33772 includes the header line:
33773 .code
33774 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33775 .endd
33776
33777 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33778 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33779 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33780 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33781 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33782 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33783
33784
33785 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33786 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33787 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
33788 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33789 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33790 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33791
33792 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33793 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33794 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33795 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33796 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33797 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33798 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33799 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33800 messages.
33801
33802
33803 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33804 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33805 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
33806 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33807 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33808 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33809 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33810 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33811 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33812 messages.
33813
33814
33815 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33816 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33817 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
33818 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33819 .cindex "message" "submission"
33820 .cindex "submission mode"
33821 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33822 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33823
33824 .ilist
33825 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33826 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33827 .next
33828 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33829 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33830 .olist
33831 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33832 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33833 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33834 .next
33835 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33836 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33837 .next
33838 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33839 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33840 .endlist
33841 .endlist
33842
33843 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33844
33845 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33846 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33847 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33848 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33849 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33850 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33851 &%qualify_domain%&.
33852
33853 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33854 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33855 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33856 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33857
33858
33859 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33860 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33861 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
33862 .cindex "message" "submission"
33863 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33864 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33865 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33866 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33867 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33868 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33869 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33870 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33871 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33872 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33873
33874
33875 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33876 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33877 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
33878 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33879 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33880 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33881
33882 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33883 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33884 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33885 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33886
33887 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33888 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33889 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33890
33891
33892 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33893 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33894 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
33895 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33896 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33897 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33898 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33899 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33900 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33901 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33902 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33903 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33904
33905
33906
33907 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33908 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33909 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
33910 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33911 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33912 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33913 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33914 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33915 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33916
33917
33918
33919 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33920 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33921 .cindex "message" "submission"
33922 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
33923 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33924 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33925 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33926 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33927 control setting.
33928
33929 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33930 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33931 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33932 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33933 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33934 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33935 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33936 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33937 line is added to the message.
33938
33939 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33940 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33941 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33942 options true at the same time.
33943
33944 .cindex "submission mode"
33945 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33946 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33947 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33948 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33949
33950 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33951 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33952 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33953 created as follows:
33954
33955 .ilist
33956 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33957 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33958 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33959 .next
33960 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33961 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33962 .next
33963 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33964 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33965 .endlist
33966
33967 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33968 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33969 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33970 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33971
33972 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33973 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33974 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33975 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33976
33977
33978
33979 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33980 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33981 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33982 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33983 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33984 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33985 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33986 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33987 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33988
33989 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33990 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33991 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33992 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33993 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33994 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33995
33996 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33997 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33998 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33999
34000 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34001 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34002 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34003 .code
34004 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34005 X-added-second: another added header line
34006 .endd
34007 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34008
34009 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34010 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34011 Each header-line is separately expanded.
34012
34013 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34014 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34015 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34016 not part of the names. For example:
34017 .code
34018 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34019 .endd
34020
34021 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34022 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34023 Each item is separately expanded.
34024 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34025 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34026 will act as list separators.
34027
34028 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34029 items are expanded at routing time,
34030 and then associated with all addresses that are
34031 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34032 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34033 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34034
34035 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
34036 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34037 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34038 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34039
34040 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34041 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34042 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34043 requirements.
34044
34045 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34046 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34047 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34048 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34049 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34050 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34051 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34052
34053 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34054 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34055 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34056 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34057
34058 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34059 the following consequences:
34060
34061 .ilist
34062 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34063 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34064 to it, at all times.
34065 .next
34066 Header lines that are added by a router's
34067 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34068 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34069 .next
34070 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34071 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34072 .next
34073 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34074 a later router or by a transport.
34075 .next
34076 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34077 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34078 .code
34079 headers_remove = subject
34080 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34081 .endd
34082 .endlist
34083
34084 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34085 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34086
34087
34088
34089
34090
34091 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34092 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34093 .cindex "constructed address"
34094 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34095 the form
34096 .display
34097 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34098 .endd
34099 For example:
34100 .code
34101 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34102 .endd
34103 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34104 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34105 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34106 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34107 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34108 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34109 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34110 there is no password file entry.
34111
34112 .cindex "RFC 2047"
34113 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34114 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34115 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34116 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34117 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34118 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34119 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34120 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34121
34122
34123
34124 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34125 .cindex "case of local parts"
34126 .cindex "local part" "case of"
34127 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34128 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34129 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34130 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34131 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34132 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34133 router option.
34134
34135 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
34136 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34137 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34138 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34139 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34140 .code
34141 correct_case:
34142 driver = redirect
34143 domains = +local_domains
34144 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34145 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34146 @$domain
34147 .endd
34148 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34149 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34150 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34151 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34152 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34153
34154
34155
34156 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34157 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
34158 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
34159 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34160 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34161 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34162 empty components for compatibility.
34163
34164
34165
34166 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34167 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34168 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34169 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34170 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34171 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34172
34173 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34174 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34175 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34176 example, a header such as
34177 .code
34178 To: hare@teaparty
34179 .endd
34180 might get rewritten as
34181 .code
34182 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34183 .endd
34184 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34185 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34186 been routed.
34187
34188 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34189 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34190 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34191 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34192 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34193 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34194 .ecindex IIDmesproc
34195
34196
34197
34198 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34199 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34200
34201 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34202 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34203 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34204 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34205 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34206 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34207 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34208
34209 .ilist
34210 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34211 .next
34212 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34213 .next
34214 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34215 .endlist
34216
34217 For mail delivery, the following are available:
34218
34219 .ilist
34220 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34221 .next
34222 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34223 &"lmtp"&);
34224 .next
34225 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34226 transport);
34227 .next
34228 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34229 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34230 .endlist
34231
34232 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34233 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34234 used to contain the envelope information.
34235
34236
34237
34238 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34239 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34240 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34241 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34242 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34243 .cindex "EHLO"
34244 .cindex "HELO"
34245 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34246 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34247 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34248 processing is the same in both cases.
34249
34250 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34251 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34252 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34253 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34254 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34255 .cindex "transport" "filter"
34256 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34257 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34258 suppressed.
34259
34260 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34261 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34262 required for the transaction.
34263
34264 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34265 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34266 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34267 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34268 is called for verification.
34269
34270 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34271 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34272 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34273
34274 .cindex "carriage return"
34275 .cindex "linefeed"
34276 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34277 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34278 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34279 line terminator.
34280
34281 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34282 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34283 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34284 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34285 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34286 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34287 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34288 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34289 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34290
34291 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34292 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34293 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34294 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34295
34296 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34297 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34298 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34299 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34300
34301 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34302 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34303 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34304 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34305 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34306 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34307 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34308 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34309 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34310 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34311
34312 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34313 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34314
34315 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34316 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34317 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34318 square bracket of the IP address.
34319
34320
34321
34322
34323 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34324 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34325 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34326 .cindex "host" "error"
34327 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34328 message errors, and recipient errors.
34329
34330 .vlist
34331 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34332 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34333 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34334
34335 .ilist
34336 Connection refused or timed out,
34337 .next
34338 Any error response code on connection,
34339 .next
34340 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34341 .next
34342 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34343 .next
34344 I/O errors at any time,
34345 .next
34346 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34347 the &"."& at the end of the data.
34348 .endlist ilist
34349
34350 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34351 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34352 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34353 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34354 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34355 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34356 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34357 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34358
34359 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34360 .cindex "message" "error"
34361 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34362 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34363 message errors are:
34364
34365 .ilist
34366 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34367 the data,
34368 .next
34369 Timeout after MAIL,
34370 .next
34371 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34372 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34373 connection at any other time.
34374 .endlist ilist
34375
34376 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34377 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34378 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34379 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34380 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34381 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34382 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34383 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34384 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34385 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34386
34387 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34388 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34389 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34390 response to MAIL.
34391
34392 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34393 .cindex "recipient" "error"
34394 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34395 recipient errors are:
34396
34397 .ilist
34398 Any error response to RCPT,
34399 .next
34400 Timeout after RCPT.
34401 .endlist
34402
34403 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34404 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34405 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34406 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34407 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34408 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34409 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34410 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34411 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34412 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34413 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34414 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34415 the retry clock is reset.
34416
34417 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34418 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34419 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34420 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34421 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34422 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34423 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34424 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34425 recipient's retry time.
34426 .endlist
34427
34428 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34429 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34430 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34431 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34432 until the next delivery attempt.
34433
34434 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34435 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34436 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34437 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34438 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34439 is created.
34440
34441 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34442 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34443 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34444 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34445 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34446 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34447 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34448
34449 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34450 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34451 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34452 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34453 then to be treated as a host error.
34454
34455 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34456 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34457 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34458 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34459 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34460
34461
34462
34463
34464 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34465 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34466 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34467 .cindex "inetd"
34468 .cindex "daemon"
34469 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34470 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34471 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34472 .code
34473 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34474 .endd
34475 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34476 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34477 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34478 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34479 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34480 stream and exits with an error code.
34481
34482 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34483 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34484 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34485 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34486
34487 .cindex "carriage return"
34488 .cindex "linefeed"
34489 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34490 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34491 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34492 line terminator.
34493 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34494 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34495 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34496
34497 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34498 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34499 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34500 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34501 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34502 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34503 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34504 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34505
34506 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34507 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34508 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34509 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34510 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34511 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34512 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34513 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34514 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34515
34516 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34517 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34518 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34519
34520 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34521 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34522 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34523 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34524 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34525
34526 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34527 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34528 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34529 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34530 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34531 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34532 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34533
34534 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34535 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34536 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34537 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34538 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34539
34540 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34541 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34542 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34543 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34544 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34545 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34546 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34547 a delivery process.
34548
34549 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34550 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34551 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34552 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34553 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34554
34555 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34556 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34557 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34558 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34559
34560 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34561 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34562 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34563
34564
34565
34566 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34567 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34568 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34569 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34570 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34571 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34572 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34573 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34574
34575
34576 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34577 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34578 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34579 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34580 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34581 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34582 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34583 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34584 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34585 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34586 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34587
34588
34589
34590 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34591 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34592 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34593 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34594 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34595 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34596 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34597 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34598
34599 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34600 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34601 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34602 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34603 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34604 counted.
34605
34606 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34607 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34608 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34609
34610 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34611 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34612 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34613 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34614 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34615
34616
34617
34618
34619 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34620 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34621 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34622 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34623
34624 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34625 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34626 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34627 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34628 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34629 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34630 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34631 SMTP response codes.
34632
34633 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34634 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34635 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34636 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34637 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34638 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34639 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34640 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34641 RCPT failures.
34642
34643
34644
34645 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34646 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34647 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34648 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34649 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34650 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34651 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34652
34653 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34654 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34655 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34656 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34657 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34658 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34659 argument. For example,
34660 .code
34661 ETRN #brigadoon
34662 .endd
34663 runs the command
34664 .code
34665 exim -R brigadoon
34666 .endd
34667 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34668 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34669 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34670 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34671 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34672
34673 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34674 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34675 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34676 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34677 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34678 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34679 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34680 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34681
34682 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34683 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34684 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34685 whatever the form of its argument. For
34686 example:
34687 .code
34688 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34689 $sender_host_address
34690 .endd
34691 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34692 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34693 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34694 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34695 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34696 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34697 for it to change them before running the command.
34698
34699
34700
34701 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34702 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34703 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34704 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34705 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34706 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34707 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34708 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34709 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34710 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34711 runs for RCPT commands:
34712 .code
34713 accept hosts = :
34714 .endd
34715 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34716
34717
34718
34719 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34720 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34721 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
34722 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34723 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34724 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34725 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34726 envelope along with the message.
34727
34728 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34729 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34730 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34731 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34732 can be used to specify it.
34733
34734 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34735 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34736 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34737 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34738 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34739
34740 .vindex "&$host$&"
34741 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34742 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34743 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34744 router:
34745 .code
34746 begin routers
34747 route_append:
34748 driver = manualroute
34749 transport = smtp_appendfile
34750 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34751
34752 begin transports
34753 smtp_appendfile:
34754 driver = appendfile
34755 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34756 batch_max = 1000
34757 use_bsmtp
34758 user = exim
34759 .endd
34760 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34761 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34762 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34763
34764
34765
34766 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34767 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34768 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34769 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34770 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34771 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34772 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34773 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34774 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34775 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34776
34777 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34778 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34779
34780 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34781 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34782 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34783 make some use of automatically, for example:
34784 .code
34785 554 Unexpected end of file
34786 Transaction started in line 10
34787 Error detected in line 14
34788 .endd
34789 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34790 file, for example:
34791 .code
34792 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34793 The error message was:
34794
34795 501 '>' missing at end of address
34796
34797 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34798 The error was detected in line 12.
34799 The SMTP command at fault was:
34800
34801 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34802
34803 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34804 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34805 .endd
34806 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34807 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34808 accepted.
34809 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34810 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34811
34812
34813
34814 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34815 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34816
34817 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34818 "Customizing messages"
34819 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34820 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34821 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34822 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34823 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34824
34825 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34826 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34827 option. Exim also adds the line
34828 .code
34829 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34830 .endd
34831 to all warning and bounce messages,
34832
34833
34834 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34835 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34836 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34837 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34838 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34839 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34840 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34841
34842 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34843 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34844 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34845 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34846 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34847 item.
34848
34849 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34850 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34851 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34852 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34853 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34854 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34855 option, rounded to a whole number.
34856
34857 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34858
34859 .ilist
34860 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34861 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34862 .next
34863 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34864 failing addresses with their error messages.
34865 .next
34866 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34867 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34868 .next
34869 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34870 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34871 .endlist
34872
34873 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34874 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34875 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34876 .code
34877 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34878 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34879 {: returning message to sender}}
34880 ****
34881 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34882
34883 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34884 {that you sent }{sent by
34885
34886 <$sender_address>
34887
34888 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34889 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34890 ****
34891 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34892 ****
34893 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34894 ------
34895 ****
34896 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34897 only the first
34898 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34899 ****
34900 .endd
34901 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34902 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34903 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34904 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34905 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34906 text sections:
34907
34908 .ilist
34909 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34910 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34911 .next
34912 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34913 the delayed addresses.
34914 .next
34915 The third item then ends the message.
34916 .endlist
34917
34918 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34919 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34920 .code
34921 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34922 $warn_message_delay
34923 ****
34924 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34925
34926 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34927 {that you sent }{sent by
34928
34929 <$sender_address>
34930
34931 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34932 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34933
34934 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34935 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34936 The date of the message is: $h_date
34937
34938 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34939 ****
34940 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34941 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34942 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34943 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34944 the message will be returned to you.
34945 .endd
34946 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34947 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34948 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34949 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34950 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34951 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34952 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34953 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34954 handled them.
34955
34956
34957
34958
34959 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34960 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34961
34962 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34963 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34964 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34965
34966
34967
34968 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34969 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34970 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34971 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34972 routing explicitly:
34973 .code
34974 send_to_smart_host:
34975 driver = manualroute
34976 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34977 transport = remote_smtp
34978 .endd
34979 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34980 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34981 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34982 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34983 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34984
34985
34986
34987
34988 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34989 .cindex "mailing lists"
34990 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34991 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34992 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34993
34994 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34995 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34996 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34997 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34998 .code
34999 lists:
35000 driver = redirect
35001 domains = lists.example
35002 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35003 forbid_pipe
35004 forbid_file
35005 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35006 no_more
35007 .endd
35008 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35009 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35010 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35011 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35012
35013 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35014 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35015 a mailing list.
35016
35017 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35018 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35019 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35020 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35021 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35022
35023 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35024 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35025 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35026 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35027 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35028 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35029 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35030 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35031 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35032
35033
35034
35035 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35036 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35037 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35038 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35039 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35040 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35041 addresses are not rigorously checked.
35042
35043 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35044 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35045 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35046 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35047 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35048
35049
35050
35051 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35052 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35053 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35054 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35055 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35056 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35057 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35058 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35059 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35060 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35061
35062 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35063 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35064 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35065 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35066 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35067 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35068 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35069 pre-existing messages.
35070
35071 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35072 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35073 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35074 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35075 one level of expansion anyway.
35076
35077
35078
35079 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35080 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35081 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35082 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35083 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35084 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35085
35086 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35087 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35088 .code
35089 lists_request:
35090 driver = redirect
35091 domains = lists.example
35092 local_part_suffix = -request
35093 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35094 no_more
35095
35096 lists_post:
35097 driver = redirect
35098 domains = lists.example
35099 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35100 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35101 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35102 forbid_pipe
35103 forbid_file
35104 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35105 no_more
35106
35107 lists_closed:
35108 driver = redirect
35109 domains = lists.example
35110 allow_fail
35111 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35112 .endd
35113 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35114 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35115 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35116 mailing list.
35117
35118 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35119 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35120 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35121 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35122 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35123 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35124 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35125 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35126 &"unrouteable address"& error.
35127
35128 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35129 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35130 the address, giving a suitable error message.
35131
35132
35133
35134
35135 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35136 .cindex "VERP"
35137 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35138 .cindex "envelope sender"
35139 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35140 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35141 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35142 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35143 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35144 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35145
35146 .oindex &%errors_to%&
35147 .oindex &%return_path%&
35148 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35149 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35150 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35151 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35152 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35153 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35154 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35155 .code
35156 verp_smtp:
35157 driver = smtp
35158 max_rcpt = 1
35159 return_path = \
35160 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35161 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35162 .endd
35163 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35164 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35165 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35166 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35167 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35168 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35169 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35170 rewritten as
35171 .code
35172 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35173 .endd
35174 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35175 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35176 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35177 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35178 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35179 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35180
35181 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35182 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35183 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35184 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35185 .code
35186 dnslookup:
35187 driver = dnslookup
35188 domains = ! +local_domains
35189 transport = \
35190 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35191 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35192 no_more
35193 .endd
35194 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35195 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35196 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35197 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35198 address.
35199
35200 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35201 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35202 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35203 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35204 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35205 .code
35206 verp_dnslookup:
35207 driver = dnslookup
35208 domains = ! +local_domains
35209 transport = remote_smtp
35210 errors_to = \
35211 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35212 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35213 no_more
35214 .endd
35215 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35216 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35217 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35218 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35219 them.
35220
35221 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35222 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35223 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35224 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35225 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35226 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35227 used).
35228
35229
35230
35231
35232
35233
35234 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35235 .cindex "virtual domains"
35236 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
35237 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35238 meanings:
35239
35240 .ilist
35241 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35242 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35243 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35244 .next
35245 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35246 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35247 have login accounts on that host.
35248 .endlist
35249
35250 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35251 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35252 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35253 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35254 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35255 to a router of this form:
35256 .code
35257 virtual:
35258 driver = redirect
35259 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35260 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35261 no_more
35262 .endd
35263 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35264 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35265 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35266 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35267 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35268 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35269
35270 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35271 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35272 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35273 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35274
35275 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35276 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35277 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35278 .code
35279 my_domains:
35280 driver = accept
35281 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35282 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35283 transport = my_mailboxes
35284 .endd
35285 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35286 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35287 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35288 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35289 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35290 follows:
35291 .code
35292 my_mailboxes:
35293 driver = appendfile
35294 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35295 user = mail
35296 .endd
35297 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35298 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35299
35300 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35301 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35302 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35303 information about the domains.
35304
35305
35306
35307 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35308 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35309 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35310 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
35311 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
35312 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35313 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35314 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35315 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35316 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35317 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35318 example, consider this router:
35319 .code
35320 userforward:
35321 driver = redirect
35322 check_local_user
35323 file = $home/.forward
35324 local_part_suffix = -*
35325 local_part_suffix_optional
35326 allow_filter
35327 .endd
35328 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35329 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35330 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35331 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35332 .code
35333 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35334 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35335 endif
35336 .endd
35337 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35338 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35339 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35340 control over which suffixes are valid.
35341
35342 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35343 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35344 another MTA:
35345 .code
35346 userforward:
35347 driver = redirect
35348 check_local_user
35349 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35350 local_part_suffix = -*
35351 local_part_suffix_optional
35352 allow_filter
35353 .endd
35354 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35355 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35356 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35357 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35358 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35359
35360
35361
35362 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35363 .cindex "vacation processing"
35364 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35365 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35366 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35367 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35368 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35369
35370 .ilist
35371 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35372 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35373 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35374 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35375 .code
35376 spqr, vacation-spqr
35377 .endd
35378 .next
35379 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35380 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35381 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35382 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35383 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35384 message.
35385 .endlist
35386
35387 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35388 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35389
35390
35391
35392 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35393 .cindex "message" "copying every"
35394 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35395 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35396 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35397 each day's messages.
35398
35399 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35400 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35401 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35402 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35403
35404
35405
35406 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35407 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35408 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35409 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35410 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35411 permanently connected.
35412
35413 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35414 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35415 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35416
35417
35418 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35419 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35420 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35421 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35422 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35423 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35424 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35425 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35426
35427 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35428 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35429 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35430 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35431 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35432 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35433 if required.
35434
35435 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35436 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35437 intermittent host. For example:
35438 .code
35439 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35440 .endd
35441 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35442 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35443 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35444 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35445 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35446 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35447 immediately.
35448
35449 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35450 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35451 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35452 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35453 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35454 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35455 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35456
35457
35458
35459 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35460 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35461 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35462 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35463 delivered immediately.
35464
35465 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35466 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35467 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35468 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35469 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35470 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35471 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35472 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35473 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35474 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35475 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35476 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35477 single SMTP connection.
35478
35479
35480
35481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35482 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35483
35484 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35485 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35486 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
35487 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35488 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35489 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35490 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35491 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35492 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35493 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35494 messages this way.
35495
35496 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35497 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35498 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35499 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35500 email is not desirable.
35501
35502 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35503 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35504 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35505 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35506 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35507 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35508 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35509
35510 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35511 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35512 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35513 before sending a message to the smart host.
35514
35515 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35516 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35517 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35518
35519 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35520 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35521 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35522 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35523 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35524 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35525 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35526
35527 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35528 following ways:
35529
35530 .ilist
35531 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35532 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35533 .next
35534 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35535 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35536 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35537 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35538 successful, a zero return code is given.
35539 .next
35540 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35541 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35542 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35543 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35544 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35545 are.
35546 .next
35547 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35548 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35549 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35550 .next
35551 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35552 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35553 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35554 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35555 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35556 .next
35557 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35558 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35559 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35560 .next
35561 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35562 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35563 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35564 are ever generated.
35565 .next
35566 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35567 .next
35568 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35569 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35570 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35571 .endlist
35572
35573 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35574 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35575 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35576 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35577 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35578 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35579
35580
35581
35582
35583 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35584 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35585
35586 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35587 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35588 .cindex "log" "types of"
35589 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35590 and the panic log:
35591
35592 .ilist
35593 .cindex "main log"
35594 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35595 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35596 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35597 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35598 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35599 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35600 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35601 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35602 .next
35603 .cindex "reject log"
35604 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35605 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35606 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35607 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35608 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35609 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35610 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35611 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35612 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35613 false.
35614 .next
35615 .cindex "panic log"
35616 .cindex "system log"
35617 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35618 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35619 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35620 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35621 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35622 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35623 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35624 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35625 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35626 .endlist
35627
35628 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35629 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35630 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35631 .code
35632 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35633 by QUIT
35634 .endd
35635 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35636 ways of changing this:
35637
35638 .ilist
35639 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35640 you set
35641 .code
35642 timezone = UTC
35643 .endd
35644 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35645 .next
35646 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35647 example:
35648 .code
35649 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35650 .endd
35651 .endlist
35652
35653 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35654 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35655 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35656 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35657 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35658 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35659
35660
35661
35662
35663 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35664 .cindex "log" "destination"
35665 .cindex "log" "to file"
35666 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35667 .cindex "syslog"
35668 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35669 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35670 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35671 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35672 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35673 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35674 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35675
35676 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35677 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35678 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35679 references to the host name:
35680 .code
35681 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35682 .endd
35683 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35684 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35685 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35686 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35687 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35688 log at all.
35689
35690 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35691 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35692 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35693 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35694 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35695 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35696 implying the use of a default path.
35697
35698 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35699 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35700 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35701 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35702 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35703 equivalent to the setting:
35704 .code
35705 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35706 .endd
35707 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35708 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35709 that is where the logs are written.
35710
35711 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35712 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35713
35714 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35715 .display
35716 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35717 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35718 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35719 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35720 .endd
35721 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35722 error is logged.
35723
35724
35725
35726 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35727 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35728 .cindex "cycling logs"
35729 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35730 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35731 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35732 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35733 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35734 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35735 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35736
35737 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35738 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35739 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35740 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35741 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35742 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35743 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35744 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35745 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35746 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35747 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35748 renamed.
35749
35750
35751
35752 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35753 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35754 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35755 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35756 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35757 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35758 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35759 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35760 .code
35761 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35762 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35763 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35764 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35765 .endd
35766 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35767 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35768 .code
35769 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35770 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35771 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35772 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35773 .endd
35774 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35775 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35776 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35777 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35778
35779 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35780 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35781 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35782 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35783 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35784 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35785 log names:
35786 .code
35787 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35788 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35789 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35790 /var/log/exim/panic
35791 .endd
35792
35793
35794 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35795 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35796 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35797 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35798 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35799 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35800 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35801 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35802 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35803 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35804 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35805 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35806 the time and host name to each line.
35807 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35808
35809 .ilist
35810 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35811 .next
35812 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35813 .next
35814 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35815 .endlist
35816
35817 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35818 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35819 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35820 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35821
35822 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35823 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35824 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35825 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35826 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35827 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35828 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35829 RFC 3164, you should set
35830 .code
35831 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35832 .endd
35833 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35834 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35835
35836 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35837 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35838 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35839 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35840 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35841 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35842 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35843 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35844 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35845 .code
35846 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35847 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35848 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35849 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35850 [5/5] mple>)
35851 .endd
35852 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35853 (LOG_NOTICE):
35854 .code
35855 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35856 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35857 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35858 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35859 [5\18] .example>)
35860 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35861 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35862 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35863 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35864 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35865 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35866 [12\18] F From: <>
35867 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35868 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35869 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35870 [16\18] le>
35871 [17\18] B Bcc:
35872 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35873 .endd
35874 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35875 without modification.
35876
35877 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35878 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35879 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35880 where it is.
35881
35882
35883
35884 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35885 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35886 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35887 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35888 timestamp. The flags are:
35889 .display
35890 &`<=`& message arrival
35891 &`(=`& message fakereject
35892 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35893 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35894 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35895 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35896 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35897 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35898 .endd
35899
35900
35901 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35902 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35903 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35904 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35905 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35906 .code
35907 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35908 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35909 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35910 .endd
35911 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35912 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35913 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35914 .code
35915 R=<message id>
35916 .endd
35917 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35918
35919 .cindex "HELO"
35920 .cindex "EHLO"
35921 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35922 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35923 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35924 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35925 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35926 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35927 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35928 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35929 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35930 name in parentheses.
35931
35932 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35933 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35934 the log containing text like these examples:
35935 .code
35936 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35937 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35938 .endd
35939 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35940 on.
35941
35942 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35943 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35944 of Exim.
35945
35946 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35947 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35948 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35949 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35950 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35951 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35952 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35953 suite that was used.
35954
35955 .cindex log protocol
35956 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35957 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35958 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35959 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35960 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35961 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35962 authenticator name.
35963
35964 .cindex "size" "of message"
35965 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35966 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35967 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35968 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35969 other).
35970
35971 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35972 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35973
35974
35975
35976 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35977 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35978 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35979 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35980 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
35981 to fit it on the page:
35982 .code
35983 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35984 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35985 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35986 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35987 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35988 .endd
35989 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35990 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35991 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35992 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35993 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35994
35995 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35996 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35997 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35998 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35999
36000 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36001 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36002 .display
36003 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36004 .endd
36005 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36006 parentheses afterwards.
36007
36008 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36009 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36010 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36011 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36012 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36013 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36014 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36015 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36016 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36017 TLS cipher information is still available.
36018
36019 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36020 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36021 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36022 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36023 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36024
36025 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36026 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36027
36028 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36029 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36030
36031
36032 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36033 .cindex "discarded messages"
36034 .cindex "message" "discarded"
36035 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36036 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36037 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36038 .code
36039 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36040 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36041 .endd
36042 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36043 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36044 .code
36045 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36046 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36047 .endd
36048
36049
36050 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36051 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36052 .code
36053 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36054 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36055 .endd
36056 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36057 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36058 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36059 .code
36060 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36061 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36062 .endd
36063 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36064 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36065 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36066
36067
36068
36069 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36070 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36071 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36072 following form is logged:
36073 .code
36074 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36075 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36076 .endd
36077 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36078 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36079 .code
36080 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36081 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36082 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36083 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36084 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36085 .endd
36086 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36087 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36088 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36089 flagged with &`**`&.
36090
36091
36092
36093 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36094 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36095 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36096 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36097 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36098
36099
36100
36101 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36102 A line of the form
36103 .code
36104 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36105 .endd
36106 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36107 at the end of its processing.
36108
36109
36110
36111
36112 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36113 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36114 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36115 the following table:
36116 .display
36117 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36118 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36119 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36120 &`CV `& certificate verification status
36121 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36122 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
36123 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36124 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36125 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36126 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36127 &`H `& host name and IP address
36128 &`I `& local interface used
36129 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36130 &`id `& message id for incoming message
36131 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36132 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36133 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36134 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36135 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36136 &`Q `& alternate queue name
36137 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36138 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36139 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36140 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36141 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
36142 &`S `& size of message in bytes
36143 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36144 &`ST `& shadow transport name
36145 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36146 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36147 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36148 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36149 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
36150 .endd
36151
36152
36153 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36154 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36155 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36156
36157 .ilist
36158 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36159 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36160 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36161 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36162 during the first delivery attempt.
36163 .next
36164 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36165 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36166 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36167 .next
36168 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36169 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36170 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36171 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36172 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36173 doing.
36174 .next
36175 .cindex "error" "ignored"
36176 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36177 message:
36178 .olist
36179 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36180 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36181 .next
36182 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36183 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36184 .next
36185 A delivery set up by a router configured with
36186 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36187 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36188 .code
36189 errors_to = <>
36190 .endd
36191 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36192 .endlist olist
36193 .next
36194 .new
36195 .cindex DKIM "log line"
36196 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
36197 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
36198 .wen
36199 .endlist ilist
36200
36201
36202
36203
36204
36205 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36206 .cindex "log" "selectors"
36207 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36208 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36209 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36210 example:
36211 .code
36212 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36213 .endd
36214 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36215 selection marked by asterisks:
36216 .display
36217 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36218 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36219 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36220 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36221 &` arguments `& command line arguments
36222 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36223 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36224 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36225 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36226 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
36227 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
36228 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36229 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36230 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36231 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36232 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36233 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36234 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36235 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36236 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
36237 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36238 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36239 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36240 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36241 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36242 &` pid `& Exim process id
36243 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36244 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36245 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36246 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36247 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36248 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36249 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36250 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36251 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36252 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36253 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36254 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36255 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36256 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36257 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36258 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36259 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36260 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36261 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36262 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36263 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36264 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36265 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36266
36267 &` all `& all of the above
36268 .endd
36269 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36270 section &<<SECID99>>&
36271
36272 More details on each of these items follows:
36273
36274 .ilist
36275 .cindex "8BITMIME"
36276 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36277 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36278 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36279 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36280 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36281 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36282 .next
36283 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36284 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36285 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36286 this log selector is set.
36287 .next
36288 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
36289 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36290 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36291 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36292 such users cannot access the log).
36293 .next
36294 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
36295 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36296 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36297 parentheses between them.
36298 .next
36299 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36300 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36301 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36302 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36303 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36304 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36305 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36306 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36307 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36308 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36309 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36310 between the caller and Exim.
36311 .next
36312 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36313 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36314 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36315 .next
36316 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36317 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36318 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36319 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36320 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36321 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36322 .next
36323 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36324 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36325 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36326 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36327 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
36328 .next
36329 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36330 .cindex "size" "of message"
36331 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36332 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36333 .next
36334 .new
36335 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36336 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36337 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signture in the header
36338 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
36339 .next
36340 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36341 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36342 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
36343 .wen
36344 .next
36345 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36346 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36347 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
36348 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36349 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36350 .next
36351 .cindex log dnssec
36352 .cindex dnssec logging
36353 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36354 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36355 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36356 It does not cover helo-name verification.
36357 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36358 .next
36359 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36360 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36361 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36362 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36363 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36364 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36365 .next
36366 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36367 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36368 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36369 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36370 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36371 .next
36372 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36373 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36374 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36375 client's ident port times out.
36376 .next
36377 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36378 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36379 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36380 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36381 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36382 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36383 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36384 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36385 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36386 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36387 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36388 .next
36389 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36390 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36391 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36392 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36393 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36394 on a proxied connection
36395 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36396 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36397 .next
36398 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36399 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
36400 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36401 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36402 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36403 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36404 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36405 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36406 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36407 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36408 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36409 .next
36410 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36411 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36412 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36413 .next
36414 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36415 .cindex millisecond logging
36416 .cindex timstamps "millisecond, in logs"
36417 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36418 appended to the seconds value.
36419 .next
36420 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36421 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36422 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36423 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36424 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36425 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36426 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36427 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36428 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36429 .next
36430 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36431 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
36432 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36433 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36434 containing => tags) following the IP address.
36435 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36436 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36437 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36438 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36439 local port is a random ephemeral port.
36440 .next
36441 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36442 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36443 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36444 immediately after the time and date.
36445 .next
36446 .cindex "log" "queue run"
36447 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36448 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36449 .next
36450 .cindex "log" "queue time"
36451 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36452 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36453 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36454 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36455 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36456 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36457 message has been successfully received.
36458 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36459 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
36460 .next
36461 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36462 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36463 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36464 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36465 .new
36466 .next
36467 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
36468 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
36469 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
36470 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36471 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
36472 .wen
36473 .next
36474 .cindex "log" "recipients"
36475 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36476 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36477 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36478 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36479 has taken place.
36480 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36481 in the list.
36482 .next
36483 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
36484 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36485 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36486 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36487 .next
36488 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36489 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36490 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36491 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36492 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36493 .next
36494 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
36495 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36496 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36497 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36498 attempt.
36499 .next
36500 .cindex "log" "return path"
36501 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36502 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36503 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36504 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36505 .next
36506 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36507 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36508 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36509 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36510 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36511 .next
36512 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36513 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36514 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36515 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36516 detail is lost.
36517 .next
36518 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
36519 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36520 it is too big.
36521 .next
36522 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36523 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36524 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36525 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36526 it.
36527 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36528 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36529 .next
36530 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36531 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36532 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36533 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36534 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36535 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36536 response.
36537 .next
36538 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36539 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36540 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36541 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36542 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36543 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36544 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36545 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36546 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36547 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36548
36549 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36550 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36551 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36552 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36553 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36554 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36555 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36556 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36557 .next
36558 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36559 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36560 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36561 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36562 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36563 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36564 .next
36565 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36566 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36567 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36568 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36569 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36570 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36571 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36572 already have their own log lines.
36573
36574 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36575 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36576 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36577 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36578 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36579 the same logging options.
36580
36581 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36582 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36583 .code
36584 C=EHLO,QUIT
36585 .endd
36586 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36587 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36588 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36589 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36590 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36591 .next
36592 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36593 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36594 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36595 was accepted or used.
36596 .next
36597 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36598 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36599 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36600 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36601 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36602 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36603 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36604 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36605 .next
36606 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36607 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36608 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36609 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36610 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36611 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36612 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36613 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36614 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36615 .next
36616 .cindex "log" "subject"
36617 .cindex "subject, logging"
36618 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36619 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36620 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36621 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36622 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36623 .next
36624 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36625 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36626 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36627 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
36628 .next
36629 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36630 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36631 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36632 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36633 .next
36634 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36635 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36636 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36637 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36638 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36639 .next
36640 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36641 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36642 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36643 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36644 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36645 .next
36646 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36647 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36648 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36649 .endlist
36650
36651
36652 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36653 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36654 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36655 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36656 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36657 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36658 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36659 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36660 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36661 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36662 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36663 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36664 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36665
36666 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36667 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36668 &%message_logs%& option false.
36669 .ecindex IIDloggen
36670
36671
36672
36673
36674 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36676
36677 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36678 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36679 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36680 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36681 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36682
36683 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36684 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36685 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36686 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36687 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36688 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36689 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36690 various criteria"
36691 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36692 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36693 "extract statistics from the log"
36694 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36695 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36696 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36697 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36698 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36699 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36700 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36701 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36702 .endtable
36703
36704 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36705 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36706 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36707
36708
36709
36710
36711 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36712 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36713 .cindex "process, querying"
36714 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
36715 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36716 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36717 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36718 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36719 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36720 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36721 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36722 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36723
36724 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36725 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36726 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36727
36728
36729 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36730 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36731 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36732 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36733 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36734 options:
36735 .display
36736 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36737 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36738 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36739 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36740 .endd
36741 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36742 .code
36743 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
36744 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
36745 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36746 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
36747 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
36748 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36749 .endd
36750 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36751 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36752
36753
36754
36755 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36756 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36757 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
36758 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36759 .code
36760 exim -bpu
36761 .endd
36762 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36763 .code
36764 exim -bp
36765 .endd
36766 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36767 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36768
36769 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
36770 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
36771
36772 .vlist
36773 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
36774 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36775 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
36776 .code
36777 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
36778 .endd
36779 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
36780 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36781 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
36782
36783 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
36784 Match against the size field.
36785
36786 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36787 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
36788
36789 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36790 Match messages that are older than the given time.
36791
36792 .vitem &*-z*&
36793 Match only frozen messages.
36794
36795 .vitem &*-x*&
36796 Match only non-frozen messages.
36797 .endlist
36798
36799 The following options control the format of the output:
36800
36801 .vlist
36802 .vitem &*-c*&
36803 Display only the count of matching messages.
36804
36805 .vitem &*-l*&
36806 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
36807 the default.
36808
36809 .vitem &*-i*&
36810 Display message ids only.
36811
36812 .vitem &*-b*&
36813 Brief format &-- one line per message.
36814
36815 .vitem &*-R*&
36816 Display messages in reverse order.
36817
36818 .vitem &*-a*&
36819 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
36820 .endlist
36821
36822 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
36823
36824
36825
36826 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
36827 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
36828 .cindex "queue" "summary"
36829 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
36830 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
36831 running a command such as
36832 .code
36833 exim -bp | exiqsumm
36834 .endd
36835 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
36836 it, as in the following example:
36837 .code
36838 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
36839 .endd
36840 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
36841 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
36842 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
36843 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
36844
36845 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36846 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36847 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36848 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36849 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36850 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36851 sender.
36852
36853 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36854 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36855 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36856 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36857 level"& addresses).
36858
36859
36860
36861
36862 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36863 "SECTextspeinf"
36864 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36865 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36866 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36867 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36868 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36869 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36870 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36871 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36872 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36873 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36874 .display
36875 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36876 .endd
36877 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36878
36879 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36880 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36881 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36882
36883 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36884 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36885 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36886 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36887 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36888
36889 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36890 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36891 regular expression.
36892
36893 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36894 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36895
36896 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36897 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36898 normally.
36899
36900 Example of &%-M%&:
36901 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36902 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36903 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36904 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36905 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36906 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36907 search term.
36908
36909 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36910 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36911 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36912 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36913 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36914
36915
36916 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36917 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36918 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36919 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36920 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
36921 the &%--help%& option.
36922
36923
36924 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36925 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36926 .cindex "cycling logs"
36927 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36928 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36929 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36930 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36931 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36932 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36933 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36934 .ilist
36935 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36936 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36937 .next
36938 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36939 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36940 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36941 configuration.
36942 .endlist
36943
36944 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36945 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36946 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36947 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36948 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36949 logs are handled similarly.
36950
36951 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36952 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36953 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36954 any existing log files.
36955
36956 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36957 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36958 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36959 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36960 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36961 .code
36962 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36963 .endd
36964 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36965 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36966
36967
36968
36969 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36970 .cindex "statistics"
36971 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36972 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36973 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36974 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36975 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36976
36977 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36978 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36979 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36980 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36981 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36982 .code
36983 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36984 .endd
36985 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36986 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36987 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36988 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36989 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36990 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36991 also produced per user.
36992
36993 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36994 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36995 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36996 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36997 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36998
36999 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37000 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37001 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37002 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37003 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37004 an entirely separate message.
37005
37006 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37007 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37008 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37009 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37010 least one address that failed.
37011
37012 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37013 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37014 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37015 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
37016 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37017 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37018 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37019
37020 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37021 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37022 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37023
37024 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37025 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37026 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37027 .code
37028 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37029 .endd
37030
37031 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37032 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37033 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37034 .cindex "checking access"
37035 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37036 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37037 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37038 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37039 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37040 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37041
37042 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37043 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37044 .code
37045 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37046 .endd
37047 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37048 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37049 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37050 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37051 .code
37052 Rejected:
37053 550 Relay not permitted
37054 .endd
37055 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37056 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37057 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37058 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37059 you can use:
37060 .code
37061 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37062 -f himself@there.example
37063 .endd
37064 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37065 mandatory arguments.
37066
37067 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37068 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37069 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37070
37071
37072
37073 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37074 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37075 .cindex "building DBM files"
37076 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37077 .cindex "lower casing"
37078 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37079 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37080 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37081 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37082 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37083 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37084
37085 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37086 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37087 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37088 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37089 files.
37090
37091 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37092 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
37093 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
37094 well.
37095
37096 .cindex "USE_DB"
37097 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
37098 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
37099 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
37100 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
37101 .code
37102 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
37103 .endd
37104 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
37105 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
37106
37107 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
37108 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
37109 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
37110 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
37111 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37112 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
37113
37114 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
37115 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
37116 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
37117 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
37118 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
37119 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
37120 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
37121 return code is 2.
37122
37123
37124
37125
37126 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37127 .cindex "retry" "times"
37128 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
37129 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37130 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37131 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37132 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37133 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37134 output. For example:
37135 .code
37136 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37137 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37138 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37139 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37140 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37141 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37142 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37143 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37144 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37145 past final cutoff time
37146 .endd
37147 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37148 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37149 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37150 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37151 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37152 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37153 run very often.
37154
37155 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37156 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37157 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37158 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37159 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37160 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37161
37162
37163
37164 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37165 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37166 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37167 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37168 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37169 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37170 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37171
37172 .ilist
37173 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
37174 .next
37175 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37176 for remote hosts
37177 .next
37178 &'callout'&: the callout cache
37179 .next
37180 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37181 .next
37182 &'misc'&: other hints data
37183 .endlist
37184
37185 The &'misc'& database is used for
37186
37187 .ilist
37188 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37189 .next
37190 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37191 &(smtp)& transport)
37192 .next
37193 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37194 in a transport)
37195 .endlist
37196
37197
37198
37199 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37200 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37201 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37202 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37203 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37204 .code
37205 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37206 .endd
37207 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37208 .code
37209 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
37210 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37211 .endd
37212 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37213 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37214 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37215 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37216 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37217 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37218 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37219 and a textual description of the error.
37220
37221 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37222 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37223 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37224 exceeded.
37225
37226 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37227 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37228 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37229 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37230 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37231 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37232 cross-references.
37233
37234
37235
37236 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37237 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37238 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37239 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37240 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37241 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37242 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37243 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37244 updated sufficiently often.
37245
37246 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37247 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37248 the retry database:
37249 .code
37250 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37251 .endd
37252 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37253 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37254 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37255 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37256 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37257 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37258 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37259 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37260 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37261 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37262 whenever it removes information from the database.
37263
37264 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37265 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37266 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37267 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37268 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37269
37270 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37271 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37272 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37273 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37274 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37275 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37276 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37277 tidied.
37278
37279 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37280 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37281
37282
37283
37284
37285 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37286 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37287 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37288 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37289 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37290 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37291 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37292 displayed.
37293
37294 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37295 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37296 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37297 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37298 by new data, for example:
37299 .code
37300 > 4 951102:1000
37301 .endd
37302 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37303 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37304 used as optional separators.
37305
37306
37307
37308
37309 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37310 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37311 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37312 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
37313 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37314 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37315 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37316 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37317 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37318 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37319 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37320 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37321 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37322
37323 .vlist
37324 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
37325 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37326
37327 .vitem &%-flock%&
37328 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37329 supports it.
37330
37331 .vitem &%-interval%&
37332 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37333 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37334
37335 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
37336 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37337
37338 .vitem &%-mbx%&
37339 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37340
37341 .vitem &%-q%&
37342 Suppress verification output.
37343
37344 .vitem &%-retries%&
37345 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37346 the lock (default 10).
37347
37348 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
37349 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37350 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37351 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37352 subsequently sees.
37353
37354 .vitem &%-timeout%&
37355 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37356 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37357 default), a non-blocking call is used.
37358
37359 .vitem &%-v%&
37360 Generate verbose output.
37361 .endlist
37362
37363 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37364 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37365 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37366 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37367 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37368 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37369 more than 30 minutes old.
37370
37371 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37372 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37373 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37374 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37375 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37376 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37377
37378 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37379 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37380 suppresses all output except error messages.
37381
37382 A command such as
37383 .code
37384 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37385 .endd
37386 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37387 .display
37388 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37389 <&'some commands'&>
37390 &`End`&
37391 .endd
37392 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37393 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37394 such as
37395 .code
37396 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37397 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37398 .endd
37399 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37400 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37401 .ecindex IIDutils
37402
37403
37404 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37405 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37406
37407 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37408 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37409 .cindex "X-windows"
37410 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
37411 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37412 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37413 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37414 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37415 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37416 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37417 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37418
37419
37420
37421 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37422 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37423 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37424 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37425 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37426 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37427 parameters are for.
37428
37429 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37430 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37431 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37432 .code
37433 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37434 .endd
37435 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37436 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37437 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37438 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37439 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37440
37441 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37442 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37443 .code
37444 Eximon*background: gray94
37445 .endd
37446 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37447 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37448 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37449 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37450 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37451 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37452 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37453 .code
37454 xrdb -merge <<End
37455 Eximon*highlight: gray
37456 End
37457 .endd
37458 .cindex "admin user"
37459 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37460 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37461
37462 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37463 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37464 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37465 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37466 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37467
37468 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37469 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37470 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37471 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37472 different parts of the display.
37473
37474
37475
37476
37477 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37478 .cindex "stripchart"
37479 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37480 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37481 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37482 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37483 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37484 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37485 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37486 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37487 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37488
37489 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37490 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37491 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37492 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37493
37494 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37495 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37496 to a single partition.
37497
37498 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37499 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37500 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37501 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37502 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37503 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37504 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37505
37506
37507
37508
37509 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37510 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37511 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37512 .cindex "window size"
37513 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37514 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37515 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37516 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37517 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37518 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37519
37520 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37521 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37522 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37523 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37524
37525 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37526 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37527 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37528 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37529 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37530 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37531
37532 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37533 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37534 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37535
37536
37537
37538 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37539 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37540 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37541 the main log is maintained.
37542 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37543 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37544 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37545 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37546 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37547
37548 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37549 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37550 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37551 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37552 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37553 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37554 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37555 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37556 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37557 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37558 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37559
37560 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37561 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37562 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37563 It cannot go further back up the log.
37564
37565 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37566 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37567 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37568 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37569 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37570 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37571
37572 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37573 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37574 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37575 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37576 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37577 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37578
37579 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37580 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37581 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37582 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37583 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37584 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37585 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37586 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37587 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37588 window.
37589
37590
37591
37592 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37593 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37594 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37595 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37596 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37597 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37598 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37599 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37600 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37601 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37602
37603 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37604 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37605 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37606 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37607 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37608 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37609 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37610
37611 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37612 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37613 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37614 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37615 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37616 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37617 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37618
37619 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37620 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37621 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37622 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37623
37624 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37625 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37626 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37627 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37628 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37629 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37630 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37631 not shown.
37632
37633 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37634 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37635
37636 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37637 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37638 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37639 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37640 display is updated.
37641
37642
37643
37644 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37645 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37646 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37647 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37648 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37649 any selected text.
37650
37651 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37652 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37653 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37654 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37655 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37656 .code
37657 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37658 .endd
37659 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37660 follows:
37661
37662 .ilist
37663 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37664 in a new text window.
37665 .next
37666 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37667 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37668 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37669 .next
37670 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37671 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37672 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37673 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37674 .next
37675 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37676 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37677 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37678 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37679 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37680 .next
37681 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37682 that the message be frozen.
37683 .next
37684 .cindex "thawing messages"
37685 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37686 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37687 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37688 that the message be thawed.
37689 .next
37690 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37691 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37692 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37693 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37694 .next
37695 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37696 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37697 message.
37698 .next
37699 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37700 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37701 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37702 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37703 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37704 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37705 which case no action is taken.
37706 .next
37707 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37708 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37709 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37710 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37711 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37712 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37713 case no action is taken.
37714 .next
37715 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37716 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37717 .next
37718 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37719 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37720 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37721 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37722 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37723 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37724 the address is qualified with that domain.
37725 .endlist
37726
37727 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37728 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37729 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37730 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37731 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37732 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37733 if no output is generated.
37734
37735 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37736 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37737 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37738 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37739
37740 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37741 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37742 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37743 .ecindex IIDeximon
37744
37745
37746
37747
37748
37749 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37750 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37751
37752 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37753 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37754 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37755 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37756
37757 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37758 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37759 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37760 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37761 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37762 its security as compared with other MTAs.
37763
37764 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37765 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37766 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37767 as soon as possible.
37768
37769
37770 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
37771 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
37772 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
37773 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
37774 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
37775 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
37776
37777 .ilist
37778 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
37779 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
37780 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
37781 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
37782 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
37783 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
37784
37785 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
37786 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
37787 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
37788 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
37789 .next
37790
37791 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
37792 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
37793 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
37794 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
37795 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
37796 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
37797 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
37798 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
37799 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
37800 separate commands.
37801
37802 .next
37803 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
37804 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
37805 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
37806 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
37807 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
37808 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
37809 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
37810 .next
37811 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
37812 is disabled.
37813 .next
37814 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
37815 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
37816 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
37817 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
37818 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
37819 .endlist
37820
37821
37822
37823 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
37824 .cindex "setuid"
37825 .cindex "root privilege"
37826 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
37827 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
37828 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
37829 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
37830 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
37831 is required for two things:
37832
37833 .ilist
37834 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
37835 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
37836 not required.
37837 .next
37838 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
37839 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
37840 configuration.
37841 .endlist
37842
37843 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
37844 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37845 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37846 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37847 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37848 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37849 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37850 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37851
37852 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37853 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37854 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37855
37856 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37857 uid and gid in the following cases:
37858
37859 .ilist
37860 .oindex "&%-C%&"
37861 .oindex "&%-D%&"
37862 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37863 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37864 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37865 the calling process.
37866 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37867 option may not be used at all.
37868 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37869 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37870 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37871 .next
37872 .oindex "&%-be%&"
37873 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
37874 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
37875 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37876 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37877 calling process.
37878 .next
37879 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37880 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37881 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37882 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37883 testing address verification
37884 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
37885 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
37886 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37887 option).
37888 .next
37889 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37890 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37891 .endlist
37892
37893 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37894
37895 .ilist
37896 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37897 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37898 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37899 will be used during message reception.
37900 .next
37901 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37902 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37903 .next
37904 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37905 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37906 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37907 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37908 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37909 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37910 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37911 generating bounce and warning messages.
37912
37913 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37914 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37915 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37916 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37917 .next
37918 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37919 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37920 .endlist
37921
37922
37923
37924
37925 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37926 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37927 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37928 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37929 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37930 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37931 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37932 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37933 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37934 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37935 to any other uid.
37936
37937 .cindex SIGHUP
37938 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37939 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37940 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37941 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37942
37943 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37944 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37945 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37946 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37947 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37948
37949 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37950 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37951 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37952 effect.
37953
37954 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37955 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37956 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37957
37958 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37959 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37960 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37961 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37962 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37963 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37964 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37965 address this problem at this time.
37966
37967 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37968 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37969 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37970 be used in the most straightforward way.
37971
37972 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37973 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37974
37975 .ilist
37976 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37977 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37978 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37979 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37980 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37981 .next
37982 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37983 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37984 .next
37985 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37986 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37987 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37988 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37989 .next
37990 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37991 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37992
37993 .olist
37994 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37995 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37996 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37997 .next
37998 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37999 owned by the Exim user.
38000 .next
38001 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38002 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38003 mailboxes need to be created manually.
38004 .endlist olist
38005 .endlist ilist
38006
38007
38008 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38009 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38010 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38011 gives more security at essentially no cost.
38012
38013 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38014 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38015
38016
38017
38018
38019 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38020 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38021 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38022
38023
38024
38025 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38026 .cindex "security" "local commands"
38027 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38028 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38029 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38030 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38031 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38032
38033 .ilist
38034 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38035 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38036 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38037 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38038 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38039 .next
38040 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38041 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38042 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38043 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38044 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38045 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38046 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38047 .next
38048 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38049 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38050 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38051 .next
38052 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38053 taint checking might apply to their usage.
38054 .next
38055 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38056 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38057 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38058 .next
38059 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38060 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38061 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38062 of opaque strings.
38063 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38064 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38065 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38066 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38067 .endlist
38068
38069
38070
38071
38072 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38073 .cindex "security" "data sources"
38074 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38075 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38076 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
38077 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38078 are some issues to be aware of:
38079
38080 .ilist
38081 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38082 .next
38083 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38084 .next
38085 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38086 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38087 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38088 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38089 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38090 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38091 data.
38092 .next
38093 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
38094 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
38095 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
38096 .next
38097 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
38098 expected to yield one result.
38099 .endlist
38100
38101
38102
38103
38104 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
38105 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
38106 .cindex "IP source routing"
38107 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
38108 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
38109 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
38110 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
38111
38112
38113
38114 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
38115 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
38116 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
38117
38118
38119
38120
38121 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
38122 .cindex "trusted users"
38123 .cindex "admin user"
38124 .cindex "privileged user"
38125 .cindex "user" "trusted"
38126 .cindex "user" "admin"
38127 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38128 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38129 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38130 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38131 permit a remote host to be specified.
38132
38133 .oindex "&%-f%&"
38134 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38135 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38136 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38137 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38138 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38139 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38140
38141 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38142 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38143 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38144 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38145 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38146
38147 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38148 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38149 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38150 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38151 includes the contents of files on the spool.
38152
38153 .oindex "&%-M%&"
38154 .oindex "&%-q%&"
38155 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38156 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38157 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38158 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38159 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38160 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38161
38162 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38163 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38164 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38165 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38166 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38167 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38168 files.
38169
38170 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38171 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38172 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38173 This affects most of the checking options,
38174 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38175
38176
38177 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38178 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
38179 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38180 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38181 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38182 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38183
38184
38185
38186 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38187 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38188 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38189 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38190 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38191 this.
38192
38193
38194
38195 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38196 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38197 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38198 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38199 converted output.
38200
38201
38202
38203 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38204 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38205 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38206 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38207 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38208
38209
38210
38211 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38212 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38213 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38214 loading it.
38215
38216
38217 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38218 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38219 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38220 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38221 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38222 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38223 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38224
38225 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38226 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38227 string.
38228
38229
38230
38231 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38232 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38233 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38234 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38235
38236
38237
38238 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38239 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38240 enough to hold the result.
38241 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
38242
38243
38244
38245
38246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38247 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38248
38249 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38250 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38251 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38252 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38253 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
38254 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38255 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38256 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38257 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38258 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38259 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38260 themselves are recoverable.
38261
38262 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38263 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38264 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38265
38266 .ilist
38267 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38268 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38269 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38270 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38271 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38272 .next
38273 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38274 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38275 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38276 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38277 .next
38278 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38279 .next
38280 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38281 signature.
38282 .endlist
38283 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38284
38285 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38286 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38287 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38288 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38289 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38290 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38291 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38292 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38293 attempt.
38294
38295 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38296 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38297 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38298 relics of crashes and can be removed.
38299
38300 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38301 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38302 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38303 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38304 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38305 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38306 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38307 normally the Exim user.
38308
38309 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38310 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38311 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38312 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38313 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38314 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38315 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38316 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38317
38318 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38319 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38320 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38321 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38322
38323 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38324 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38325
38326 .vlist
38327 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38328 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38329 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38330 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38331 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38332 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38333 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38334 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38335 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38336 newlines.
38337
38338 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38339 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38340 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38341 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38342 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38343 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38344
38345 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38346 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38347 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38348 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38349 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38350 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38351
38352 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38353 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38354 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38355
38356 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38357 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38358 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38359 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38360 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38361
38362 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38363 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38364 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38365 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38366 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38367
38368 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38369 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38370 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38371
38372 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38373 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38374 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38375
38376 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38377 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38378 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38379
38380 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38381 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38382 present if the number is greater than zero.
38383
38384 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38385 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38386 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38387
38388 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38389 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38390 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38391
38392 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38393 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38394 command.
38395
38396 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38397 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38398 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38399 messages.
38400
38401 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38402 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38403 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38404 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38405
38406 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38407 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38408 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38409
38410 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38411 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38412 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38413 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38414 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38415 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38416
38417 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38418 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38419 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38420 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38421 supplied by the remote host, if any.
38422
38423 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38424 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38425 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38426 generated messages.
38427
38428 .vitem &%-local%&
38429 The message is from a local sender.
38430
38431 .vitem &%-localerror%&
38432 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38433
38434 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38435 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38436 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38437 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38438
38439 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38440 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38441 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38442
38443 .vitem &%-N%&
38444 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38445 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38446 &%-N%& is assumed.
38447
38448 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38449 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38450 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38451
38452 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38453 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38454 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38455
38456 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38457 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38458 of &$spam_score_int$&.
38459
38460 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38461 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38462 rather than Unix-format.
38463 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38464 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38465
38466 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38467 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38468 certificate was verified by the server.
38469
38470 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38471 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38472 name of the cipher suite that was used.
38473
38474 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38475 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38476 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38477 certificate.
38478 .endlist
38479
38480 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38481 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38482 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38483 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38484 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38485 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38486 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38487 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38488 addresses are complete.
38489
38490 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38491 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38492 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38493 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38494 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38495 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38496 .code
38497 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38498 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38499 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38500 .endd
38501 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38502 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38503 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38504 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38505 example:
38506 .code
38507 4
38508 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38509 darcy@austen.fict.example
38510 rdo@foundation
38511 alice@wonderland.fict.example
38512 .endd
38513 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38514 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38515 line is of the following form:
38516 .display
38517 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38518 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38519 .endd
38520 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38521 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38522 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38523 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38524 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38525 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38526 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38527 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38528
38529
38530 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38531 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38532 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38533 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38534 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38535 following:
38536
38537 .table2 50pt
38538 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38539 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38540 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38541 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38542 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38543 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38544 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38545 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38546 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38547 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38548 .endtable
38549
38550 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38551 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38552 typical set of headers:
38553 .code
38554 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38555 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38556 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38557 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38558 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38559 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38560 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38561 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38562 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38563 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38564 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38565 .endd
38566 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38567 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38568 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38569 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38570 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38571 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38572
38573 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
38574 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
38575 an ASCII newline character.
38576 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
38577 can have an alternate format.
38578 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
38579 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
38580 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
38581 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
38582 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
38583 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
38584
38585 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38586 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38587
38588 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38589 "DKIM and SPF Support"
38590 .cindex "DKIM"
38591
38592 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
38593
38594 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38595 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38596 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38597 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
38598
38599 .new
38600 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
38601 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
38602 any original DKIM signature.
38603 .wen
38604
38605 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38606 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38607
38608 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38609 .olist
38610 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38611 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38612 (including transport filters)
38613 except cutthrough delivery.
38614 .next
38615 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38616 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38617 different signature contexts.
38618 .endlist
38619
38620 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38621 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38622 Exim's standard controls.
38623
38624 .new
38625 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38626 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
38627
38628 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
38629 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
38630 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38631 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38632 .code
38633 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38634 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38635 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38636 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38637 .endd
38638 .wen
38639
38640 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38641 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38642 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38643 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38644 senders).
38645
38646
38647 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38648 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38649
38650 .new
38651 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
38652 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38653 .code
38654 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38655
38656 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38657 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38658 .endd
38659 .wen
38660 .wen
38661
38662 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38663 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38664
38665 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38666 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38667 After expansion, this can be a list.
38668 Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38669 while expanding the remaining signing options.
38670 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
38671 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38672
38673 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
38674 This sets the key selector string.
38675 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
38676 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
38677 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38678 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38679 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
38680 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
38681
38682 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38683 This sets the private key to use.
38684 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38685 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38686 The result can either
38687 .ilist
38688 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
38689 .next
38690 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38691 the private key.
38692 .next
38693 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38694 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38695 is set.
38696 .endlist
38697
38698 .new
38699 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38700 .code
38701 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
38702 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
38703 .endd
38704 .wen
38705
38706 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
38707 Can be set alternatively to &"sha1"& to use an alternate hash
38708 method.
38709
38710 .new
38711 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38712 .code
38713 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38714 .endd
38715 .wen
38716
38717 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
38718 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
38719 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
38720 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
38721 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
38722 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
38723
38724 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
38725 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
38726 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
38727 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
38728 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
38729
38730 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
38731 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
38732 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
38733 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
38734 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
38735 variables here.
38736
38737 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
38738 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
38739 list of header names.
38740 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
38741 in the message signature.
38742 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
38743 whether or not each header is present in the message.
38744 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
38745 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
38746
38747 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence therof)
38748 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
38749 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
38750
38751 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
38752 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
38753 will be signed.
38754 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
38755 will be signed, and one signtature added for a missing header with the
38756 name will be appended.
38757
38758
38759 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
38760 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
38761
38762 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is implemented via the
38763 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
38764 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
38765 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
38766 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
38767 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
38768 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
38769
38770 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
38771 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
38772 runtime of the ACL.
38773
38774 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
38775 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
38776 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
38777 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
38778
38779 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
38780 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
38781 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
38782 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
38783 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
38784 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
38785 it defaults as:
38786 .code
38787 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
38788 .endd
38789 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
38790 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
38791 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
38792 .code
38793 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
38794 .endd
38795 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
38796 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
38797 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
38798 .code
38799 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
38800 .endd
38801
38802 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
38803 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
38804
38805 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
38806 for each matching signature.
38807
38808
38809 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
38810 available (from most to least important):
38811
38812
38813 .vlist
38814 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
38815 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
38816 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
38817 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
38818
38819 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
38820 Within the DKIM ACL,
38821 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
38822 .ilist
38823 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
38824 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38825 .next
38826 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
38827 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38828 .next
38829 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
38830 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38831 .next
38832 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
38833 .endlist
38834
38835 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
38836 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
38837 hash-method or key-size:
38838 .code
38839 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}}
38840 condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
38841 logwrite = NOTE: forcing dkim verify fail (was pass)
38842 set dkim_verify_status = fail
38843 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak
38844 .endd
38845
38846 After all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
38847 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
38848
38849 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
38850 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
38851 "fail" or "invalid". One of
38852 .ilist
38853 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
38854 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
38855 .next
38856 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
38857 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
38858 .next
38859 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
38860 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
38861 means that the message body was modified in transit.
38862 .next
38863 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
38864 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
38865 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
38866 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
38867 .endlist
38868
38869 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
38870
38871 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
38872 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
38873 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
38874 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38875
38876 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
38877 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
38878 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
38879 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38880
38881 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
38882 The key record selector string.
38883
38884 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
38885 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
38886
38887 .new
38888 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38889 .code
38890 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
38891
38892 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
38893 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
38894 .endd
38895
38896 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
38897 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
38898 .wen
38899
38900 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
38901 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38902
38903 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
38904 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38905
38906 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
38907 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
38908 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
38909 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
38910 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
38911 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
38912
38913 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
38914 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
38915 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
38916 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
38917
38918 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
38919 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
38920 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
38921
38922 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
38923 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
38924 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
38925 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
38926 integer size comparisons against this value.
38927
38928 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
38929 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
38930
38931 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
38932 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
38933
38934 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
38935 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
38936
38937 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
38938 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38939 in the key record.
38940
38941 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
38942 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38943 in the key record.
38944
38945 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
38946 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
38947
38948 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
38949 Number of bits in the key.
38950
38951 .new
38952 Note that RFC 8301 says:
38953 .code
38954 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
38955 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
38956 .endd
38957
38958 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
38959 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
38960 .wen
38961
38962 .endlist
38963
38964 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
38965
38966 .vlist
38967 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
38968 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
38969 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
38970 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
38971 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
38972
38973 .code
38974 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
38975 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
38976 sender_domains = gmail.com
38977 dkim_signers = gmail.com
38978 dkim_status = none
38979 .endd
38980
38981 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
38982 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
38983
38984 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
38985 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
38986 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
38987 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
38988
38989 .code
38990 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
38991 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
38992 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
38993 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
38994 .endd
38995
38996 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
38997 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
38998 for more information of what they mean.
38999 .endlist
39000
39001
39002
39003
39004 .new
39005 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
39006 .cindex SPF verification
39007
39008 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
39009 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
39010 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
39011
39012 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
39013 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
39014
39015 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
39016 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
39017 &url(http://www.libspf2.org/).
39018 There is no Exim involvement on the trasmission of messages; publishing certain
39019 DNS records is all that is required.
39020
39021 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
39022
39023 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39024 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
39025 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
39026 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
39027 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
39028 Valid strings are:
39029 .vlist
39030 .vitem &%pass%&
39031 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
39032
39033 .vitem &%fail%&
39034 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
39035 domain in the envelope-from address.
39036
39037 .vitem &%softfail%&
39038 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
39039 is a forgery.
39040
39041 .vitem &%none%&
39042 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
39043
39044 .vitem &%neutral%&
39045 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
39046 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
39047 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
39048
39049 .vitem &%permerror%&
39050 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
39051 You may deny messages when this occurs. (Changed in 4.83)
39052
39053 .vitem &%temperror%&
39054 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
39055 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
39056 (Changed in 4.83)
39057
39058 .vitem &%err_temp%&
39059 Same as permerror, deprecated in 4.83, will be removed in a future release.
39060
39061 .vitem &%err_perm%&
39062 Same as temperror, deprecated in 4.83, will be removed in a future release.
39063 .endlist
39064
39065 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
39066 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
39067 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
39068 short-circuit fashion.
39069
39070 Example:
39071 .code
39072 deny spf = fail
39073 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
39074 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
39075 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
39076 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
39077 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
39078 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
39079 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
39080 ip=$sender_host_address
39081 .endd
39082
39083 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
39084 variables:
39085
39086 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
39087 .vlist
39088 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
39089 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
39090 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
39091 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
39092 it for logging purposes.
39093
39094 .vitem &$spf_received$&
39095 .vindex &$spf_received$&
39096 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
39097 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
39098 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
39099 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
39100
39101 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
39102 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
39103
39104 .vitem &$spf_result$&
39105 .vindex &$spf_result$&
39106 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
39107 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
39108 temperror.
39109
39110 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39111 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39112 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
39113 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
39114 .endlist
39115
39116
39117 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39118 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
39119 .cindex SPF "best guess"
39120 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
39121 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
39122 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
39123 capability.
39124 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
39125 for a description of what it means.
39126
39127 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
39128 of the spf one. For example:
39129
39130 .code
39131 deny spf_guess = fail
39132 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
39133 .endd
39134
39135 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
39136 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
39137 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
39138 reject message.
39139
39140 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
39141 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
39142
39143 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
39144 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
39145 &%spf_guess%& option.
39146 For example, the following:
39147
39148 .code
39149 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
39150 .endd
39151
39152 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
39153
39154
39155 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
39156 .cindex lookup spf
39157 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
39158 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
39159
39160 .code
39161 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
39162 .endd
39163
39164 The lookup will return the same result strings as they can appear in
39165 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
39166 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
39167
39168
39169 . wen-for SPF section
39170 .wen
39171
39172
39173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39174 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39175
39176 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
39177 "Proxy support"
39178 .cindex "proxy support"
39179 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
39180
39181 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
39182 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
39183
39184
39185 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
39186 .cindex proxy inbound
39187 .cindex proxy "server side"
39188 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
39189 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
39190
39191 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
39192 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
39193 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
39194 in Local/Makefile.
39195
39196 It was built on specifications from:
39197 (&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
39198 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
39199 (&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
39200
39201 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
39202 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
39203 to distribute load.
39204 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
39205 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
39206 There is no logging if a host passes or
39207 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
39208 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
39209
39210 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
39211 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
39212 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
39213 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
39214 automatically determines which version is in use.
39215
39216 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
39217 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
39218 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
39219 Exim and the proxy server.
39220
39221 The following expansion variables are usable
39222 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
39223 of the proxy):
39224 .display
39225 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
39226 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
39227 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
39228 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
39229 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
39230 .endd
39231 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
39232 there was a protocol error.
39233
39234 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
39235 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
39236 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
39237 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
39238 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
39239 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
39240 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
39241 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
39242 A possible solution is:
39243 .display
39244 # Set max number of connections per host
39245 LIMIT = 5
39246 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
39247 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
39248
39249 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
39250 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
39251 .endd
39252
39253
39254
39255 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
39256 .cindex proxy outbound
39257 .cindex proxy "client side"
39258 .cindex proxy SOCKS
39259 .cindex SOCKS proxy
39260 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
39261 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
39262 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
39263 Local/Makefile.
39264
39265 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
39266 on an smtp transport.
39267 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
39268 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
39269 Each proxy specifier is a list
39270 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
39271 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
39272
39273 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
39274 The list of options is in the following table:
39275 .display
39276 &'auth '& authentication method
39277 &'name '& authentication username
39278 &'pass '& authentication password
39279 &'port '& tcp port
39280 &'tmo '& connection timeout
39281 &'pri '& priority
39282 &'weight '& selection bias
39283 .endd
39284
39285 More details on each of these options follows:
39286
39287 .ilist
39288 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
39289 .cindex proxy authentication
39290 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
39291 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
39292 for access to the proxy.
39293 Default is &"none"&.
39294 .next
39295 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
39296 Default is empty.
39297 .next
39298 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
39299 Default is empty.
39300 .next
39301 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
39302 Default is 1080.
39303 .next
39304 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
39305 Default is 5.
39306 .next
39307 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
39308 higher values being tried first.
39309 The default priority is 1.
39310 .next
39311 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
39312 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
39313 weighted by this value.
39314 The default value for selection bias is 1.
39315 .endlist
39316
39317 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
39318 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
39319 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
39320
39321 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
39322 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
39323 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
39324 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
39325
39326 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39327 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39328
39329 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
39330 "Internationalisation""
39331 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
39332 .cindex EAI
39333 .cindex i18n
39334 .cindex UTF-8 "mail name handling"
39335
39336 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
39337 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
39338 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
39339
39340 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
39341 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
39342 requirement, upon libidn2.
39343
39344 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
39345 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
39346 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
39347 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
39348 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
39349 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
39350
39351 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
39352 international handling for the message is enabled and
39353 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
39354
39355 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
39356 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
39357 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
39358 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
39359
39360 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
39361 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
39362 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
39363 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
39364
39365 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
39366 components expanded to a-label form,
39367 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
39368 form of the name.
39369
39370 .cindex log protocol
39371 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
39372 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
39373 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
39374
39375 The following expansion operators can be used:
39376 .code
39377 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
39378 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
39379 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
39380 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
39381 .endd
39382
39383 ACLs may use the following modifier:
39384 .display
39385 control = utf8_downconvert
39386 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
39387 .endd
39388 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
39389 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
39390 Message Submission Agent context.
39391 If a value is appended it may be:
39392 .display
39393 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
39394 &`0 `& no downconversion
39395 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
39396 .endd
39397
39398 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
39399 is initially set to -1.
39400
39401
39402 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
39403 Configurations supporting these should inspect
39404 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
39405
39406 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
39407 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
39408 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
39409
39410 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
39411 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
39412
39413
39414
39415 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
39416 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
39417 the following expansion operator can be used:
39418 .code
39419 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
39420 .endd
39421
39422 The string is converted from the charset specified by
39423 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
39424 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
39425 to the
39426 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
39427 with the following exception: All occurences of <sep>
39428 (which has to be a single character)
39429 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
39430 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
39431
39432 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
39433 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
39434
39435 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
39436 by many other IMAP servers.
39437
39438 Examples:
39439 .display
39440 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
39441 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
39442 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
39443 .endd
39444
39445 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
39446 must be representable in UTF-16.
39447
39448
39449 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39450 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39451
39452 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
39453 "Events"
39454 .cindex events
39455
39456 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
39457 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
39458 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
39459 processing actions.
39460
39461 Most installations will never need to use Events.
39462 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
39463 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39464
39465 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
39466 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
39467 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
39468
39469 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
39470 An example might look like:
39471 .cindex logging custom
39472 .code
39473 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
39474 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
39475 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
39476 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
39477 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
39478 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
39479 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
39480 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
39481 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
39482 } {}}
39483 .endd
39484
39485 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
39486 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
39487 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
39488
39489 The current list of events is:
39490 .display
39491 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
39492 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39493 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
39494 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
39495 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
39496 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
39497 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
39498 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
39499 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
39500 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
39501 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
39502 .endd
39503 New event types may be added in future.
39504
39505 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
39506 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
39507 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
39508
39509 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
39510 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
39511 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
39512
39513 The third column in the table above says what section of the configumration
39514 should define the event action.
39515
39516 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
39517 with the event type:
39518 .display
39519 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
39520 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
39521 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
39522 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
39523 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
39524 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
39525 .endd
39526
39527 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
39528
39529 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
39530 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
39531 the course of its processing:
39532 .ilist
39533 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
39534 transport call
39535 .next
39536 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
39537 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
39538 .endlist
39539 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
39540 a useful way of writing to the main log.
39541
39542 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
39543 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
39544 following will be forced:
39545 .display
39546 &`msg:delivery `& (ignored)
39547 &`msg:host:defer `& (ignored)
39548 &`msg:fail:delivery`& (ignored)
39549 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
39550 &`tcp:close `& (ignored)
39551 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
39552 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
39553 .endd
39554 No other use is made of the result string.
39555
39556 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39557 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39558 the target system.
39559
39560 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39561 chain element received on the connection.
39562 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39563 loaded locally.
39564
39565 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39566 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39567
39568 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39569 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39570 .cindex "adding drivers"
39571 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
39572 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39573 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39574 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39575
39576 .olist
39577 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39578 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39579 .next
39580 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39581 .display
39582 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39583 .endd
39584 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39585 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39586 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39587 .next
39588 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39589 .code
39590 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39591 .endd
39592 .next
39593 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39594 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39595 .next
39596 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39597 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39598 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39599 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39600 simple form that most lookups have.
39601 .next
39602 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39603 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39604 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39605 .next
39606 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39607 &_src_&.
39608 .next
39609 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
39610 as for other drivers and lookups.
39611 .endlist
39612
39613 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
39614 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
39615 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
39616 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
39617 searched using a binary chop procedure.
39618
39619 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
39620 the interface that is expected.
39621
39622
39623
39624
39625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39626 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39627
39628 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39629 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
39630 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
39631 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
39632 . processors.
39633 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39634
39635 .literal xml
39636 <?sdop
39637 format="newpage"
39638 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
39639 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
39640 ?>
39641 .literal off
39642
39643 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
39644 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
39645 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
39646
39647
39648 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39649 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////